ENGINEERING CONSULTING GUIDELINES FOR … Vol... · Engineering Consultant Guidelines for Highway...
-
Upload
phunghuong -
Category
Documents
-
view
222 -
download
3
Transcript of ENGINEERING CONSULTING GUIDELINES FOR … Vol... · Engineering Consultant Guidelines for Highway...
ENGINEERING CONSULTING GUIDELINES FOR HIGHWAY, BRIDGE,
AND WATER PROJECTS
VOLUME 1 – DESIGN AND TENDER 2011
�ovember 2011 1
E�GI�EERI�G CO�SULTA�T GUIDELI�ES FOR HIGHWAY,
BRIDGE, A�D WATER PROJECTS – VOLUME 1 – DESIG� A�D
TE�DER
The purpose of this manual is as follows:
� To outline the Department’s expectations for the provision of engineering services for
the design and tendering of all provincial highway, bridge, and water management
projects where a consultant is hired directly by the Department.
� To ensure uniformity and consistency in the provisions of these services to the
Department.
� To outline specific responsibilities and authorities of the consultant when providing
these services.
The consultant’s obligations are detailed in the consulting services contract and construction
contract documents. This manual outlines the deliverables established by the Department
which will typically fulfil the consultant’s obligations and ensure that Department
requirements are met in the desired manner.
This manual does not provide a complete record of all the processes, responsibilities and
authorities of the consultant and the Department in managing the delivery of a Department
construction contract. Other documents or manuals which must be considered include but are
not limited to the following:
1. Engineering Consultant Guidelines for Highway and Bridge Projects – Volume 2 –
Construction Contract Administration
� This document provides guidelines covering the post-tender period.
2. Project Administration Manual
� This document outlines the Department’s internal methods of administering
engineering contracts and construction contracts as well as selecting, monitoring
and evaluating consultants.
3. Traffic Accommodation in Work Zones Manual
� This document provides information and minimum standards for the provision of
traffic accommodation through work zones on highways and bridges in Alberta.
The authorities, responsibilities and processes contained in all these manuals are based on the
Department’s policy statements, authority’s matrix, contract specifications, and contracts for
engineering consultant services. Updates or revisions to existing contract specifications, the
terms of the contract, policy statements or the authority’s matrix may affect these processes,
responsibilities and authorities. In the event of any such changes which significantly affect
�ovember 2011 2
the contents of these manuals, users will be advised accordingly. Please refer to the
Department website for a listing of additional Department publications.
This manual is not intended to replace or modify the contents of the Department’s
construction contracts or engineering consultant contracts. If a conflict or ambiguity exists
between this manual and the Consulting Services Contract, the user shall contact the
Director, Professional Services Section, of the Department’s Program Management Branch
for clarification.
Any omissions, obvious errors, or recommendations for future updates should be forwarded
to the Director, Professional Services Section, of the Department’s Program Management
Branch.
TABLE OF COTETS
�ovember 2011 i
SECTIO� 1 - GE�ERAL .......................................................................................................................... 1-1
1.1 INTRODUCTION ...................................................................................................................................1-1
1.1.1 DEFI�ITIO�S ................................................................................................................................ 1-2
1.2 WORKERS COMPENSATION BOARD AND OCCUPATIONAL HEALTH AND SAFETY.............1-8
1.2.1 GE�ERAL ....................................................................................................................................... 1-8
1.2.2 WORKSITE HAZARD ..................................................................................................................... 1-9
1.2.3 ACCIDE�T I�VESTIGATIO� AT THE WORKSITE ..................................................................... 1-9
1.2.4 SAFETY CERTIFICATE OF RECOG�ITIO� ............................................................................... 1-9
1.3 PUBLIC SAFETY REQUIREMENTS (TRAFFIC ACCOMMODATION THROUGH THE WORK
ZONE) ...............................................................................................................................................................1-10
1.3.1 GE�ERAL ..................................................................................................................................... 1-10
1.3.1.1 Flagperson ................................................................................................................................................. 1-11
1.3.2 ACCIDE�T I�VESTIGATIO� WITHI� THE PROJECT LIMIT ................................................. 1-11
1.4 OTHER GENERAL REQUIREMENTS ...............................................................................................1-12
1.4.1 PROFESSIO�AL REGISTRATIO� .............................................................................................. 1-12
1.4.2 PROFESSIO�AL SEAL ................................................................................................................ 1-12
1.4.3 CO�STRUCTIO� SPECIFICATIO�S A�D CO�TRACT CO�DITIO�S ................................... 1-12
1.4.4 FIRST �ATIO� CO�SULTATIO� ............................................................................................... 1-12
1.4.4.1 First Nation Consultation For Projects on Indian Reserves ....................................................................... 1-12
1.4.4.2 First Nation Consultation For Projects Outside Indian Reserves .............................................................. 1-13
1.4.4.3 Federal Government First Nation Consulting Requirements ..................................................................... 1-13
1.4.5 RECORDS, FREEDOM OF I�FORMATIO�, A�D PROTECTIO� OF PRIVACY ACT ............ 1-13
1.4.6 MA�UALS .................................................................................................................................... 1-14
1.4.7 DUPLICATI�G ............................................................................................................................ 1-14
1.4.8 UPDATES ..................................................................................................................................... 1-14
1.4.9 WEBSITE ...................................................................................................................................... 1-14
1.5 RESPONSIBILITIES ............................................................................................................................1-15
1.5.1 GE�ERAL ..................................................................................................................................... 1-15
1.5.2 CHA�GES TO SCOPE OF WORK FOR E�GI�EERI�G ASSIG�ME�T .................................. 1-15
1.5.3 BACKGROU�D I�FORMATIO� ................................................................................................ 1-15
1.5.4 LIAISO� ....................................................................................................................................... 1-16
1.5.5 PROJECT I�ITIALIZATIO� ........................................................................................................ 1-16
1.5.6 APPROVAL OR ACCEPTA�CE .................................................................................................. 1-16
1.5.7 COST ESTIMATES ....................................................................................................................... 1-17
1.5.8 I�DEPE�DE�T DESIG� CHECK .............................................................................................. 1-18
1.5.9 REVIEW OF WORK BY THE DEPARTME�T ............................................................................. 1-18
1.5.10 CO�SULTA�T PERFORMA�CE EVALUATIO� ....................................................................... 1-18
1.6 DESIGN PHILOSOPHY .......................................................................................................................1-19
1.6.1 GE�ERAL ..................................................................................................................................... 1-19
1.6.2 CO�TRACT DESIG� CHA�GE PROPOSALS ........................................................................... 1-20
1.7 USE OF ALL TERRAIN VEHICLES (ATVS) FOR ENGINEERING ACTIVITIES ...........................1-21
1.8 REPORTING REQUIREMENTS .........................................................................................................1-22
SECTIO� 2 - PLA��I�G ......................................................................................................................... 2-1
2.1 GENERAL...............................................................................................................................................2-1
2.2 DATA COLLECTION ............................................................................................................................2-1
2.3 TYPICAL STUDY CONSIDERATIONS ...............................................................................................2-2
2.4 PLAN PREPARATION...........................................................................................................................2-3
2.4.1 MOSAIC PLA�S ............................................................................................................................. 2-3
2.4.2 CO�TOUR PLA�S ......................................................................................................................... 2-3
2.5 STAKEHOLDER INPUT ........................................................................................................................2-3
2.6 FIELD WORK .........................................................................................................................................2-3
2.7 PRESENTATION OF RECOMMENDATION .......................................................................................2-4
2.8 REPORTING REQUIREMENTS ...........................................................................................................2-4
TABLE OF COTETS
�ovember 2011 ii
SECTIO� 3 - RIGHT-OF-WAY ............................................................................................................... 3-1
3.1 BASIC RIGHT-OF-WAY REQUEST .................................................................................................... 3-1
3.1.1 GE�ERAL ....................................................................................................................................... 3-1
3.1.2 REQUEST DOCUME�TS .............................................................................................................. 3-1
3.1.3 LEAD-TIME .................................................................................................................................... 3-2
3.1.4 RIGHT-OF-WAY FOR PROJECTS O� U�TITLED CROW� LA�D ............................................ 3-2
3.2 SUPPLEMENTARY AND FINAL RIGHT-OF-WAY REQUESTS ...................................................... 3-2
3.2.1 GE�ERAL ....................................................................................................................................... 3-2
3.2.2 RIGHT-OF-WAY FOR PROJECTS O� U�TITLED CROW� LA�D ............................................ 3-3
3.2.3 REQUEST DOCUME�TS .............................................................................................................. 3-3
3.3 ACQUISITION OF RIGHT-OF-WAY ................................................................................................... 3-3
3.3.1 GE�ERAL ....................................................................................................................................... 3-3
3.3.2 TIMI�G .......................................................................................................................................... 3-6
3.3.3 SPECIAL CO�SIDERATIO�S FOR FEDERAL LA�DS ............................................................... 3-6
3.3.4 APPROVALS REQUIRED .............................................................................................................. 3-6
3.4 LEGAL SURVEY ................................................................................................................................... 3-7
3.4.1 GE�ERAL ....................................................................................................................................... 3-7
3.4.2 PERMISSIO� TO SURVEY ............................................................................................................ 3-7
3.4.3 REFERE�CI�G EXISTI�G SURVEY MO�UME�TS ................................................................... 3-8
3.4.4 ALIG�ME�T .................................................................................................................................. 3-8
3.4.5 POSTI�G BOU�DARIES (I�STALLI�G IRO� POSTS)............................................................... 3-8
3.4.6 PLA� PREPARATIO� ................................................................................................................... 3-8
3.4.7 AT AFFIDAVIT FOR ACQUIRI�G LA�DS .................................................................................. 3-9
3.4.7.1 Normal Affidavit ......................................................................................................................................... 3-9
3.4.7.2 Affidavit When Lands Are Being Expropriated .......................................................................................... 3-9
3.4.8 EXPROPRIATIO� SURVEYS ......................................................................................................... 3-9
3.5 EXPROPRIATION PROCESS ............................................................................................................. 3-10
3.6 REPORTING REQUIREMENTS ........................................................................................................ 3-10
SECTIO� 4 - E�VIRO�ME�TAL CO�SIDERATIO�S ..................................................................... 4-1
4.1 ENVIRONMENTAL MANAGEMENT SYSTEM................................................................................ 4-1
4.2 ENVIRONMENTAL ASSESSMENT ................................................................................................... 4-1
4.3 REGULATORY CONTACT/APPROVALS/AUTHORIZATIONS ...................................................... 4-1
4.3.1 PROJECT SPO�SOR SIG�-OFF O� E�VIRO�ME�TAL A�D REGULATORY APPLICATIO�S4-2
4.4 SPECIAL PROVISIONS ........................................................................................................................ 4-2
4.5 ENVIRONMENTAL RISK ASSESSMENT ......................................................................................... 4-3
4.6 CONSERVATION AND RECLAMATION OF TOPSOIL AND SUBSOIL ........................................ 4-3
4.6.1 SOIL STRIPPI�G PLA� ....................................................................................................................... 4-3
4.7 BORROW EXCAVATIONS .................................................................................................................. 4-4
4.7.1 DEPARTME�T SUPPLY OF BORROW ............................................................................................... 4-5
4.7.2 CO�TRACTOR SUPPLY OF BORROW ............................................................................................... 4-5
4.8 WEED SURVEY .................................................................................................................................... 4-5
4.9 CONTAMINATED SITES..................................................................................................................... 4-6
4.10 MONITORING AND INSPECTION REPORTING ............................................................................. 4-6
SECTIO� 5 - E�GI�EERI�G ASSESSME�T ...................................................................................... 5-1
5.1 GENERAL .............................................................................................................................................. 5-1
5.2 ROADWAY ENGINEERING ASSESSMENTS ................................................................................... 5-2
5.2.1 GEOMETRIC ASSESSME�T ......................................................................................................... 5-2
5.2.2 ROAD SAFETY AUDIT .................................................................................................................. 5-4
5.2.3 I�-SERVICE SAFETY REVIEW ..................................................................................................... 5-5
5.2.4 AT-GRADE RAILWAY CROSSI�G APPLICATIO�S .................................................................... 5-7
5.2.5 ROADWAY APPURTE�A�CES: (HIGHWAY LIGHTI�G, TRAFFIC SIG�ALS, PEDESTRIA�
CROSSI�G CO�TROL) ................................................................................................................................. 5-8
5.2.5.1 General ........................................................................................................................................................ 5-9
5.2.5.2 Scope Outline .............................................................................................................................................. 5-9
TABLE OF COTETS
�ovember 2011 iii
5.2.5.3 Warrant Analysis ....................................................................................................................................... 5-10
5.2.6 TRAFFIC DATA: (TUR�I�G MOVEME�T STUDIES, TRAFFIC SPEED DATA COLLECTIO�)5-11
5.2.6.1 General ...................................................................................................................................................... 5-11
5.2.6.2 Turning Movement Studies ....................................................................................................................... 5-12
5.2.6.3 Speed Data Requirements .......................................................................................................................... 5-13
5.2.7 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS .................................................................................................. 5-14
5.3 SURFACING ENGINEERING ASSESSMENT ..................................................................................5-14
5.3.1 SURFACI�G STRATEGY A�D BASIC PAVEME�T STRUCTURAL DESIG� .......................... 5-14
5.3.2 SEAL COAT PRIORITIZATIO� ................................................................................................... 5-16
5.3.3 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS .................................................................................................. 5-16
5.4 BRIDGE ASSESSMENTS AND/OR BRIDGE PLANNING ...............................................................5-17
SECTIO� 6 - PRELIMI�ARY E�GI�EERI�G ................................................................................... 6-1
6.1 GENERAL...............................................................................................................................................6-1
6.1.1 BRIDGE PLA��I�G...................................................................................................................... 6-1
6.1.2 PROJECT SET-UP A�D REVIEW EXISTI�G I�FORMATIO� ................................................... 6-1
6.1.3 I�ITIALIZATIO� MEETI�G ......................................................................................................... 6-2
6.1.4 PRELIMI�ARY SURVEY................................................................................................................ 6-2
6.1.4.1 General Requirements ................................................................................................................................. 6-2
6.1.4.2 Chainages .................................................................................................................................................... 6-3
6.1.4.3 Construction Control Points ........................................................................................................................ 6-3
6.1.4.4 Elevations .................................................................................................................................................... 6-3
6.1.4.5 Bridge Surveys ............................................................................................................................................ 6-3
6.1.5 DRAI�AGE REVIEW (SIDE DITCHES, MEDIA�S DITCHES, �O�-BRIDGE SIZED CULVERTS,
A�D STORM WATER MA�AGEME�T FACILITIES) .................................................................................. 6-4
6.1.6 RIGHT-OF-WAY COORDI�ATIO�/ PERMISSIO� TO E�TER & TEST ..................................... 6-4
6.1.7 SOIL SURVEY ................................................................................................................................ 6-5
6.1.8 UTILITY SURVEY .......................................................................................................................... 6-5
6.1.8.1 Utility Search ............................................................................................................................................... 6-5
6.1.8.2 Notification Letter ....................................................................................................................................... 6-6
6.1.8.3 Pipelines ...................................................................................................................................................... 6-6
6.1.8.4 Power Lines ................................................................................................................................................. 6-8
6.1.8.5 Telephone Facilities ..................................................................................................................................... 6-8
6.1.8.6 Railway Crossings ....................................................................................................................................... 6-9
6.1.8.7 Other Cables ................................................................................................................................................ 6-9
6.1.8.8 Illumination Assessment .............................................................................................................................. 6-9
6.1.8.9 Reporting Requirements .............................................................................................................................. 6-9
6.1.9 REVIEW ACCESS MA�AGEME�T ............................................................................................. 6-10
6.1.10 SIG� I�VE�TORY ....................................................................................................................... 6-10
6.1.11 GEOMETRIC A�D SAFETY ASSESSME�T, A�D SURFACI�G STRATEGY ........................... 6-10
6.2 REPORTING REQUIREMENTS .........................................................................................................6-11
SECTIO� 7 - GEOTECH�ICAL CO�SIDERATIO�S ........................................................................ 7-1
7.1 GENERAL...............................................................................................................................................7-1
7.2 ROADWAY ............................................................................................................................................7-7
7.3 BORROW................................................................................................................................................7-7
7.4 BRIDGE AND MAJOR CULVERTS .....................................................................................................7-8
7.4.1 CORROSIO� SURVEY ................................................................................................................... 7-9
7.4.1.1 Reporting Requirements .............................................................................................................................. 7-9
7.4.1.2 Qualifications ............................................................................................................................................ 7-10
7.5 SOFT GROUND/MUSKEG .................................................................................................................7-10
7.6 LANDSLIDE .........................................................................................................................................7-10
7.7 EXPANSIVE SOILS .............................................................................................................................7-11
7.8 EROSION ..............................................................................................................................................7-12
7.9 ROCK ....................................................................................................................................................7-13
7.10 BACKFILLING OF TEST HOLES AND RESTORATION OF TEST PITS ......................................7-13
7.11 INSTRUMENTATION INSTALLATION AND MONITORING .......................................................7-14
7.12 LABORATORY TESTING ..................................................................................................................7-14
TABLE OF COTETS
�ovember 2011 iv
7.13 GEOSYNTHETIC AND EROSION CONTROL MATERIALS ......................................................... 7-15
7.14 BOREHOLE DATA REPORTING ...................................................................................................... 7-15
7.15 PRESENTATION OF SOILS AND ROCK INFORMATION ON MOSAICS ................................... 7-15
7.16 REPORTING REQUIREMENTS ........................................................................................................ 7-16
7.16.1 DIFFERI�G SITE CO�DITIO�S (DSC) CLAUSES .................................................................... 7-16
SECTIO� 8 - GEOMETRIC DESIG� ..................................................................................................... 8-1
8.1 GENERAL .............................................................................................................................................. 8-1
8.1.1 GRADI�G DESIG� PACKAGE .................................................................................................... 8-2
8.2 ROADSIDE FACILITIES ...................................................................................................................... 8-3
8.3 INTERSECTION DESIGN .................................................................................................................... 8-3
8.4 RIGHT-OF-WAY AND BORROW ....................................................................................................... 8-3
8.5 ROADSIDE DESIGN (CLEAR ZONE, MITIGATION OF HAZARDS, BARRIER PROTECTION, ETC.) ............. 8-4
8.6 RAILWAY CROSSINGS ....................................................................................................................... 8-4
8.6.1 AT-GRADE CROSSI�GS ............................................................................................................... 8-5
8.6.2 GRADE SEPARATED CROSSI�GS ............................................................................................... 8-5
8.7 UTILITIES ............................................................................................................................................. 8-5
8.7.1 GE�ERAL ....................................................................................................................................... 8-5
8.7.2 COORDI�ATIO� ........................................................................................................................... 8-7
8.7.3 UTILITY EASEME�TS A�D CLEARI�G ...................................................................................... 8-8
8.7.4 CROSSI�G ADJUSTME�T AGREEME�TS ................................................................................ 8-10
8.7.5 UTILITY AGREEME�TS .............................................................................................................. 8-12
8.7.6 UTILITY SPECIAL PROVISIO�S ................................................................................................ 8-12
8.8 SEEDING ............................................................................................................................................. 8-12
8.9 SIGNING .............................................................................................................................................. 8-12
8.9.1 PRIVATELY OW�ED SIG�S ....................................................................................................... 8-13
8.10 GUIDEPOSTS (DELINEATORS) ....................................................................................................... 8-13
8.11 PAVEMENT MARKINGS (COMBINED GRADING/ SURFACING PROJECTS AND SURFACING
PROJECTS) ...................................................................................................................................................... 8-13
8.11.1 LA�E WIDTHS (PAI�TI�G) ........................................................................................................ 8-14
8.12 RUMBLE STRIPS................................................................................................................................ 8-14
8.13 HIGHWAY ILLUMINATION (LIGHTING) ...................................................................................... 8-14
8.14 TRAFFIC CONTROL SIGNALS......................................................................................................... 8-15
8.15 INDEPENDENT DESIGN CHECK..................................................................................................... 8-15
8.16 FINAL DESIGN REVIEW................................................................................................................... 8-16
8.17 COST SUMMARY............................................................................................................................... 8-16
8.18 REPORTING REQUIREMENTS ........................................................................................................ 8-16
SECTIO� 9 - SURFACI�G DESIG� ...................................................................................................... 9-1
9.1 GENERAL .............................................................................................................................................. 9-1
9.2 SURFACING DESIGN PACKAGE ....................................................................................................... 9-1
9.2.1 SURFACI�G STRATEGY A�D BASIC STRUCTURAL DESIG� .................................................. 9-2
9.2.1.1 Pavement and Laboratory Testing ............................................................................................................... 9-3
9.2.2 GRAVEL SURFACI�G A�D SEAL COAT ..................................................................................... 9-4
9.2.3 GEOMETRICS A�D CLEARA�CES .............................................................................................. 9-4
9.2.4 AGGREGATE REQUIREME�TS ................................................................................................... 9-4
9.2.5 ASPHALT MIX TYPE A�D BI�DER SELECTIO� ........................................................................ 9-4
9.2.6 SPECIAL PROVISIO�S ................................................................................................................. 9-4
9.2.7 SUPPLEME�TAL SPECIFICATIO�S & SPECIFICATIO� AME�DME�TS .............................. 9-5
9.2.8 BID ITEMS QUA�TITY A�D COST ESTIMATES ......................................................................... 9-5
9.2.9 PLA�S ............................................................................................................................................ 9-5
9.2.10 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS .................................................................................................... 9-6
9.3 SUPPLY OF AGGREGATE .................................................................................................................. 9-6
9.3.1 AGGREGATE SOURCES ............................................................................................................... 9-6
9.3.1.1 General ........................................................................................................................................................ 9-6
9.3.1.2 Aggregate Data Summary Request .............................................................................................................. 9-6
TABLE OF COTETS
�ovember 2011 v
9.3.1.3 Payment for Supply of Aggregate ................................................................................................................ 9-7
9.3.1.4 Pit Reclamation ........................................................................................................................................... 9-8
9.3.1.5 Aggregate Source Controlled by the Department ........................................................................................ 9-8
9.3.1.6 Tender Package Requirements for Aggregates ............................................................................................ 9-9
SECTIO� 10 - BRIDGE PLA��I�G, DESIG� A�D I�SPECTIO� .................................................. 10-1
10.1 DESIGN STANDARDS ........................................................................................................................10-1
10.2 ENGINEERING DRAWINGS ..............................................................................................................10-1
10.3 INDEPENDENT DESIGN CHECK .....................................................................................................10-1
10.4 BRIDGE SURVEYS .............................................................................................................................10-2
10.4.1 BE�CH MARKS ........................................................................................................................... 10-2
10.5 RIGHT-OF-WAY REQUESTS FOR STAND ALONE BRIDGE PROJECTS ....................................10-2
10.6 STAKEHOLDER INPUT .....................................................................................................................10-2
10.7 APPROVALS, LICENSES, AND PERMITS .......................................................................................10-2
10.8 SUBMISSIONS OF DRAWINGS AND REPORTS ............................................................................10-2
10.9 BRIDGE ENGINEERING WEBSITE ..................................................................................................10-3
10.10 BRIDGE PLANNING AND ASSESSMENTS .................................................................................10-3
10.10.1 ASSESSME�TS ......................................................................................................................... 10-3
10.10.2 I�PUT TO FU�CTIO�AL PLA��I�G STUDIES ................................................................... 10-4
10.10.3 BRIDGE PLA��I�G ................................................................................................................ 10-4
10.10.4 SUMMARY OF REPORTI�G A�D SUBMISSIO� REQUIREME�TS .................................... 10-5
10.11 BRIDGE STRUCTURAL ENGINEERING .....................................................................................10-5
10.11.1 STRUCTURAL ALTER�ATIVES A�ALYSIS............................................................................ 10-5
10.11.2 DETAILED STRUCTURAL DESIG� ....................................................................................... 10-6
10.11.3 SUMMARY OF REPORTI�G A�D SUBMISSIO� REQUIREME�TS .................................... 10-6
10.12 MATERIAL FABRICATION AND BRIDGE CONSTRUCTION INSPECTION ..........................10-7
10.12.1 SHOP DRAWI�GS ................................................................................................................... 10-7
10.12.2 RECORD DRAWI�GS .............................................................................................................. 10-7
SECTIO� 11 - CO�TRACT TE�DERI�G ............................................................................................ 11-1
11.1 DESIGN AND TENDER PACKAGE ...................................................................................................11-1
11.1.1 GE�ERAL ..................................................................................................................................... 11-1
11.1.2 DESIG� A�D TE�DER PACKAGE SUBMISSIO� REQUIREME�TS ...................................... 11-1
11.1.2.1 Covering Letter ..................................................................................................................................... 11-1
11.1.2.2 Design Submission ................................................................................................................................ 11-2
11.1.2.3 Tender Documents ................................................................................................................................ 11-3
11.1.2.4 Separate Plans and Drawings; Reference Drawings (if applicable) ....................................................... 11-4
11.1.2.5 Design Cross-Sections (if applicable) ................................................................................................... 11-5
11.1.2.6 Additional Information Documents (if applicable) ............................................................................... 11-6
11.1.3 TE�DER DOCUME�T PACKAGE ............................................................................................. 11-6
11.1.4 STA�DARD SPECIFICATIO�S, SPECIAL PROVISIO�S, SPECIFICATIO� AME�DME�TS
A�D SUPPLEME�TAL SPECIFICATIO�S ................................................................................................ 11-7
11.1.5 ADDE�DA ................................................................................................................................... 11-7
11.1.6 MATERIALS ................................................................................................................................. 11-8
11.1.7 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS .................................................................................................. 11-8
11.1.8 CO�SULTA�T SERVICES DURI�G THE TE�DER PERIOD ................................................... 11-8
SECTIO� 12 - WATER CO�TROL STRUCTURES PLA��I�G A�D DESIG� ............................. 12-1
12.1 GENERAL.............................................................................................................................................12-1
12.2 DESIGN STANDARDS AND GUIDELINES ......................................................................................12-1
12.3 INDEPENDENT DESIGN CHECK .....................................................................................................12-1
12.4 SURVEYS .............................................................................................................................................12-2
12.5 LAND ACQUISITION REQUIREMENTS ..........................................................................................12-2
12.6 APPROVALS, LICENSES AND PERMITS ........................................................................................12-2
12.7 CONSTRUCTION CONTRACT SPECIFICATIONS .........................................................................12-3
12.8 ENGINEERING DRAWING STANDARDS .......................................................................................12-3
12.9 CONCEPTUAL STUDY.......................................................................................................................12-3
TABLE OF COTETS
�ovember 2011 vi
12.9.1 STUDIES ...................................................................................................................................... 12-3
12.9.2 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS .................................................................................................. 12-4
12.10 PRELIMINARY ENGINEERING ................................................................................................... 12-4
12.10.1 STUDIES .................................................................................................................................. 12-4
12.10.2 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS .............................................................................................. 12-5
12.11 FINAL DESIGN ............................................................................................................................... 12-5
12.11.1 DESIG� ACTIVITIES ............................................................................................................... 12-5
12.11.2 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS .............................................................................................. 12-6
12.12 CONTRACT TENDERING ............................................................................................................. 12-6
12.12.1 SITE MEETI�G ........................................................................................................................ 12-6
12.12.2 TE�DER I�QUIRIES ............................................................................................................... 12-6
I�DEX
TABLE OF COTETS
�ovember 2011 vii
APPE�DICES
APPE�DIX A General Engineering Processes for Management of Alberta’s Highways and
Bridges, December 2008
� General Outline of the Engineering Processes from Long Range Planning to
Construction Completion for Provincial Highways
� Flow Diagram of Highway Engineering Process
� Process of Notification of Provincial Highway Construction Projects to
Municipalities
APPE�DIX B Typical Agenda for Consultant Initialization Meeting � Consultant Initialization Meeting – Provincial Highway Project’s Agenda
APPE�DIX C Summary Table of Commonly Used Forms
� Accident Notification
� Utility Accident Report
� ATVs Use for Field Surveys
� Request for Bridge Corporate Information
� Payment Voucher Directions & Completion Guide
� Design Standards/Practice Exception Request Form
APPE�DIX D Planning Requirements
� Planning Study Types
� Mosaic Production
� Basic Right-of-Way Request
� Right-of-Way Request Form
� Right-of-Way Process Acquisition Summary
� Historical Resources Overview Scope of Work
� Environmental Assessment Requirements
� Location Survey Requirements
� Typical Planning Study Process for Major Functional Planning Studies
� Communications Procedures for Open Houses
APPE�DIX E Consultant Highway Grading/Surfacing Design Coordination Flow Diagram
APPE�DIX F Surfacing Criteria
� Surfacing Design Estimate
� Spread Rate Guidelines for First Course Gravel Surfacing Design
� Guidelines for Selecting Type of Seal Coat on a Paved Surface
� Surfacing Estimate Worksheet
� Surfacing Estimate Schematics
� Surfacing Estimate Typicals
� Surfacing Estimates
� Surfacing Estimate Summary
� Approximate Distribution of Major Haul-Related Materials
� Details of Widths and Thicknesses
APPE�DIX G Supply of Aggregates
� Aggregates Data Summary Request
� Sample of Plans for Tender Document
� Pit Plan
� Aggregate Testing Plan
� Enlarged Aggregate Testing Plan (area to be mined)
TABLE OF COTETS
�ovember 2011 viii
APPE�DIX H Utility Adjustment Agreements (Sample)
� Sample 1 – Letter of Notification
� Sample 2 – Letter Requesting for Cost Estimate
� Sample 3 – Letter of Confirmation of Cost Estimate and Signing Agreements
(Telecommunication and Power company)
� Sample 4 – Letter of Confirmation of Cost Estimate and Signing Agreements
(Pipeline Company)
� Sample 5 – Roadway Upgrading Pipeline Crossing Agreement
(Pipeline Adjustment is required)
� Sample 6 – Roadway Upgrading Pipeline Crossing Agreement
(Pipeline Adjustment is not required)
� Sample 7 – New Roadway over Existing Pipeline Crossing Agreement
� Sample 8 – Letter of Confirmation of Cost Estimate
(New Railway Crossing)
� Sample 9 – Letter of Confirmation of Cost Estimate
(Existing Railway Crossing Upgrading)
� Sample 10 – Letter of Confirmation of Commencement of Construction
� Sample 11 – Utility agreement with ATCO Electric Ltd.
� Sample 12 – Roadway Upgrading Pipeline Crossing Agreement with ATCO
Pipeline Ltd. or ATCO Gas Ltd.
(with or without Pipeline Adjustment is required)
APPE�DIX I Sample Estimates and Summary
� “A” Estimate
� “B” Estimate
� “C” Estimate
� “D” Summary
APPE�DIX J1 Bridge Design Processes and Data Requirements
� Bridge Design Process Chart
� Bridge Project Process
� Requirements for Design Data Drawings
� Process Forms
� Bridge Choose Design
� Bridge Design Completion
� Design Project Brief
� Corporate Data Requirements for Bridge Projects Project Summary
APPE�DIX J2 Qualifications for Bridge Materials Fabrication Inspection
� Pre-stressed Pre-cast Concrete Girder/Units
� Miscellaneous Material (Including Culverts)
� Major Steel Components
APPE�DIX J3 Qualifications for Bridge Construction Inspection and Bridge Painting
Inspection
APPE�DIX K Records Management by Consultants on Projects
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-1
SECTIO� 1 - GE�ERAL
1.1 I�TRODUCTIO�
These guidelines, appendices and references shall be used for the provision of
engineering services on all Provincial highway, bridge and water management
projects where a Consultant is hired directly by the Department. These guidelines may
also be used when stipulated for projects not undertaken directly by the Department
but where the funding agency (whole or partial funding) is Alberta Transportation.
Where a discrepancy exists between this document and the documents prepared
specifically for a project, for example the Terms of Reference for a project, the latter
shall take precedence. Because of the evolving nature of standards, guidelines,
legislation, regulations, specifications and engineering practices, it is impractical to
expect all the contents of this document and the documents referenced to be up-to-
date. The Consultant is responsible for using current standards, design codes and
guidelines and for ensuring that all current legislation and regulations are being
followed. A list of current Federal and Alberta Provincial legislation and regulations
that are relevant to highway planning, design, construction and operations is
contained on the Department website. This list is not all-inclusive.
In the event of discrepancies, the hierarchy of documents shall be as follows, in
descending order:
� Legislation and Regulations
� Consulting Services Contract1
� Terms of Reference1
� Engineering Technical Standards1, Warrants1 and Processes
� “Engineering Consultant Guidelines for Highway, Bridge, and Water Projects”
In keeping with a spirit of innovation, the Department is interested in hearing
innovative proposals from Consultants at the ‘Request for Proposal’ stage, if it is
apparent that projects can be undertaken more efficiently or effectively using an
alternative approach rather than that outlined in the Terms of Reference. This spirit of
innovation will be encouraged by Department staff when developing Terms of
Reference for a project, and when evaluating proposals that have been submitted.
The Prime Consultant retained by the Department is responsible for the engineering
integrity and professional liability of all work performed under their Contract,
including work by any Sub-Consultant. The checking of the Consultant’s or Sub-
Consultant’s work by the Department or the signing of drawings by Department staff
does not relieve the Consultant from any responsibility for the work. Therefore these
1 See Section 1.1.1 - Definitions
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-2
guidelines will generally use the terminology of “acceptance” rather than “approval”
when referring to engineering issues submitted to the Department by the Consultant.
1.1.1 DEFI�ITIO�S
The following words, when used in this document, shall have the meaning as defined
below:
Acceptance Work is accepted by the Department without detailed
checking of the engineering principles and calculations.
Alberta Land Surveyor A person registered to perform land surveys in the
Province of Alberta.
Approval The subject work shall be “approved” by the Department
for matters relating to things such as Department policy,
funding, contract extensions or over-runs, right-of-way
purchase, or Contract Design Change Proposals. The
Department will also review and approve Design
Exceptions as required (see Section 1.6.1).
Bridge Assessment A formal review of bridge condition, functionality
controlling issues and technical parameters with respect
to the crossing and roadway approaches. A key objective
is to identify optimum strategies for preservation,
rehabilitation or potential reconstruction of the crossing
over the life cycle of the structure. See Appendix J1 for
more details.
Bridge Planning An engineering process for bridges undertaken prior to
the structural design phase including but not limited to
bridge assessment, functional planning, geometric
design, hydrotechnical design, site location and survey,
environmental determinations, preliminary geotechnical
investigation and development of optimized concepts for
advancement to structural design.
Bridge Structures Consist of:
� Bridge Size Culverts - structures that are completely
surrounded by soil and located below the surface of the
roadway parallel to the general direction of the stream
flow. All bridge size culverts are defined as having an
equivalent flow area of 1500 mm or more.
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-3
� Standard Bridges - bridge structures built using
standard plans. Typically standard bridge construction
comprises standard precast girders and steel or
concrete abutments (and piers when applicable)
supported on steel piles, but excludes new precast
girder bridges with a composite cast-in-place concrete
deck (e.g. standard SLC bridges).
� Major Bridges - all other bridge structures including
large or complex culverts. Major bridges are typically
built from site-specific drawings, but can also be built
from standard drawings (e.g. standard SLC bridges).
Typically major bridges are river crossings, highway
interchanges or railway crossings.
Checker
The Professional Engineer who conducts an independent
check of the Design Drawings.
Consultant The person or company that has entered a consulting
services contract with the Department.
Consulting Services
Contract
The contract between the Department and the Consultant
for the provision of services on Department projects.
Construction Contract The contract between the Department and the Contractor
covering the performance of the work.
Contract Design
Change Proposal
An alternate design or a design modification to the
Department’s tendered design or a component thereof. If
required, the Contractor shall submit this proposal
(through the Department’s Project Sponsor) after the
tender is awarded.
Contractor The person or company that has entered into a
construction contract with the Department.
Department Alberta Transportation.
Designer
The Professional Engineer who takes professional
responsibility for the Design Drawings.
Design Data (DD)
Drawings
Design Data Drawings are bridge engineering drawings
that provide all significant pre-design information for
use in structural design or associated river engineering,
as well as recording and illustrating all relevant bridge
planning information.
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-4
Design Drawings
Drawings that encompass any original designs or design
changes. These drawings shall be authenticated by both
the Designer and Checker indicating that the design has
been prepared in accordance with all appropriate
engineering and Departmental Standards.
Design Exception An instance where a designer has chosen to use a
parameter or product which is different from the
prevailing practice. Documentation of the rationale used
for the design exception must be filed as part of the
design tender package for future reference.
Design Package Includes grading, surfacing, and bridge design packages
which are used as the basis for preparation of the
contract tender. It generally includes the detailed design
calculations, notes to the Project Manager, Utility
Agreements, environmental permits, etc. The completed
and independently checked package is normally
submitted to the Project Sponsor. A sign-off letter is
prepared by the Consultant for the Project Sponsor’s
signature for submission to Professional Services
Section prior to tendering.
ECO plan The Environmental Construction Operations plan
consists of plans and written procedures that address
environmental protection issues relevant to the specific
activity being performed during construction of a
project.
Engineering
Assessment
A formal assessment of various technical and safety
parameters and/or performance data generally using a
predefined methodology or warrant system. An
engineering assessment is generally undertaken early in
the construction programming cycle to allow the scope-
of-work to be accurately estimated.
Examples of engineering assessments are Geometric
Assessment, Safety Assessment, Surfacing Strategy, etc.
See Section 5 for more details.
Estimates
“A” Estimate A “Program/Planning Estimate”, which is a “Ball Park”
estimate, to be prepared before any design calculations
are completed.
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-5
For roadway grading, base, and paving projects the “A”
Estimate may be based on a typical cost per kilometre all
inclusive cost (including engineering, materials costs,
right-of-way, utilities, mobilization, contract costs, etc.)
from past experience of average cost in the vicinity. The
“A” Estimate may be refined after an Engineering
Assessment has been completed.
For bridge structures, this estimate is usually produced at
the Functional Planning stage and is usually based on the
typical square metre cost for the overall deck area.
See Appendix I for an example.
“B” Estimate A “Preliminary “B” Grading Design Estimate” is
prepared when preliminary earthwork quantities have
been established after 1 or 2 computer runs have been
made. A Preliminary “B” Surfacing Estimate is prepared
when the surfacing strategy has been established. These
estimates may be updated one or more times before the
“C” estimate is prepared.
Each subsequent “B” Estimate submission for either
roads or bridges needs to be identified as “B1”, “B2”,
“B3”, etc. estimate when a greater accuracy is identified
at a later stage of design. The number will designate
generation or occurrence.
For bridge structures, the “B” Estimate is usually
produced at the Choose Design stage for each alternative
structure type after overall dimensions are established
(out to out, width, etc.). The “B” Estimate should be
based on itemized quantities and unit prices resulting
from preliminary sizing of the structural elements and be
sufficiently accurate to allow a reasonable comparison of
viable options.
See Appendix I for an example.
“C” Estimate A Final Design Estimate which is to be prepared when
the Grading Estimate Summary” and the Surfacing
Estimate Summary have been completed for roadway
grading, base and paving projects. Typically this
estimate is produced after the final design is completed.
For Bridge structures, the “C" Estimate is produced
when the tender drawings and estimated quantities are
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-6
available. Refer to Section 11 for more details.
See Appendix I for an example.
“D” Summary An estimate produced when the actual tender prices are
known.
See Appendix I for an example.
Field Review Engineer
The Professional Engineer who takes responsibility for
assuring that the finished construction substantially
complies with the Design Drawings and the contract
specifications.
Final Details Describes the package of information that must be
compiled and submitted at the completion of
construction work. A detailed description of the
requirements of Final Details for roads and bridges is
provided in the “Engineering Consultant Guidelines for
Highway and Bridge Projects – Volume 2 –
Construction Contract Administration”. Record
drawings for each roadway and bridge project are to be
included as part of the Final Details.
A Final Details Report is required for each bridge file
where construction or rehabilitation work is undertaken
as stipulated in Volume 2.
FOIP
Government of Alberta legislation entitled “Freedom of
Information and Protection of Privacy Act”.
Preliminary
Engineering
An engineering exercise undertaken early in the detailed
design process, the purpose of which is to gather
preliminary site surveys, geotechnical and other
information used and reaffirm the key design parameters
that should be used on the project.
In cases where a Planning Study and/or Engineering
Assessment has been undertaken for the project the
Preliminary Engineering process will involve
“revisiting” the previously made recommendations. On
projects where there is no Planning or Engineering
Assessment available, the Preliminary Engineering
exercise will involve establishing the key design
parameters based on normal Department practices.
See Section 6 for more details.
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-7
Professional Engineer A person registered to practice engineering in the
Province of Alberta under the APEGGA Act.
Project Administrator A Department employee who has been designated by the
Project Sponsor to administer the Project on a day to day
basis.
Project Co-Sponsor A Department employee primarily responsible for a
particular component of work, such as highway or
bridge work.
Project Design Brief A document that is completed by the Consultant for
major bridge projects. The document lists salient points
and design assumptions prior to any detailed design
work. The purpose of the document is to ensure that the
Consultant and the Department agree on the main design
assumptions before the design progresses to detailed
work. An example of a brief is included in Appendix J1.
A blank brief will be made available to the Consultant at
the project initialization meeting.
Project Sponsor The Department employee appointed by the Department
to be responsible for the delivery of the project. The
Project Sponsor is the Department’s Senior Manager
responsible for the Project/Assignment.
Record Drawings Drawings that represent the completed constructed
project (previously referred to as As-Constructed
Drawings/Details). Record drawings shall be
authenticated by the Field Review Engineer indicating
that the constructed product substantially complies with
the Design Drawings and all appropriate Contract Plans
and Specifications.
Request for Proposal A formal document that includes a cover letter defining
the preparation of the proposal, the basic insurance
requirements expected of the Consultant and has the
Terms of Reference attached to it.
A Request for Proposal system seeks the best value
through open competition or the competition of short-
listed proponents, and, most importantly, it is a system
which provides for both objective and justifiable reasons
for its choices.
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-8
Road Drainage
Culverts
Culverts with an equivalent diameter of less than 1.5 m
and which are included with the road design package.
Sub-Consultant A person or company that enters into an agreement with
the Consultant to carry out part or all of the work
covered in the consulting services contract.
Technical Standards,
Guidelines and
Warrants
Technical References and other Department documents
listed on the Department website.
Tender Package The end product of the design phase of the project. This
package normally includes tender documents, plans,
design summaries, cost estimates and covering memos.
Terms of Reference A document outlining the description of the assignment,
the scope of the work, schedules and expected
deliverables.
1.2 WORKERS COMPE�SATIO� BOARD A�D OCCUPATIO�AL
HEALTH A�D SAFETY
1.2.1 GE�ERAL
The Consultant’s responsibilities under the Occupation Health and Safety Act are
defined in the Consulting Services Contract as follows:
The Consultant shall familiarize themselves, their staff and their sub-consultants with
the terms of the “Occupational Health and Safety Act” and Regulations to ensure
complete understanding of the responsibilities given and compliance required. The
Consultant acknowledges and accepts all of the responsibilities and duties of the
Prime Contractor as defined in the “Occupational Health and Safety Act”.
The Prime Contractor shall, to the extent required by the “Occupational Health and
Safety Act”, establish and maintain a Health and Safety system or process to ensure
compliance to the Act and Regulations by sub-consultants. The Consultant shall also,
to his satisfaction, ensure that any sub-consultants are able to comply with all health
and safety regulations before commencing work.
As the Department representative on site, the Consultant will communicate with
Contractors and Utilities Companies and may have to arbitrate disputes between them
when they are working in the vicinity of each other.
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-9
1.2.2 WORKSITE HAZARD
The Consultant has the responsibility to identify worksite hazards and shall develop
operational occupational safety policies, procedures and plans which are specific to
the work being performed to ensure the safety of workers, whether employed by the
Consultant or Sub-Consultant(s). The impact of the public traveling through the site
must be considered when developing these plans (if applicable). When requested by
the Department, the Consultant shall provide copies of these safety policies,
procedures and plans to the Department prior to the commencement of the work,
along with verification that they have been submitted to Workplace Health and
Safety.
If Workplace Health and Safety conducts a worksite inspection which results in
“orders” being issued to the Consultant, the Consultant shall immediately supply
copies of these orders to the Project Sponsor or the Department Safety Officer.
In cases of recognized imminent danger or when the Consultant fails to comply with
safety orders issued or fails to rectify previously identified worksite hazards, the
Project Sponsor, a Department Safety Officer or any other authorized Department
representative will order the cessation of the work until it is safe for the work to
resume. Their interpretation of a worksite hazard will be considered as final in all
cases.
1.2.3 ACCIDE�T I�VESTIGATIO� AT THE WORKSITE
In the event of an injury or accident involving workers of the Consultant, or his/her
Sub-Consultant, at the worksite as defined by the “Occupational Health and Safety
Act”, the Consultant shall conduct an accident investigation where required by
Section 18 of the “Occupational Health and Safety Act”. In addition, the Consultant
shall supply a copy of this investigation report and obtain copies of the Contractors
accident reports to the Project Sponsor within 72 hours of knowledge of the
occurrence.
Where there is a worksite accident involving the Contractor’s personnel, the
Contractor shall conduct the investigation and the Consultant shall submit a copy of
the investigation report to the Project Sponsor within 72 hours of knowledge of the
occurrence.
1.2.4 SAFETY CERTIFICATE OF RECOG�ITIO�
The Department will only prequalify and award assignments to Consultants who have
achieved accreditation/recognition in a Safety Certification Program which is relevant
to their industry and which is recognized by Alberta Employment and Immigration,
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-10
Workplace Health and Safety. Accreditation/recognition will be in the form of a
Certificate of Recognition in Health and Safety (COR). A small employer’s certificate
of recognition (SECOR) is not acceptable.
Consultants shall submit proof of accreditation with their annual pre-qualification.
The Department may verify the Consultant’s compliance with this requirement
through the Alberta Construction Safety Association (ACSA) at any time, and any
firm found not to have current accreditation will have their pre-qualification
rescinded.
It is the prospective Consultant’s responsibility to ensure that their registration in the
program is properly documented with the Alberta Construction Safety Association,
and the Department will assume no liability for errors or omissions by the Alberta
Construction Safety Association in this regard.
For Consultants that have not obtained a Certificate of Recognition in Health and
Safety, a valid Temporary Letter of Certification (TLC) issued by Alberta
Construction Safety Association will be considered acceptable.
1.3 PUBLIC SAFETY REQUIREME�TS (TRAFFIC
ACCOMMODATIO� THROUGH THE WORK ZO�E)
1.3.1 GE�ERAL
Accommodation of traffic may be required at any time through the planning,
preliminary engineering, design, construction, and post construction phases. Refer to
“Engineering Consultant Guidelines for Highway and Bridge Projects – Volume 2 –
Construction Contract Administration” on procedures for traffic accommodation
operations.
Traffic control devices shall be constructed, installed and maintained in accordance
with the Department’s latest version of the “Traffic Accommodation in Work Zones”
manual.
The Consultant shall be responsible for identifying situations that will require special
traffic accommodation procedures to be implemented. These situations could involve
major utility or pipeline relocations, bridge construction, the need to accommodate
high traffic volumes, major grade line changes, lane closures, etc.
If traffic control is found to be inadequate, the Consultant shall take appropriate and
timely action to rectify the situation.
� Planning, Preliminary Engineering, and Design Phase
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-11
During planning, design, preliminary and legal survey operations, geotechnical
work such as test holes/test piles the Consultant shall be responsible for provision
of suitable traffic accommodation measures.
Preparation of traffic accommodation plans showing signing, delineation, traffic
lanes, etc., for all detours, diversions or partial road closures, shall be undertaken
by the Consultant.
The Consultant shall install and maintain any required traffic control devices.
� Construction Phase
Please refer to the latest version of “Traffic Accommodation in Work Zones”
manual.
1.3.1.1 Flagperson
When the Consultant is undertaking surveying/engineering/inspection/field
reconnaissance/field investigation operations that may cause interruption, delay or
hazards to the travelling public or anyone on the worksite, qualified flagpersons shall
be provided as required for the direction and control of traffic. The Consultant shall
ensure that flagpersons are instructed in the use of proper traffic control procedures
appropriate for the prevailing conditions. Flagpersons shall have proof of certification
from a recognized training program on traffic control procedures through construction
zones. The Department currently only recognizes traffic control programs
administered by the Alberta Construction Safety Association.
Flagpersons shall be dressed in accordance with the information and minimum
standards in the “Traffic Accommodation in Work Zones” manual.
1.3.2 ACCIDE�T I�VESTIGATIO� WITHI� THE PROJECT LIMIT
Should any third party accident involving highway users (vehicular or pedestrian)
occur within the project limits, the Consultant shall investigate the accident and
provide the Project Sponsor with a report on the prescribed forms within 72 hours of
knowledge of the occurrence. If a fatal or major accident involving serious personal
injury or major property damage occurs, the Consultant shall immediately notify the
Project Sponsor or the Department Safety Officer of the incident. The accident report
will include a record of conditions at the time of the accident, photos, description of
all pertinent signing and other traffic control devices in place at the time. The “Report
of Motor Vehicle Traffic Collisions Occurring in Construction Zones” form is
available in the “Engineering Consultant Guidelines for Highway and Bridge Projects
– Volume 2 – Construction Contract Administration”.
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-12
1.4 OTHER GE�ERAL REQUIREME�TS
1.4.1 PROFESSIO�AL REGISTRATIO�
All Consultants engaged to provide engineering services for the Department shall be
registered with the Association of Professional Engineers, Geologists and
Geophysicists of Alberta (APEGGA) and shall abide by the Association's regulations,
code of ethics and by-laws.
Land surveyors who are doing legal surveys for the Department must be registered
Alberta Land Surveyors.
1.4.2 PROFESSIO�AL SEAL
The Consultant shall sign, seal and date all plans, drawings, specifications, designs,
data and any other engineering documents they produce, check and/or approve. The
seal shall consist of the APEGGA member stamp or seal and the permit stamp.
1.4.3 CO�STRUCTIO� SPECIFICATIO�S A�D CO�TRACT
CO�DITIO�S
The current edition of the Department's “Standard Specifications for Highway
Construction”, “Specification Amendments and Supplemental Specifications for
Highway Construction”, “Standard Drawings for Highway Construction” and
“Specifications for Bridge Construction” shall apply to all construction contracts.
They may be modified and supplemented by special provisions, plans, specification
amendments, or supplemental specifications.
The Consultant shall be the engineering representative engaged to administer
construction contracts on behalf of the Department. The Consultant cannot change
any condition of the contract between the Department and the Contractor.
1.4.4 FIRST �ATIO� CO�SULTATIO�
1.4.4.1 First �ation Consultation For Projects on Indian Reserves
For those projects where land is required from Indian Reserves the Department has a
legal duty to uphold the "honour of the Crown" by consulting with First Nations. The
Project Sponsor, with the assistance of the Consultant, shall complete the necessary
consultation in order to satisfy federal consultation requirements. During construction,
the Department does allow the use of First Nations labour, equipment, and material
resource supply (through mutual agreement with the First Nation jurisdiction) when
undertaking construction activity through Indian Reserves.
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-13
1.4.4.2 First �ation Consultation For Projects Outside Indian Reserves
The department has a legal duty to uphold the "honour of the Crown" by consulting
with First Nations as required by the Supreme Court of Canada in consideration of
aboriginal and treaty rights that are recognized and affirmed in Section 35 of the
“Constitution Act”. Although there is no legal obligation to consult with respect to
non-treaty uses, Alberta has made a policy commitment to consult when the Crown
decision making has the potential to adversely impact these uses. To meet this legal
duty and policy commitments made by the Alberta provincial Crown, the Department
must consult with First Nations when the Department's decisions have the potential to
adversely impact Rights and Traditional Uses. The Project Sponsor, with the
assistance of the Consultant, shall complete the necessary consultation procedures as
outlined in “Draft Alberta First Nations Consultation Procedures Manual”. This
document will provide the guidance required on the issue of First Nations
consultation for the planning, design, and construction phases.
1.4.4.3 Federal Government First �ation Consulting Requirements
In addition to the First Nation consultation requirements outlined in the “Draft
Alberta First Nations Consultation Procedures Manual”, the federal government also
has First Nation consultation requirements. It is essential that discussions regarding
First Nations consultation with the relevant federal departments (e.g. Department of
Fisheries and Oceans/Transport Canada) occur early in the process so that any
additional consultation requirements that may be required are incorporated into the
project as necessary.
The Consultant is required, in the earliest stages of the project, to identify to the
Project Sponsor those federal agencies that need to be contacted regarding First
Nations consultation requirements and to assist the Project Sponsor in fulfilling any
subsequent obligations as a result of those discussions.
1.4.5 RECORDS, FREEDOM OF I�FORMATIO�, A�D PROTECTIO� OF
PRIVACY ACT
Any information collected or generated by a Consultant, when providing engineering
services, is the sole property of the Department. This information is subject to the
Records Management Regulations of the Government and the FOIP Act. Refer to
Appendix K to ensure that records are retained accordingly. When asked to give out
information the Consultant must contact the Project Sponsor prior to doing so, in
order that the FOIP Act is not violated in regards to privacy and personal information.
Refer to Appendix C for a sample request for Corporate Bridge Information form.
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-14
1.4.6 MA�UALS
All guidelines, manuals, or other documents referred to in these standards are the
current edition or version unless specifically noted. Refer to the Department website
for a listing of documents available for sale at the time of writing.
1.4.7 DUPLICATI�G
The Executive Director, Program Management Branch, hereby gives permission for
the Consultant to copy these guidelines solely for use within the firm.
1.4.8 UPDATES
Updated information related to Design and/or Construction is released by the
Department through Design Bulletins and Construction Bulletins respectively. These
bulletins are made available to consultants and others through the Department’s
website. Bulletins are numbered sequentially and dated. The Bulletins will continue to
be displayed until the information is superseded either by a more permanent document
(e.g. Design Guide, Specification, etc.) or when more current information comes into
use.
The Department will update these guidelines on an as required basis. Updates are
normally done through the rewrite of the complete document on a regular basis
(usually every 3 years). The Consultant shall ensure that the most recent version of the
guidelines is used on all projects.
Consultants are required to monitor the Design and Construction Bulletins on a
regular basis to ensure that they are following the latest Department practices. At the
time of writing the web addresses for the bulletins are as follows:
Design Bulletins:
www.transportation.alberta.ca/649.htm
Construction Bulletins:
www.transportation.alberta.ca/920.htm
1.4.9 WEBSITE
The Department’s web address is www.transportation.alberta.ca.
A search engine is available on the website to assist in locating information.
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-15
1.5 RESPO�SIBILITIES
1.5.1 GE�ERAL
The Consultant shall complete the assignment as described in the Consulting Services
Contract. The Consultant shall also monitor all aspects of health and safety on the
project. The Department will tender and award all construction contracts, and will
administer holdback, contract security, public work act claims, and be involved in
settlement of construction contract related claims (in consultation with the
Consultant).
The Consultant shall supply all personnel, materials, and equipment required to
provide the services in accordance with these guidelines.
The Consultant shall be responsible for all work performed under the Consulting
Services Contract, including work done by any Sub-Consultants.
1.5.2 CHA�GES TO SCOPE OF WORK FOR E�GI�EERI�G
ASSIG�ME�T
Any changes in the scope of work or the Terms of Reference of the Consulting
Services Contract that impacts upon the time frame or costs of the project shall be
brought to the attention of the Project Sponsor by the Consultant. These changes to
the scope of work shall be in writing including the estimated costs and shall be
submitted as soon as they become apparent, for review and approval. Scope changes
having impact on engineering costs of the project will be recorded on the cost control
sheet submitted with the invoices.
�OTE: Except for emergency situations, the Consultant shall not proceed unless an
authorization to do the work is given by the Project Sponsor.
1.5.3 BACKGROU�D I�FORMATIO�
The Consultant shall identify and review all historic records, archives and information
relating to the project. The Department’s files and archives will be available for
the Consultant’s review and use. A “Request for Corporate Bridge Information” form
indicating record types, storage areas, and the contact persons are included in
Appendix C.
Electronic reporting is to be used when available and Department programs will be
made available to Consultants unless restricted by licensing or other requirements.
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-16
1.5.4 LIAISO�
For each project, a Project Sponsor will be appointed by the Department to act as the
liaison between the Department and the Consultant. The Project Sponsor will have the
overall responsibility of ensuring that the work is planned, coordinated, and executed
in accordance with the Consulting Services Contract. The Project Sponsor will liaise
between the Consultant and the various branches within the Department to resolve
any administrative, technical or contractual matters.
1.5.5 PROJECT I�ITIALIZATIO�
The Project Sponsor is responsible for ensuring that each activity and phase of the
work is completed as scheduled. To do this, prior to any work commencing on a
project, the Project Sponsor will normally call a Project Initialization Meeting with
the Consultant, the Department Safety Officer, and any appropriate specialist staff
from the Department to clarify the assignment, expectations and staff roles, the scope
of the work, the safety strategy, the reporting requirements (during planning or design
work as identified in the Terms of Reference), the standards to be used, the time
frame for the overall project, as well as any significant milestone dates within that
time frame for specific activities. Project Administration information such as
Consulting Contract number, work activity codes, jobcoster numbers, sample forms,
revised procedures, etc. will also be made available to the Consultant at this meeting.
The Project Sponsor will advise the Consultant of all issues that may affect the
Consultants work plan (e.g. tendering schedule, right-of-way negotiations, borrow
purchase). See Appendix B for Sample Agenda Items and the Project Administration
Manual (P.A.M.) for other details.
1.5.6 APPROVAL OR ACCEPTA�CE
The following, and other unforeseen matters, shall be referred to the Project Sponsor
for approval or acceptance unless authority is delegated elsewhere:
� Approval
� Change of Project Personnel
� Public participation programs
� Planning report
� Roadway preliminary engineering report
� Significant changes to project funding requirements
� Property Agreements
� Design Exceptions (before or after tender)
� Design Changes (before or after tender)
� Changes to scope of work and fee increases
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-17
� Specified start and/or completion dates for the contract and any other
conditions related to construction schedules
� Bridge assessments and bridge planning concept meeting
� Contract Design Change Proposals
� Unit prices for bid items that were not included in the original tender
� Contract claims resolution
� Extra work (as per the Departments Authorities Matrix)
� Contract Payments
� Contract over-runs
� Contract extensions
� Railway Crossing Agreements
� Utility Crossing Agreements
� Public Advertising on behalf of the Department
� Site occupancy changes
� Acceptance
� Environmental permits, licenses, and investigations
� Engineering Assessment Report (see Section 5)
� Bridge and bridge culvert design package
� Utility plans and adjustment methods
� Other Contract and Design Changes (prior to tender)
� Electronic file formats
� Geotechnical investigation and report
� Grading design package
� Surfacing design package
� Final project design, cost estimates and tender package
� Progress and Final Payment for Construction Contracts
� Final Details
� Final Bridge Planning Summary Report
1.5.7 COST ESTIMATES
Accurate and timely submission of cost estimates including current unit costs is
important for the Department’s programming function.
The Consultant shall provide the following cost estimates:
� Planning Stage
� “A” Preliminary cost estimates with all planning studies and bridge
assessments
� Design Stage
� “B” cost estimates on completion of preliminary designs
� “C” cost estimates on completion of final design with tender packages
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-18
� “D” cost summary after contract award (for bridge structures only)
� Utility relocation and adjustment estimates
� Surfacing estimate
� Grading design estimate
� Tender package cost summary
� Construction Stage
� Progress and final estimates
� Refer to Engineering Consultant Guidelines for Highway and Bridge Projects
– Volume 2 – Construction Contract Administration for more details.
1.5.8 I�DEPE�DE�T DESIG� CHECK
The Consultant shall undertake an independent check of all designs, Contract Tender
Package, drawings, and final details by a qualified and experienced Professional
Engineer, prior to submission of the work to the Department. Tender estimates and
progress estimates shall be prepared and independently checked by either a qualified
and experienced engineer or technologist. All documents and drawings shall show the
names and/or signatures of persons responsible for design and checking. This
independent design check shall be carried out by another Consultant when the design
Consultant does not have adequate in-house capabilities to provide this check.
For Independent Design Check of bridge planning and bridge structural design, also
refer to Section 10.3.
1.5.9 REVIEW OF WORK BY THE DEPARTME�T
Any review of the Consultant’s work, signing of drawings and the acceptance of
documents by Department staff does not relieve the Consultant from any
responsibility for errors or omissions by the Consultant.
1.5.10 CO�SULTA�T PERFORMA�CE EVALUATIO�
At the project initialization meeting, the Project Sponsor will advise the Consultant of
appropriate form(s) to be used, and as required, also identify the criteria/ weighting/
timing that will be used as the basis in the evaluation process. See the Project
Administration Manual for further information on this process.
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-19
1.6 DESIG� PHILOSOPHY
1.6.1 GE�ERAL
While undertaking planning studies, preliminary engineering or detailed design,
Consultants are expected to achieve “best value” for the project dollars while still
achieving a safe, functional and efficient design for the end-user. The guidelines,
warrants, and practices contained in the Department’s Design Guides (Highway
Geometric Design Guide, Roadside Design Guide, Pavement Design Manual, Bridge
Design manuals, etc.) should be followed. However, where there are significant
constraints, especially areas with rough terrain conditions (steep hills, muskegs, sharp
river valleys, winding river crossings, widening of narrow roads, existing developed
infrastructures etc.), it may not be practical or desirable to maintain normal standards.
In these circumstances, to ensure that designs are “optimized”, the designer may
request a Design Exception to adopt a design parameter that is more appropriate for
the context while addressing other factors such as safety, cost-effectiveness,
consistency, etc.
Occasionally a design exception may involve use of a design parameter, which
exceeds normal standards or practices. The use of modified design parameters (lower
or higher standards) shall be analyzed by the designer/proponent, documented (to
show the rationale used for the exception generally including economic justification,
impacts on end-users and risk analysis), reviewed and approved by the Department.
The approval process shall include a written submission of a Design Standards/
Practice Exception Request Form (attached in Appendix C with the following
information:
� Description and details of the project including the project stage, type, location,
length, and limits. In addition, highway service class or level, design speed, posted
speed, cross-sections, and other improvements being considered should be
included.
� Site plans, profiles, sketches, detailed drawings, and/or photographs of the site
and the alternatives considered.
� Current and future projected traffic volumes, growth rate, traffic composition,
Turning Movement Diagrams (if applicable).
� Summary of the current standards / practices that are not being followed and what
alternatives were considered and evaluated.
� Information on implications to future planned improvements to the roadway or
corridor that may need to be considered.
� Cost estimate to build to standard versus to the Design Standards / Practice
Exception.
� Assessment of the exposure and risk with respect to traffic volume, location,
severity (worst case scenario), duration, etc. The evaluation may involve an
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-20
assessment beyond the project limits. The evaluation may also include a Road
Safety Audit.
� Summary of the collision history within the project limits.
� Description of any proposed mitigations (safety enhancements such as signing,
markings, barriers, etc.) to reduce the potential impact and/or risk of not meeting
the current standards and practices.
The document should be stamped by the appropriate professional. All requests must
be recommended by the Project Sponsor and the Regional Director. The requests are
then forwarded to the Executive Director, Technical Standards Branch for approval.
Where the Design Exception involves a planning project or a planning aspect of any
project, the Executive Director, Planning will be asked to sign in addition to indicate
consensus.
1.6.2 CO�TRACT DESIG� CHA�GE PROPOSALS
The Standard Specifications allow the Contractor (after a tender has been awarded),
the option of submitting a Contract Design Change Proposal for an alternative design
or change to the Department’s design. In the event of a “contract design change” the
Department’s expectations of the Consultant and Contractor are outlined in the
Standard Specifications. Depending on the nature of the proposal, the technical details
may be very complex or relatively simple. The Consultant will generally be involved
in the review and there is an expectation that deadlines will be met. When a
Contractor submits a design change proposal directly to the Consultant, the
Consultant shall immediately forward it to the Project Sponsor for direction.
The review/acceptance process may involve several branches of the Department
including Technical Standards Branch and Program Management Branch.
Consequently, the Consultant is required to have the resources available to facilitate
this process in a timely way.
In the event that a proposed Contract Design Change is approved, the Department’s
Program Management Branch needs to be involved so that the necessary contractual
changes can be made. Contract change documentation shall be signed and executed
by the Department before the work is undertaken.
If a Contract Design Change Proposal is submitted and the Department asks the
Consultant to participate in the assessment of the proposal and subsequent
engineering work, a change of scope to the original Consulting Services Contract may
be made if required. Refer to Engineering Consultant Guidelines for Highway and
Bridge Projects – Volume 2 – Construction Contract Administration for more detail.
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-21
1.7 USE OF ALL TERRAI� VEHICLES (ATVs) FOR E�GI�EERI�G
ACTIVITIES
The Department, in recognition of the substantial cost savings that can be made
through the use of ATVs for engineering activities (e.g. field surveys), has made
arrangements for the delegation of authority so that ATVs may be permitted to
operate on the highway right-of-way under special permit. Consultants should make
their request (see Appendix C for a Sample Order) to the Project Sponsor who in turn
will arrange for Regional Director’s approval. The ATV Operator shall carry a copy
of the Permit when conducting work. Regional Directors may grant permission
subject to certain conditions. The following conditions will generally apply:
1. ATVs cannot work on the highway finished pavement surface (shoulder to
shoulder).
2. ATVs can cross highway surfaces, but must follow existing Legislation.
(Unnecessary highway crossings must be avoided).
3. The registered owner(s) of the ATVs must ensure that ATV operators are trained
and fully qualified to operate ATVs. A valid operator’s license of a class higher
than a learner’s permit shall be obtained by an ATV operator prior to doing work
in the highway right-of-way.
4. The use of ATVs must be restricted to daylight hours only.
5. All employees on the ATVs must wear fluorescent red-orange safety vests. The
safety vest shall have the word “SURVEY” or “CONSTRUCTION” or
“MAINTENANCE” on the back of the vest, or alternatively on the back of the
ATV machine. These employees must also wear protective headwear that has
been approved by one of the following organizations:
- Canadian Standards Association (CSA)
- American National Standards Institute (ANSI)
- Snell Memorial Foundation
- British Standards Association
6. ATVs must be licensed, insured, and equipped as defined in the existing
legislation.
7. If unique safety hazards are identified, the Department reserves the right to refuse
the use of ATVs for survey activities.
8. The Work area where the ATVs are to be used should be limited to 3 kilometres
in length. This is particularly important if the work zone is to be “signed”. Unless
surveyors (not ATVs-see item 1) are actually working on the road surface, the
need for warning signs is minimal.
9. The Department will require that the ATV users develop a safe work procedure
for this specific operation. If several Consultants will be involved in this type of
operation, a joint safe work procedure shall be developed to accomplish the work.
Additional conditions are currently being considered to ensure that survey crews will
be easily distinguishable from other ATV users in the highway right-of-way. The use
of rotating amber light attached to a pole in the ATV machine is also being considered
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-22
at this time and may also be required. These conditions will be clearly stipulated in
the permit.
1.8 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS
All written communication between the Consultant and the Department shall be
through the Project Sponsor. If stipulated in the Terms of Reference or at the
initialization meeting, there may be a requirement to send copies of correspondence to
other persons, for example the Co-Sponsor.
During planning, preliminary engineering, and design activities the Consultant shall
advise the Project Sponsor as required of progress on the project and discuss
upcoming work, milestones and critical issues. Regular meetings shall be held with
the Project Sponsor as required.
Progress Review meetings shall be called by the Consultant at the conclusion of
milestone events and when technical or other progress matters need to be reviewed.
The Consultant shall review the work of Sub-Consultants before being brought
forward to the Progress Review meetings for discussion. These meetings will
generally be held at Department offices or on site.
Minutes of all meetings will be taken by the Consultant and circulated within 5
working days. For reporting requirements concerning contract administration refer to
Engineering Consultant Guidelines for Highway and Bridge Projects – Volume 2 –
Construction Contract Administration.
All submissions to the Department shall be in electronic format unless otherwise
stated. Additional hard copy format may also be required, as specified by the
Consultant Service Contract and/or the Project Sponsor.
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-23
Current References for Section 1:
Below are references identified in this Section. Please see the Department website for a complete list of available
documents.
Constitution Act, 1982, Government of Canada
Draft Alberta Transportation First Nations Consulting Procedures Manual, 2009, Alberta Transportation
Engineering Consultant Guidelines for Highway and Bridge Projects – Volume 2 – Construction Contract Administration,
2001, Alberta Transportation
Freedom of Information and Protection of Privacy Regulation (Alberta Regulation 200/95), 2001, Province of Alberta
Highway Geometric Design Guide, 1999, Alberta Transportation
Occupational Health and Safety Act, 1994, Province of Alberta
Specification Amendments and Supplemental Specifications for Highway Construction, 1998, Alberta Transportation
Specifications for Bridge Construction, latest, Alberta Transportation
Standard Drawings for Highway Construction, 2000, Alberta Transportation
Standard Specifications for Highway Construction, 2001, Alberta Transportation
Traffic Accommodation in Work Zones Manual, 2008, Alberta Transportation
SECTIO 1 – GEERAL
�ovember 2011 1-24
This page left blank intentionally.
SECTIO 2 – PLAIG
�ovember 2011 2-1
SECTIO� 2 - PLA��I�G
2.1 GE�ERAL
The Consultant shall undertake planning studies that typically consist of the following
types of projects with details outlined in the specific project Terms of Reference.
� Corridor study
� Location study
� Interchange study
� Access management studies
� Traffic impact assessments
� Bridge planning study
� Functional planning study
As part of the planning study, the Consultant may be requested to prepare the basic
right-of-way plans and right-of-way request for the project (refer to Section 3.1 and
Appendix D Planning Requirements).
The proposed plan will be subject to the Department’s final approval. Where planning
studies recommend design parameters that are not compatible with current accepted
standards/practices, a design exception shall be requested.
2.2 DATA COLLECTIO�
Before embarking on data collection activities, the Consultant shall review the
existing data available in the Department or through other sources/agencies. This data
may include:
� Previous planning documentation (reports, plans, files, surveys, etc.)
� Traffic data
� Collision information
� Highway geometrics (profile and alignment)
� Pavement condition
� Bridge inventory, condition inspection data, correspondence file
� Attributes that may influence the study such as utilities, drainage, irrigation
systems, railway facilities, structures, or adjacent developments
� Aerial photography
� Contour mapping
� Identification of possible contaminated sites
� Right-of-way owned by the Department
� Geotechnical reports
SECTIO 2 – PLAIG
�ovember 2011 2-2
2.3 TYPICAL STUDY CO�SIDERATIO�S
Where required, the Consultant shall recommend a roadway standard based on factors
such as traffic volumes, roadway service classification, and the Department’s long
range network plan. A typical study shall consider factors such as, but not limited to:
� Highway safety
� Consistent application of geometric standards
� Geometric Assessments of all existing paved roads
� Highway continuity
� Staging requirements (short and long term)
� Traffic assessments, travel demand forecasts, capacity analyses, laning, auxiliary
lanes, and intersection operational analyses
� Bridge and/or river training planning level assessments
� Ultimate bridge plan functionality, optimization, stageability, and site constraints
� Bridge functionality
� Geotechnical investigations
� Major drainage requirements (especially in semi-urban and urban areas) and
storm-water management plan to include:
� Areas tributary to highway ditches;
� Median ditches and culverts (less than bridge size); and
� Discharge and outfall quantity and quality considerations
� Impact to adjacent property, irrigation systems, railways, and developments
� Utility impact (location and cost)
� Land use impact
� Environmental issues (Federal and Provincial Requirements)
� Historical Resource Overview
� Estimated construction cost comparison and analysis
� Benefit Cost analysis
� Access and service road requirements
� Public involvement considerations
� First Nations consultation
� Right-of-way requirements
� Provisional Road Reservation plans
� Traffic control devices and illumination
� Pavement conditions
� Traffic noise in urban areas
� Aesthetics
� Truck weight, length, and geometric requirements
� Mass haul diagram
� Safety rest areas and pullouts
� Value Engineering (where specifically required)
As required, several options should be compared and summarized in the form of a
formal planning report, outlining the rationale for the recommended option.
SECTIO 2 – PLAIG
�ovember 2011 2-3
2.4 PLA� PREPARATIO�
Plan and report identification numbers will be supplied to the Consultant in the Terms
of Reference or at the initiation of the project. These numbers are to be indicated in
all plans or documents and used in the naming of the electronic files. Naming
convention shall be obtained from the Planning Branch. All plans are to be submitted
in MicroStation format.
2.4.1 MOSAIC PLA�S
All planning studies require the preparation of mosaic plans unless otherwise
specified. Plans shall show existing and proposed right-of-way dimensions as well as
all pertinent geometric data such as curve radii, super-elevation, tapers, etc. Mosaic
plans are to be prepared to the Department’s standards (refer to Appendix D).
2.4.2 CO�TOUR PLA�S
Some planning studies will require the preparation of contour plans. Standards shall
be reviewed with the Department prior to undertaking this work.
2.5 STAKEHOLDER I�PUT
The Consultant shall submit a written “Communication Plan” to the Project Sponsor
and consult with the local authorities, regulatory agencies, First Nations, and general
public as required. These discussions may be in the form of general meetings
including open houses. All meetings must be documented. Approval of this plan from
the Department is required prior to presenting any information to the public. Refer to
Appendix D for the Typical Public Input Process. This process may vary depending
on project specifics. The Consultant will be required to prepare a summary of the
public input process in the final report. Also, all original questionnaires, sign-in
sheets, letters, etc. are to be bound separately and submitted to the Department (this
information is to be kept confidential as per FOIP requirements).
2.6 FIELD WORK
The Consultant shall undertake field reviews of proposed alignments, and establish
alignments on the ground (particularly at river crossings or in areas of extreme
topographical constraints). Refer to Location Survey Requirement in Appendix D.
SECTIO 2 – PLAIG
�ovember 2011 2-4
2.7 PRESE�TATIO� OF RECOMME�DATIO�
The majority of planning studies will require presentation(s) to the Department. A one
(1) page briefing with a map (12 copies) must be submitted at least one week prior to
the presentation. At this presentation, the Consultant shall outline the project
objectives, discuss options, and make recommendations.
2.8 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS
The Consultant shall produce a written, unbound, report for all planning studies that
follows the Department’s approved sign off guidelines. The reproducible copy shall
consist of unbound pages up to 11”x17” size. Any sheets that are larger shall be
provided on Mylar for reproduction purposes. In addition to the hard copy of the
report and plans, the Consultant is also required to submit an electronic version of the
formatted report (PDF) and digital data (MicroStation and document files) for the
report and plans. The Consultant shall submit the draft planning study for review by
the Department to reach a consensus before finalizing the report. The report must
include all details pertinent to the project, including but not limited to background,
alternatives, functional plans, estimated costs, and justification for the
recommendations made. Deliverables should include all spreadsheet files (travel
demand forecast computations, illumination and signal warrants, and/or quantity/cost
estimates), as well as simulation and capacity software input/output files
(traffic/drainage models and MicroStation). Plan profiles at specified scales are
required in MicroStation format. Departmental approval is required for the reports.
The planning study shall not be considered complete without this approval.
Additional information on record management is included in Appendix K.
SECTIO 2 – PLAIG
�ovember 2011 2-5
Current References for Section 2:
There were no references identified in this Section. Please see the Department website for a complete list of available
documents.
SECTIO 2 – PLAIG
�ovember 2011 2-6
This page left blank intentionally.
SECTIO 3 –RIGHT-OF-WAY
�ovember 2011 3-1
SECTIO� 3 - RIGHT-OF-WAY
3.1 BASIC RIGHT-OF-WAY REQUEST
3.1.1 GE�ERAL
For projects requiring the acquisition of right-of-way the Consultant shall prepare a
"right-of-way" request document detailing “any” or “all” property requirements for
the project.
Generally, the Project Sponsor will identify the need for a right-of-way request by
specifying this work in the project Terms of Reference. For projects involving a
planning study, the Consultant hired to do the study may be asked to prepare the basic
right-of-way request under the Terms of Reference for that project.
Right-of-way requests (see Appendix D) must include all right-of-way requirements
shown relative to existing land parcels as follows:
1. Highway basic right-of-way width
2. Proposed service road right-of-way (if required)
3. Proposed intersection improvement right-of-way (if required)
4. Optional purchase of isolated cut-off-areas
5. Area calculations from each certificate of title
6. Safety Rest Area (SRA) sites (if required)
7. Storm Water Management Facilities (if required)
Prior to issuing the right-of-way request, the Consultant shall review the following
items:
1. Land titles and registered survey plans are checked to ensure that the existing
property boundaries are shown correctly on the mosaics.
2. The planning report is reviewed for access requirements, intersection
improvements, cut-off areas, creek diversions, existing developments,
replacement of service road dedications, etc.
3. Land ownership as shown on the mosaics is updated as per current land titles. The
date of title search shall be shown on mosaics under the title block. Subdivisions
are plotted on mosaics.
3.1.2 REQUEST DOCUME�TS
The right-of-way request document must address access closures, access
consolidations, new access construction requirements, and any special measures for
SECTIO 3 –RIGHT-OF-WAY
�ovember 2011 3-2
interim access. All right-of-way requests must be color coded (as to the type of
request) in accordance with the Department's established format. See Appendix D.
3.1.3 LEAD-TIME
A lead-time of 18 months is desirable (12 months minimum) for all right-of-way
requests to allow sufficient time, should expropriation be necessary. Longer lead-time
may be required for projects through Federal jurisdiction (e.g. Indian Reserves,
Military Installations, etc.) and urban centres.
3.1.4 RIGHT-OF-WAY FOR PROJECTS O� U�TITLED CROW� LA�D
Upon approval by the Department, the Consultant shall prepare the provisional
reservation affecting Crown Land and submit the reservation to the appropriate
authority with a copy to the Project Sponsor. This work shall be done as early in the
process as possible.
3.2 SUPPLEME�TARY A�D FI�AL RIGHT-OF-WAY REQUESTS
3.2.1 GE�ERAL
The Consultant shall prepare the supplementary (if required) and final right-of-way
requests during the detailed design to address unforeseen factors such as:
1. Change in project limits
2. Additional scope of work
3. Expropriation proceedings which necessitate an increase or decrease from basic
right-of-way (and which require finalization of right-of-way needs)
4. Excessive cuts and fills along the main alignment and for road allowances that
require grade-line improvement
5. Sight distance or grade-line restrictions that might necessitate changes in
intersection location
6. Intersection modification requirements
7. Proposed borrow locations
8. Projects located near major urban centres (land parcels are smaller, higher in
price, and contain numerous owners to deal with)
To facilitate land negotiations with property owners, an early indication of earth
borrow requirements is desirable. Coordination between the Consultant, Project
Sponsor, and Property Agent can expedite this procedure. The Consultant is generally
required to arrange for borrow agreements.
SECTIO 3 –RIGHT-OF-WAY
�ovember 2011 3-3
3.2.2 RIGHT-OF-WAY FOR PROJECTS O� U�TITLED CROW� LA�D
A final right-of-way request is not required in the case of a new alignment, since
provisional reservations will cover any extra taking. A final right-of-way request may
be required along an existing facility if a provisional reservation is not in place. The
provisional reservation will be issued listing all conditions the Department is
obligated to meet. This will include identification of all third-party interest requiring
consents or agreements. Negotiations shall be based on the land acquisition Terms of
Reference noted in Section 3.3.1.
For conditions and application requirements for obtaining borrow on crown land,
please refer to Section 4.7.
3.2.3 REQUEST DOCUME�TS
The right-of-way request document must also address earth borrow requirements,
easements, back-slope agreements, and general release of all demands. All right-of-
way requests must be color coded in accordance with the Department’s established
format. See Appendix D.
3.3 ACQUISITIO� OF RIGHT-OF-WAY
3.3.1 GE�ERAL
Land required for the project may be acquired by either the Department or the
Consultant on a project specific basis as described in the project Terms of Reference.
When being handled by the Consultant Land Agent (CLA), the Department may assist
in negotiations with landowners.
A CLA must have a valid Alberta Land Agent’s license, be a Commissioner for
Oaths, and must have an Alberta Drivers License. CLAs must hold a membership in
either of the International Right-of-way Association (IRWA), the Appraisal Institute
of Canada (AIC), or other appraisal organization recognized by the department.
As part of the duties of the Consulting Land Agent, the CLA shall:
1. Meet with the landowners (and those who hold a third party interest) or their
agents to assess their concerns, and to negotiate the terms of land agreements. The
“Principles of Compensation” as set forth under the Expropriations Act, Revised
Statues for Alberta 1980, Chapter 16, shall form the basis of compensation
packages.
2. Establish priorities and set up schedules to ensure the landowners most affected
are addressed first.
SECTIO 3 –RIGHT-OF-WAY
�ovember 2011 3-4
3. Start negotiations in a timely manner to ensure possession dates for land do not
delay or compromise established departmental construction schedules.
4. Perform all title searches; locate all existing documents pertaining to that title,
including crown land dispositions, legal survey, and other plans.
5. Review the sketches and/or preliminary plans showing the land to be acquired or
the interests affected; and advise the department of additional information which
may be required for negotiations.
6. Review any appraisal requirements with the department. The department will
arrange for the reports required. These plans or reports shall be available for
negotiation purposes; however, they remain the property of the department.
7. Prepare recommendations for compensation for each landowner affected. The
department will provide comments, and/or review and approve the CLA’s
recommendation prior to presenting the proposal to the landowner or the
landowner’s agent.
8. Prepare all draft agreements with associated documentation necessary for
negotiations and a final agreement. The associated documentation may include,
but is not limited to:
� Offer to Sell Agreements
� Section 30 Agreements
� Moving Agreements
� Agreements for Survey
� General Release of all Demands
� Fencing Agreements
� Preliminary Agreements For Temporary Rental of Haul Roads, Camp,
Plant, or Stockpile
� Agreements of Easement for Construction and Maintenance of a Public
Work
� Consent to Withdrawals
� Permission to Enter, Test, and Survey
� Earth Borrow – Letter of Understanding
� Approach/Access Relocation
9. For all grading projects, the issue of earth borrow shall be discussed during
negotiations with the landowner. In cases where the landowner is receptive to
providing a borrow source, the CLA shall complete an “Earth Borrow – Letter of
Understanding” with the landowner.
10. Provide a summary of the services performed pertaining to the project upon
completion of the land acquisition process.
11. Maintain frequent communication with the Department’s representative during
negotiations with landowners and provide:
� Photographs of all land and improvements affected by the project
� Detailed notes to file documenting all conversations, meetings, and
discussions pertaining to the project
� Monthly status reports to track progress of the right-of-way acquisition
process as defined in Appendix D in the Right-of-way Progress
Acquisition Summary
12. Submit monthly invoices and Contract Summary Reports in a timely fashion.
SECTIO 3 –RIGHT-OF-WAY
�ovember 2011 3-5
13. Prepare briefing notes and draft letters for ministerial responses and reports when
required by the department.
14. Sign an agreement addressing confidentiality requirements and conflict of interest
disclaimer if required.
15. Attend monthly team meetings in the Regional Office when invited to do so.
16. Provide a history of negotiations upon completion of the negotiations or as
requested by the department.
17. Direct all contact from the media to the Department’s contact person listed in the
agreement.
To improve the line of communication, a process has been designed to encourage the
landowners to contact the regional property managers rather than the MLA’s. At an
open house, the Department may distribute a pamphlet outlining the land acquisition
process and answer questions about property related issues. In advance of the CLA’s
first visit, a letter of introduction from the regional property manager as well as the
pamphlet will be distributed to the landowner. The landowner is encouraged to
contact the land consultant, and then the regional property manager, should a dispute
arise. The land consultant also needs to be aware of what flexibility he has in the
engineering plans when negotiating with landowners.
Private land is acquired by one of the following methods:
1. Offer to Sell
2. Section 30 Agreement
3. Full Expropriation
The most desirable method is the Offer to Sell. This is where the landowner
voluntarily agrees to sell the required land at the price offered by the Property Agent.
After construction, the right-of-way boundary is surveyed and if the area is greater
than what is in the Offer to Sell, an adjustment payment is forwarded to the
landowner.
If unable to obtain an Offer to Sell, and if compensation is the only outstanding issue,
the Property Agent may request the landowner to sign a Section 30 Agreement. By
executing such an agreement under the Expropriation Act, the landowner gives up
possession of the required right-of-way at a mutually agreed date, but reserves the
right to have final compensation determined by the Land Compensation Board.
The last resort in acquiring right-of-way is Full Expropriation. In this situation the
landowner refuses to sell the required land (for example, objection to the proposed
alignment). The issue may go before an inquiry, at which time the Department must
present sufficient evidence to justify the expropriation (financial compensation is
dealt with at a later stage). In some cases, it can take up to a year from the date of the
notice of intention to expropriate to the date when possession of the land is obtained.
SECTIO 3 –RIGHT-OF-WAY
�ovember 2011 3-6
For both Section 30 Agreements and Full Expropriation, the Consultant is responsible
for supplying plans showing the final right-of-way requirements from the subject
properties. Special care must be taken in confirming the final right-of-way
requirements since it can be difficult and sometimes impossible to obtain additional
right-of-way at a later date. This is especially true in the case of Full Expropriation.
The Consultant shall refer to the Expropriation Act and the Department’s “The
Expropriation Process” documentation (available from the Manager, Expropriations,
Land Services, Infrastructure) for details of the process to be followed for
expropriation.
3.3.2 TIMI�G
Consulting Services Contracts shall include land acquisition services for all
outstanding right-of-way for all projects to be delivered within a five year window
from activation of the contract. For projects beyond the 5 year window, land
acquisition will be considered in those cases where the landowner makes a request,
the negotiations are based on fair market value, and the purchase has been pre-
approved by the Assistant Deputy Minister, Transportation and Civil
Engineering. These acquisitions will be negotiated by in-house land agents in most
cases. The procedures are defined in the Land Agents Handbook and Property
Services Manual.
Any change to the functional plan or design considered during right-of-way
negotiations (such as changing the median spacing to minimize the required right-of-
way to appease a landowner so that construction can proceed) shall be referred to the
Project Sponsor.
3.3.3 SPECIAL CO�SIDERATIO�S FOR FEDERAL LA�DS
Additional time may be required for right-of-way acquisition on Federal Lands
because of the greater complexity of the process. Each project should be assessed on
its own merit and dealt with accordingly.
3.3.4 APPROVALS REQUIRED
All land purchases and borrow agreements shall be referred to the Property Manager
for approval, prior to presenting a proposal to the landowner and after the agreements
are signed by the landowners. All right-of-way shall be obtained prior to proceeding
with tender, unless otherwise approved by the Project Sponsor.
SECTIO 3 –RIGHT-OF-WAY
�ovember 2011 3-7
3.4 LEGAL SURVEY
3.4.1 GE�ERAL
Except for expropriation surveys, and subject to any special instructions issues by
Alberta Transportation, the Consultant shall be responsible for the Legal Survey of
the right-of-way acquired as related to the project and shall supply and install
associated materials to complete the work. Legal Survey shall be done by a registered
Alberta Land Surveyor.
The Consultant shall ensure that the Legal Survey is carried out in accordance with
the provisions of the Surveys Act, the Land Titles Act, the Public Works Act, the
“Land Surveyor’s Manual of Standard Practice”, and any other applicable legislation.
The Consultant shall also be responsible for:
� Registration of the plan of survey at the appropriate Alberta Land Titles Office
� Discharge of the caveats protecting the acquired right-of-way
� Provision of two (2) copies of the registered legal survey where Crown Lands are
involved to:
Sustainable Resource Development
Public lands Division,
5th Floor, Petroleum Plaza South Tower
9915-108 Street
Edmonton, Alberta T5K 2G8
Attention: Supervisor, Senior Land Administrator
Applications / Approvals - Oil and Gas, Roadways, Reservations
Re: RDS #
� Provision of one (1) copy of the registered legal survey to the Property Manager
3.4.2 PERMISSIO� TO SURVEY
When doing any surveys for the Department, the Consultant shall consider the
following: permission is normally obtained from the owner/lessee as a courtesy prior
to entering or passing over private lands or public lands that are leased in order to
undertake a survey.
If cutting or clearing of trees or other vegetation is required for survey purposes,
permission to do this work must be obtained from the landowner/lessee.
When surveying on Crown lands in the green zones, the Consultant must adhere to
the requirements of the local forestry officials. When surveying on crown lands in the
white zones, the surveyor shall obtain approval in writing from Public Land officials.
SECTIO 3 –RIGHT-OF-WAY
�ovember 2011 3-8
3.4.3 REFERE�CI�G EXISTI�G SURVEY MO�UME�TS
Key statutory monuments are to be identified and referenced prior to construction
where there is a chance of monuments being destroyed during construction.
3.4.4 ALIG�ME�T
In determining the final alignment and extent of the project, the Land Surveyor shall
take into account the following:
1. Area purchased
2. Designed alignment and boundaries, including curve and deflection information
3. Area used for construction
4. Centre-line of the final grade
5. Area fenced
The Consultant shall advise the Project Sponsor of any significant deviations before
completing the survey.
3.4.5 POSTI�G BOU�DARIES (I�STALLI�G IRO� POSTS)
When an Alberta Land Surveyor is doing road surveys for the Department, all service
roads within a primary highway will be posted and labelled as “service roads”. In
addition, where practical, efforts are to be made to consolidate existing road plans
into the new survey.
3.4.6 PLA� PREPARATIO�
A Legal Survey plan, if required, shall be in a registerable format and comply with all
of the requirements as stated in the Land Titles “Policy and Procedures Manual for the
Submission of Digital Plans of Survey for Registration”. A copy of this manual is
located on the following website:
www.servicealberta.ca/1075.cfm
Headings for plans prepared for the Department are to include:
� The nature of the plan, e.g. “Plan showing Survey of Public Work (Road),
Stockpile Site” etc., as delivered by the Public Works Act
� The file number of the Department, preferably at the bottom right-hand corner of
the plan (e.g. “AT File No. _______”)
SECTIO 3 –RIGHT-OF-WAY
�ovember 2011 3-9
� Affidavit for the plan prepared for the Department along with a copy of the plan
of the unregistered plan of survey shall be submitted to the Department for
review, approval, and execution
3.4.7 AT AFFIDAVIT FOR ACQUIRI�G LA�DS
One of the following affidavits will apply, depending on whether the lands were
acquired by agreement or expropriation.
3.4.7.1 �ormal Affidavit
I hereby certify that this plan represents a survey of land required for public work
pursuant to the Public Works Act and the lands covered by this plan were acquired by
agreement with the owner(s) thereof.
Dated _____________ 20 ___ ______________________ (seal)
Property Manager
3.4.7.2 Affidavit When Lands Are Being Expropriated
I hereby certify that this plan represents a survey of land required for public work
pursuant to the Public Works Act and the lands covered by this plan were acquired by
expropriation pursuant to the Expropriation Act.
Dated ____________ 20 ___ ______________________ (seal)
Property Manager
3.4.8 EXPROPRIATIO� SURVEYS
The Consultant shall contact the landowner to explain the purpose of the survey and
obtain permission to proceed with the survey. If permission is not obtained, please
advise the Project Sponsor for further direction.
Marker posts and lathe shall not be used unless permission to place has been obtained.
If statutory iron posts are placed without marker posts, the iron posts should be
countersunk and the excavation should be filled to its original state.
Any damage done such as line clearing, disturbing crops, etc., shall be recorded
showing the date and extent of the damage. This will be a part of the Survey Report.
SECTIO 3 –RIGHT-OF-WAY
�ovember 2011 3-10
3.5 EXPROPRIATIO� PROCESS
When negotiations are not progressing, a review under the “Pre-Expropriation
Process” will be lead by the Property Manager and will include the Project Sponsor;
Infrastructure Manager; Property Agent; Director, Highway Planning & Design,
Technical Standards Branch; Manager, Expropriation and Regional Services,
Properties Division; Consulting Design Engineer; Consulting Planning Engineer; and
Alberta Justice Solicitor. The review will document Landowner issues, compensation
proposed, and a comparison of positions including:
� Appraisal reports and alternatives considered;
� The history of negotiations and file chronology; and
� The design and planning alternatives including technical standards.
The decision to proceed with expropriation shall be supported by the Assistant
Deputy Minister, Transportation and Civil Engineering, and the recommendation will
be forwarded to the Properties Division of Infrastructure to manage the formal
Section 8 process.
Following the Notice of Intention to Expropriate, the landowner may exercise their
right to object to the expropriations. At this point, an Inquiry Officer will be
appointed, and the Consulting Engineer, on behalf of the Department, will be
responsible for defending the alignment at the hearing.
3.6 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS
Upon completion of the project, all titles, plans, survey control searches shall
accompany a blue print or Mylar copy of the plan of survey submitted to the
Department along with appropriate affidavits. The electronic file in MicroStation
format shall also be submitted in accordance with the Department’s Drafting
Guidelines.
Any information that might affect the cost of the survey or incur liability to the
Department shall also be included.
SECTIO 3 –RIGHT-OF-WAY
�ovember 2011 3-11
Current References for Section 3:
Below are references identified in this Section. Please see the Department website for a complete list of available
documents.
Expropriation Act, 1996, Province of Alberta
Historical Resources Act, 1997, Province of Alberta
Land Agents Handbook and Property Services Manual, 2010, Alberta Transportation
Land Surveyor’s Manual of Standard Practice, April 1996, (includes amendments to April 26, 2003), Alberta Land Surveyor
Association
Land Titles Act, 1999, Province of Alberta
Policy and Procedures Manual for the Submission of Digital Plans of Survey for Registration, 2000, Province of Alberta
Pre-Expropriation Process; 2006, Alberta Transportation
Public Lands Act, 1998, Province of Alberta
Public Works Act, 1996, Province of Alberta
Surveys Act; Survey Regulation (Alberta Regulation 94/2000), 1999, Province of Alberta
Summary of Expropriation Process, 2000, Alberta Transportation
SECTIO 3 –RIGHT-OF-WAY
�ovember 2011 3-12
This page left blank intentionally.
SECTIO 4 –EVIROMETAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 4-1
SECTIO� 4 - E�VIRO�ME�TAL CO�SIDERATIO�S
4.1 E�VIRO�ME�TAL MA�AGEME�T SYSTEM
The Department’s Environmental Management System (EMS) outlines environmental
measures that apply to Department Projects. The EMS applies to Department staff and
all Consultants contracted by the Department. The Consultant is responsible for
understanding their EMS roles and responsibilities.
4.2 E�VIRO�ME�TAL ASSESSME�T
On the Department’s website there are two Terms of Reference (TOR) for
Environmental Assessment (EA). These are the “Alberta Transportation – Terms of
Reference for Environmental Assessment (CEAA)” and the “Alberta Transportation –
Terms of Reference for Environmental Evaluation” which contain the specific
requirements that must be followed in order to complete an EA.
The Environmental Evaluation TOR is to be utilized for projects that are not on the
five year construction program and/or do not have any federal CEAA triggers
associated with them. The Environmental Assessment TOR (CEAA) is to be used for
those projects on the five year program and have federal triggers under CEAA.
These TORs are updated as required to ensure that they meet current regulatory
standards.
4.3 REGULATORY CO�TACT/APPROVALS/AUTHORIZATIO�S
Federal and provincial departments have mandates for ensuring that projects they are
responsible for are handled appropriately. Contact with appropriate federal and
provincial government departments (e.g. Fisheries & Oceans Canada, Alberta
Environment) shall be initiated as soon as the project is awarded and shall be
maintained to ensure that all environmental considerations and requirements (e.g.
authorizations, decisions and advisory letters) are adequately addressed throughout
the design and construction phases. The Consultant must obtain permission from the
Department prior to each contact with regulatory authorities.
The Consultant shall ensure that the project complies with all current environmental
legislation. The Consultant is responsible for identifying and facilitating the process
to secure all applicable permits, approvals, and authorizations. The Consultant shall
complete the following Alberta Transportation EMS Environmental Approvals
Framework appendices:
SECTIO 4 –EVIROMETAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 4-2
� Appendix 2: Environmental Approvals and Consultation Checklist;
� Appendix 3: Environmental Reports and Considerations Checklist; and
� Appendix 4: Necessary Environmental Approvals Checklist.
It is mandatory that the Consultant provide a signed copy of the appendices to the
Project Sponsor prior to the start of construction.
4.3.1 PROJECT SPO�SOR SIG�-OFF O� E�VIRO�ME�TAL A�D
REGULATORY APPLICATIO�S
The following procedures shall be followed by the Consultant when facilitating the
process to secure regulatory approvals, authorizations, and permits for the project:
� The Consultant will collect and assess environmental information for a project
and will make recommendations for mitigation and/or compensation for
environmental impacts to the Project Sponsor prior to contacting the regulatory
agency
� The Project Sponsor will determine which mitigation and/or compensation
measures may be discussed with the regulatory agency and direct the Consultant’s
next actions accordingly
� The Consultant prepares a draft application, complete with all the necessary
documents and supporting information, for submission to the Project Sponsor for
review and signature
� The Project Sponsor will forward a signed copy of the application to the
regulatory agency with a copy of same to the Consultant
� Any amendments to a regulatory approval will follow the above protocol
The Consultant shall keep copies of all permits, approvals and authorizations for their
records.
4.4 SPECIAL PROVISIO�S
Copies of all Environmental Approvals, Permits, Authorizations and other associated
documents shall be included in the Plans Section of the tender document. Where the
environmental documents indicate specialized work to be performed by the
Contractor, the Special Provisions shall describe the work required, and shall describe
the method of payment. Where the environmental documents indicate conditions that
are beyond the scope of the Contractor's Work, the excluded conditions shall be
clearly indicated in the Special Provisions.
SECTIO 4 –EVIROMETAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 4-3
4.5 E�VIRO�ME�TAL RISK ASSESSME�T
The Consultant shall complete a project Environmental Risk Assessment as part of
the detailed design work for all projects. These assessments shall identify any
permanent and temporary measures required to protect the environment. Assessments
shall be discussed with the Project Sponsor and incorporated into the tender package,
contract bid items, and special provisions as required. This is a minimum review and
is expected to be brief.
Items include:
� A list of permits/authorizations that have been issued for the project
� Identification of the environmental sensitivities by the Consultant, or as discussed
in the Environmental Assessment documents (where they exist) that must be
addressed in the Contractor’s ECO Plan
� A summary of the borrow pre-disturbance assessment
� A summary of the soil stripping plan
� A summary of the weed survey
� Identification of Clubroot infected areas
� Environmental Protection Plan
� Alignment Sheets (where they exist)
4.6 CO�SERVATIO� A�D RECLAMATIO� OF TOPSOIL A�D
SUBSOIL
The Environmental Protection and Enhancement Act requires an operator to conserve
and reclaim specified land, and unless exempted by the regulations, to obtain a
Reclamation Certificate. Environmental Protection Guidelines (Information Letters)
that address Roadways, Pits, Borrow Excavation, Disposal of Excess Soil Materials
from Roadways, and Conservation and Reclamation Guidelines for Alberta have been
developed by Alberta Environment. The “Alberta Transportation Guide to Reclaiming
Borrow Excavations Used for Road Construction” provides field level experiences for
proper reclamation to be achieved. This document can be found on Alberta
Transportation’s website.
4.6.1 SOIL STRIPPI�G PLA�
During the project design stage the following procedures shall be followed on
Department projects that contain a grading component.
The Consultant shall employ a soils specialist to perform a complete assessment of
the soil within the highway right-of-way and borrow excavation.
SECTIO 4 –EVIROMETAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 4-4
The assessment must identify soil depths, textures, colour changes, and any areas with
potential soil handling concerns (such as areas where colour change between topsoil
and subsoil cannot be used as an accurate guide to topsoil stripping, poorly drained
areas, and areas of saline or Solonetzic subsoil) on the existing side slopes, ditches,
and back slopes and any additional widening of the right-of-way.
The assessment will include a description of how the topsoil and subsoil layers are to
be handled, including details of temporary and permanent stockpile locations. Topsoil
and subsoil shall be salvaged and stockpiled separately, within a minimum 3 m
distance separating the different stockpiles.
The “Alberta Transportation Pre-Disturbance Assessment Procedures for Borrow
Excavations for Road Construction” and the “Alberta Transportation Post-
Disturbance Reclamation Criteria and Assessment Procedures for Borrow
Excavations for Roadway Construction” outlines the techniques to be followed in
developing the soils assessment. These documents can be found on the Department’s
website. Soils shall be described according to the terminology outlined in the
“Canadian System of Soil Classification”.
The Consultant shall design the project such that all topsoil in the right-of-way is
salvaged and redistributed in the right-of-way. All subsoil (if suitable) in the right-of-
way shall be used in the construction of embankments. Prior to drafting the contract
special provisions, the Consultant shall liaise with the Department’s Project Sponsor
and the local Reclamation Inspector for Alberta Environment to confirm actual
requirements.
If the quantity of soil is such that additional areas are required for either interim
stockpiling or final placement, the Consultant shall make the necessary arrangements
for the additional areas. Other alternative Department owned sites (gravel pits) may
be considered. In these cases, the Consultant shall consult with the Project Sponsor to
determine the availability of such sites and provide a cost estimate for hauling the soil
material. The Consultant shall incorporate the soil survey data into the tender
documents. Soil quantities shall be calculated and a plan developed for the interim
stockpiling of soil during construction.
4.7 BORROW EXCAVATIO�S
The Consultant must obtain permission from the appropriate Provincial Government
agency before entering on, testing, or operating a borrow excavation on Crown land.
A pre- and post-disturbance assessment shall be conducted on all borrow areas that
pertain to the project.
Conservation of topsoil and subsoil material from a borrow excavation is mandatory.
The haul road utilized to access the borrow excavation is considered an integral part
SECTIO 4 –EVIROMETAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 4-5
of the borrow and must have the topsoil and subsoil treated in the same manner as the
borrow.
4.7.1 DEPARTME�T SUPPLY OF BORROW
The Consultant shall prepare a pre-disturbance assessment of the proposed borrow as
detailed in the “Alberta Transportation Pre-Disturbance Assessments Procedures for
Borrow Excavations for Road Construction” document.
The Consultant shall prepare a post-disturbance assessment report for the area
disturbed by operation of the borrow excavation as detailed in the “Alberta
Transportation Post-Disturbance Reclamation Criteria and Assessment Procedures for
Borrow Excavations for Roadway Construction” document.
4.7.2 CO�TRACTOR SUPPLY OF BORROW
The Consultant shall ensure that pre-disturbance and post-disturbance assessments are
completed by the Contractor for borrow that is supplied by the Contractor and ensure
that reclamation criteria are met before accepting the borrow.
Copies of pre-disturbance and post-disturbance assessments prepared for borrow
excavations are to be submitted to the Project Sponsor or delegate. The timing of
submission is to be as follows: pre-disturbance assessment to be submitted within one
(1) month of undertaking the assessment. The post-disturbance assessment is to be
submitted within one (1) month of the completion of the reclamation of the borrow
excavation. Additional follow-up post-disturbance assessments may be required
subject to the conditions detected during the initial post-disturbance assessment.
4.8 WEED SURVEY
A weed survey must be completed along the right-of-way and for all borrow
excavations prior to the commencement of activities to establish a bench mark for
post-activity assessment. The land owner or land manager should be advised of the
presence of Prohibited Noxious and Noxious weeds that are listed in Schedule 1 and 2
in the “Weed Control Act”.
The location of restricted and noxious weeds should be clearly delineated and
appropriate control measures put in place to destroy all restricted weeds, control
noxious weeds, and prevent the scattering of nuisance weeds throughout the life of the
project.
The “Weed Control Act” also states that the movement of a machine or vehicle is
prohibited if the movement is likely to cause the spread of a noxious or prohibited
SECTIO 4 –EVIROMETAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 4-6
noxious weed. Equipment, materials, and vehicles exposed to weeds should be
cleaned prior to leaving an infested site.
4.9 CO�TAMI�ATED SITES
If, during the course of any investigations or work the Consultant believes, or has a
reason to believe, that any property may be contaminated, the Consultant must
immediately report the contamination to the Project Sponsor. Further direction will be
given to the Consultant at that time.
4.10 MO�ITORI�G A�D I�SPECTIO� REPORTI�G
The Consultant shall conduct monitoring during the construction phase to ensure
compliance with regulatory requirements. The Consultant will develop appropriate
monitoring procedures consistent with the terms and conditions, site characteristics,
work activities, and potential environmental risks associated with the work to be
performed. Project specific items outlined in the monitoring procedures shall include
locations and items to be inspected, monitoring frequency, monitoring during shut-
downs, and reporting requirements related to environmental permits. Any actual or
perceived non-compliance with environmental requirements must be reported to the
Contractor and the Department immediately, and corrective/preventative measures
implemented.
SECTIO 4 –EVIROMETAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 4-7
Current References for Section 4:
Below are references identified in this Section. Please see the Department website for a complete list of available
documents.
Alberta Transportation Guide to Reclaiming Borrow Excavations Used for Road Construction, 2002, Alberta Transportation
Alberta Transportation Post-Disturbance Criteria and Assessment Procedures for Borrow Excavations for Road
Construction, 2002, Alberta Transportation
Alberta Transportation Pre-Disturbance Procedures for Borrow Excavations for Road Construction, 2002, Alberta
Transportation
Canadian System of Soil Classification, 1987, Agriculture Canada
Environmental Protection and Enhancement Act, 1998, Province of Alberta
Weed Control Act, 2008, Province of Alberta
SECTIO 4 –EVIROMETAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 4-8
This page left blank intentionally.
SECTIO 5 –EGIEERIG ASSESSMET
�ovember 2011 5-1
SECTIO� 5 - E�GI�EERI�G ASSESSME�T
5.1 GE�ERAL
�OTE: Engineering Assessments are not normally included as part of a Design/
Construction Supervision engineering assignment, however, if they are, this will
be stated in the Terms of Reference for the assignment.
The purpose of an Engineering Assessment is to determine the scope of work of a
detailed design and construction project at the conceptual level in advance of
preparing a Terms of Reference for the project. An Engineering Assessment typically
includes a review of the roadway geometric and operational characteristics using
safety, traffic, and roadway engineering principles with the purpose of identifying
measures which could improve road operations and safety for all road users.
For projects involving planning, design, and construction of new segments of
highways, the Department conducts safety audits to ensure that all road components
meet road safety requirements. Engineering Assessments on projects involving
existing segments of highways are normally undertaken at the Engineering
Assessment stage of a design project approximately 3 to 5 years in advance of a
planned highway construction or rehabilitation. Engineering Assessment may also be
required as part of an operational or safety review of an existing in-service highway or
its component.
Ideally Engineering Assessments of roadways and bridges are completed prior to
issuing a Terms of Reference for the detailed design/construction supervision of a
project. Roadway Engineering Assessments involve some or all of the following tasks
(which are described in greater detail later in this section): Geometric Assessment,
Road Safety Audit, In-Service Safety Review, At-grade Railway Crossing Assessment
and Applications, Assessment of the need for Illumination, Traffic Signals and
Pedestrian Crossing Signals, Traffic Studies, Surfacing Strategy, Basic Pavement
Structure Design, and Seal Coat Assessment.
The fundamental parameters that are normally established at the planning/Engineering
Assessment stage are as follows:
� Design speed, posted speed
� Design designation (surface width, overlay acceptable or widening required)
� Geometric improvements needed
� Lighting (warranted or not)
� Traffic signals (required or not)
� Safety improvements
� Bridge requirements and assessments
� Railway at-grade crossings (improvements warranted or not)
SECTIO 5 –EGIEERIG ASSESSMET
�ovember 2011 5-2
� Surfacing strategy and basic pavement structural design
A more comprehensive description of engineering assessment information is provided
in the following pages.
The purpose of an Engineering Assessment is to ensure that an appropriate amount of
engineering is undertaken to identify, prioritize, and determine the scope of projects
before detailed engineering work is undertaken. This is also an opportunity to build
consensus on safety, engineering and programming strategies.
5.2 ROADWAY E�GI�EERI�G ASSESSME�TS
5.2.1 GEOMETRIC ASSESSME�T
Geometric Assessments are primarily undertaken on existing highway segments
identified for pavement rehabilitation and/or geometric improvements. Usually, the
Region identifies the need to conduct a Geometric Assessment and initiates a project
under a separate engineering agreement. Alternatively, Geometric Assessments may
be done as a first step with Preliminary Engineering of a detailed design project.
The scope of a Geometric Assessment and type of analysis required will depend on
the nature and cost of the work being considered. The requirements for a project will
be described in detail in the Terms of Reference. Additional information is contained
in Chapter G “3R/4R Geometric Design Guidelines” of the “Highway Geometric
Design Guide”.
Geometric assessments required on unpaved roads shall use “new construction
standards”. Exceptions to the above require approval of a Design Exception through
the formal process described in Section 1.6.1.
The 3R/4R Geometric Design Guidelines (Chapter G of the Department “Highway
Geometric Design Guide”) are used for geometric analysis on existing paved
roadways. The assessment shall result in identification of geometric elements of
existing infrastructure that warrant improvement based on consideration of total
societal costs and benefits and 3R/4R Guidelines. The Consultant shall investigate
and makes recommendations on the need for upgrading or on the suitability of
existing geometrics, particularly roadway width, horizontal and vertical alignment,
intersections, auxiliary lanes, roadside slopes, turnouts, climbing lanes, etc.
The Geometric Assessment is generally used to prepare the Terms of Reference for
detailed design.
A Geometric Assessment is a review of existing geometric, traffic and operational
conditions, including but not limited to the following:
SECTIO 5 –EGIEERIG ASSESSMET
�ovember 2011 5-3
1. Geometric information
� Design designation
� Horizontal alignment
� Vertical alignment
� Intersection geometry
� Cross-section elements
� Sight distances
� Super-elevation
� Climbing/passing lanes
� Railway crossings
� Guardrail
� Roadside hazards in clear zone
� Horizontal and vertical clearances to structures
� Roadside auxiliary developments (historical turn-outs, SRA sites, view points,
litter box turn-outs, etc.)
� Passing opportunity (based on pavement marking and traffic)
� Functional classification system
� Access management and service roads
� Rumble strips
� Highway illumination
� Traffic control devices, signals, and roundabouts
� Pedestrian traffic control
� Culverts, storm water drainage, and management facilities
� Noise attenuation devices
2. Traffic information
� Traffic volume, hourly and daily
� Traffic composition (vehicle types)
� Turning volumes at major intersection
� Level of service and capacity analysis
� Pavement markings
� Posted speed, general and advisory
� Running speed (85th percentile and average)
3. Collision experience
� Collision records for previous 5 years
� Records of special monitoring locations
� Breakdown of non-animal and animal collisions
� Collision types
� Collision severity
4. Other information (catalogue of locations)
� Utilities (catalogue the existence of all buried and above ground utilities)
� Culvert conditions
� Signing and traffic signals (catalogue)
� Illumination (catalogue)
SECTIO 5 –EGIEERIG ASSESSMET
�ovember 2011 5-4
� Geotechnical information (landslides)
� Noise attenuation devices (catalogue of existing devices)
Much of the above information is available through the Department’s Transportation
Infrastructure Management System (TIMS). The TIMS interactive web map contains
information on roadway geometric conditions, appurtenances, operational and traffic
characteristics, and collision information. More detailed information on collisions
within a particular roadway segment can be obtained from the Transportation Safety
Services Branch.
Information on the existing roadway elements and appurtenances can also be gathered
from existing records, which are available from the Department in the Twin Atria
building. Some information, for example super-elevation rates on existing curves and
intersection sight distances available at intersections, can only be measured accurately
from an on-site survey. A full survey (e.g. preliminary survey) is not required at the
Engineering Assessment stage, however, a limited amount of survey work may be
needed to check existing cross section elements (e.g. side slopes), guardrail, existing
intersection configuration, sight distances, culvert condition, existing pavement
width, roadside hazards, utility and illumination.
5.2.2 ROAD SAFETY AUDIT
Road Safety Audits are conducted to identify potential road safety issues and make
suggestions within a function plan, design, or prior to opening of a highway
transportation project for all road users, under all operating conditions. The Road
Safety Audit provides an independent assessment of the safety performance of a road
transportation project, carried out at predetermined intervals by road safety specialists.
The objective of a Road Safety Audit is to:
� Minimize the frequency and severity of preventable collisions;
� Consider the safety of all road users, including vulnerable road users;
� Ensure that collision mitigation measures that may eliminate or reduce potential
safety problems are considered fully; and
� Minimize potentially negative safety impacts both within and outside the project
limits (i.e. to avoid introducing collisions elsewhere along the route or on the
network).
The intervals at which the Road Safety Audit shall be conducted include at the
planning, preliminary design, detailed design, and pre-opening stages.
The “Road Safety Audit Guidelines” shall be followed for all preliminary engineering
assessments associated with changes to roadways or interchanges.
SECTIO 5 –EGIEERIG ASSESSMET
�ovember 2011 5-5
5.2.3 I�-SERVICE SAFETY REVIEW
In-Service Safety Reviews are engineering studies of an existing highway segment or
its component with the purpose of identifying cost-effective countermeasures that
would improve safety and operations for all road users. An In–Service Safety Review
is generally done as a stand-alone assignment under a separate engineering contract.
The scope of an In-Service Safety Review is defined in detail in the Terms of
Reference for that project.
An In-Service Safety Review is focused on a particular safety or operational problem
occurring at a defined location such as an intersection, interchange, curve, or bridge.
Typically, a problematic location is identified through the process of network
screening. Safety or operational problems at a candidate location may also be
identified by members of the public, municipal officials, or elected representatives.
An In-Service Safety Review involves a structured review and analysis of the
collision history, in particular, a breakdown of collision types and rates in conjunction
with a review of the existing geometric parameters and analysis of traffic operational
efficiency. An In-Service Safety Review could also include traffic conflict
observations and a human factors assessment. The study usually results in the
identification of geometric or operational deficiencies and the development of
countermeasures to address these problems.
In-Service Safety Reviews make use of the following types of information:
Core Data Requirements:
1. Site physical characteristics
� Surrounding land use
� Road classification
� Design and posted speed
� Vertical and horizontal alignments features
� Cross-section elements including lane configuration and width,
shoulders and super-elevation
� Geometry of auxiliary lanes at an intersection and sight distances
� Transit facilities including bus stop locations
� Roadside elements such as embankments, boulevards, ditches, barrier
(type, location and condition) and fixed object hazards
� Pedestrian facilities and control
� Roadway lighting
2. Traffic information and operational characteristics
� Traffic volume, hourly and daily
� Traffic composition (vehicle types)
� Bicycle traffic volumes
� Turning movement diagram at an intersection
SECTIO 5 –EGIEERIG ASSESSMET
�ovember 2011 5-6
� Pedestrian volumes (vulnerable road user volumes such as
schoolchildren, and elderly)
� Level of service
� Pavement markings
� Posted speed, general and advisory, running speed (85th percentile and
average
� Parking regulations
� Traffic control devices and their locations
� Traffic signal characteristics
3. Collision Information
� A five year collision history
� Breakdown of non-animal and animal collisions
� Collision types and severity
� Collision diagram (showing direction of travel of vehicles involved in
a collision)
The Department has compiled a five-year historical record of the safety performance
of all single and double digit Provincial highways to identify operational problems at
both spot locations and along segments of highways. Summaries of collision data for
primary highways are available from the Department.
Supplementary Data Requirements:
� Traffic conflicts (near misses) observations
� Additional traffic measurements (e.g., speed measurements, gap analysis)
� Stakeholder input
� Human factors review
� Technical information reported by the police including date, time weather,
light condition, pavement condition, collision severity, and travel direction
In some situations, it may be important to analyze traffic operational efficiency to
determine if any of the operational factors contribute to safety problems. The
efficiency of traffic operations shall be evaluated using a capacity analysis in
accordance with the procedures of the “Highway Capacity Manual” or the “Canadian
Capacity Guide for Signalized Intersections”.
Depending on the nature of the problem and socio-economic needs, an In-Service
Safety Review may also require stakeholder input or consultation. The scope of the
stakeholder consultation will be described in details in the Terms of Reference for
that project.
An In-Service Safety Review will identify appropriate types of countermeasures and
improvements to mitigate the existing safety problems to best meet the needs of all
road users and the Department.
SECTIO 5 –EGIEERIG ASSESSMET
�ovember 2011 5-7
The countermeasures should be grouped into workable improvement strategies based
on the time frame for their implementation (i.e., short, medium, and long term
strategies).
Short term, inexpensive strategies provide opportunity to improve safety at locations
where the cost of major upgrading is not justified or warranted. Examples of short-
term, low cost measures are signing, chevrons, pavement markings, rumble strips,
animal reflector posts, etc.
Medium and long term improvement strategies are typically more expensive and may
require planning and design work, possibly the acquisition of right-of-way and public
consultation. Examples include the addition of a left-turn lane, installing a new signal
and even grade-separation or roadway re-aligning.
In many instances, an improved safety performance can be achieved with the
implementation of the immediate countermeasures, which often reduce the need for
more expensive long-term improvements. Therefore it is preferred that an In-Service
Review identify countermeasures that could be effectively applied in the short term.
Where major improvements are warranted, the extent of these improvements together
with the estimated capital cost and internal rate of return for the improvement shall be
provided. The internal rate of return shall be calculated according to the Department’s
“Benefit Cost Analysis” guide considering total societal costs and benefits over the
life of the project.
Although the main focus of an In-Service Safety Review is to determine engineering
countermeasures, an analysis may also reveal the need for education and enforcement
strategies to counter specific driver or pedestrian behaviours. Recommendations for
enforcement and education should be supplementary to through road-engineering
based recommendations.
5.2.4 AT-GRADE RAILWAY CROSSI�G APPLICATIO�S
Where an existing public at-grade railway crossing is under consideration for safety
improvements, an Engineering Assessment is undertaken to establish the need for
improvements and to decide on the appropriate type of treatment. The At-grade
Railway Crossing Assessment is normally done as a stand-alone safety assessment
under a separate engineering contract.
The assessment includes preliminary assessment of need and preparation and
submission of applications for safety improvements at new or existing crossings. The
assessment involves consultation with all parties involved, especially those who may
be cost sharing on the improvement. The initial assessment may include an on-site
joint inspection.
SECTIO 5 –EGIEERIG ASSESSMET
�ovember 2011 5-8
Where there is general agreement that safety improvements should be made at an
existing public at-grade crossing, a formal application must be prepared and
submitted to Transport Canada, the Railway Company, and any other party involved
as per current federal regulations. Transport Canada Railway Safety Directorate
should be contacted during the preliminary engineering stage. Public at-grade railway
crossings on national railways (such as CPR and CNR) are under federal jurisdiction.
Improvements to existing crossings or construction of new ones require not only
agreement from affected railway companies but also adherence to federal guidelines
and standards.
If the proposed road work will significantly affect a railway crossing, the railway
company shall be consulted in a timely manner for their review of potential impacts to
their operations, review of engineering requirements, and cost estimate. Railway input
on drainage treatment, planking material, utilities and signal hardware placement is
also needed to avoid potential conflicts, costly re-construction, or delays in waiting
for an agreement.
Since certain railway safety improvements (signals, sight line improvements, etc.) are
partially funded by Transport Canada and the Railway Company, application for
improvements shall be submitted well in advance as the approval process can take up
to 18 months. If Transport Canada is not cost-sharing, there is no need to submit an
application to them. If a cost-apportionment dispute develops and a submission to the
Canadian Transportation Agency (CTA) for resolution is made, a turn-around time of
90 days should be expected.
A general review of traffic, train volumes, and the safety record of the crossing will
also help determine the need for signals and other protection works.
The “Road/Railway Grade Crossing Guidelines” for at-grade crossings and grade
separations should be followed for the preliminary engineering assessment and
application.
5.2.5 ROADWAY APPURTE�A�CES: (HIGHWAY LIGHTI�G, TRAFFIC
SIG�ALS, PEDESTRIA� CROSSI�G CO�TROL)
The assessment of the need for installation or upgrade of existing highway
appurtenances is frequently required at the engineering assessment stage of a design
project, and may also be required as part of an operational review on an existing in-
service highway. For this reason, the analysis of the need for Highway Lighting,
Traffic Signals and Pedestrian Traffic Control may be undertaken under a separate
engineering contract.
SECTIO 5 –EGIEERIG ASSESSMET
�ovember 2011 5-9
5.2.5.1 General
The Department receives requests from municipalities and the general public
regarding the installation of traffic control devices such as highway lighting, traffic
signals, roundabouts, and pedestrian crossings control at selected locations throughout
the province. These requests usually require an investigation of existing traffic data, a
warrant analysis, and good traffic engineering judgment to access the required need.
A warrant analysis is used to compare the operation, safety and uniform application of
highway lighting, traffic signals, and pedestrian crossing control with other locations
in the province. However, the warrant calculation (number of priority points obtained)
is not absolute and requires sound engineering judgment on the safety and operational
implication of installing the traffic device. The use of warrants for street lighting,
traffic signals, roundabouts, and pedestrian crossing control is necessary to develop
consistency in prioritizing of installation/upgrading/maintenance of these traffic
devices. A warranted application also promotes drivers’ compliance with traffic
control devices that could help solve operational safety problems.
5.2.5.2 Scope Outline
The following general steps are required to assess whether highway lighting, traffic
signals, or pedestrian crossing protection devices are warranted.
1. Review background information relating to the candidate location. This
information can be requested through the Project Sponsor and Central Records.
2. Review current operations with the Regional Operations Manager, Operations
Engineer, Maintenance Contract Inspector, or other Department staff.
3. Review with appropriate stakeholders involved (e.g. discuss with school
administration if the request is a pedestrian crossing in the vicinity of a school).
4. Public consultation is not normally required as part of the assessment.
5. Obtain the most recently available collision summary from Transportation Safety
Services. Review collision types to ascertain whether the requested traffic control
would address the collision type.
6. The Department will provide access to traffic information for the analysis. If
traffic information is unavailable, or if a manual count has not been undertaken
within the previous three years, an up-to-date traffic count would be desirable. A
traffic count, if required, is generally done through existing contractors (under
contract to the Department), however in some cases a special count may be done
by the consultant using Departmental procedures if specifically requested by the
Project Sponsor.
SECTIO 5 –EGIEERIG ASSESSMET
�ovember 2011 5-10
7. Obtain aerial photos, maps, plans, drawings, etc. to determine the geometry and
development in the area. Note other sources of signals and lighting in the area.
8. Undertake a site reconnaissance to observe the overall operations at the location at
an appropriate time. Note that an examination of the site may be required during
darkness (e.g. for illumination).
9. Undertake warrant calculation using appropriate warrant procedure.
10. Assess other various options including lower cost alternatives such as other
intersection improvements possibly relating to other traffic control devices,
roundabouts, lane markings, delineation, minor geometric adjustments, etc., to
address the problem and possibly postpone the need for traffic signals and/or
lighting.
11. Provide an estimate of costs, need year, and staging for the suggested traffic
control scheme, including other possible low-cost alternatives for better
operations.
12. The Department specifications for materials used in lighting should also be
compatible with the standards set by the industry. This will ensure that service
equipment used will serve both old and new lighting systems and that the
replacement material is readily available.
13. Report the results of the engineering assessment in a draft document for review by
the Project Sponsor and others.
14. Modify draft report to include Project Sponsor’s and others comments.
Turning Movement Diagram or speed data collection may be required at selected sites
based on a request from the Project Sponsor.
5.2.5.3 Warrant Analysis
The following publications are generally used in calculating the warrant for each type
of traffic control:
1. “Canadian Traffic Signal Warrant Matrix Procedure”
� Traffic signals are considered at a threshold value of 100 points.
2. “Pedestrian Crossing Control Manual”
SECTIO 5 –EGIEERIG ASSESSMET
�ovember 2011 5-11
� The Department generally follows the hierarchy of pedestrian crossings
outlined in the TAC guide.
3. “Illumination of Isolated Rural Intersections”, “Guide for the Design of Roadway
Lighting”
� The guide for “Illumination of Isolated Rural Intersections” shall be used to
determine the requirement for lighting at rural or semi-urban intersections.
The guide outlines three types of highway lighting: full, partial, and
delineation lighting, which is recommended based on the warrant calculations.
When selecting the type and the extent of the lighting, several factors needs to
be considered including presence of lighting at adjacent roadway sections,
presence of lit roadside development, presence of vulnerable road users during
reduced visibility conditions. The consultant shall also use engineering
judgment in recommending the appropriate type of lighting treatment.
� The “Guide for the Design of Roadway Lighting” shall be used to determine
the type and extent of roadway lighting along highway segments and their
elements (e.g., curves, bridges). Lighting is usually justified when the warrant
calculations reach given threshold values.
5.2.6 TRAFFIC DATA: (TUR�I�G MOVEME�T STUDIES, TRAFFIC
SPEED DATA COLLECTIO�)
The Department frequently requires traffic data for planning, engineering assessment
and detailed design purposes. The Department maintains an extensive database of
current information and retains the services of a consulting engineering company to
collect new information as required. In the event that normal processes cannot be used
to obtain/compile the required data, an appropriate traffic study (i.e., speed data
collection or turning movement count) may be undertaken either in conjunction with a
preliminary Engineering Assessment or as a stand-alone assignment under a separate
engineering contract
5.2.6.1 General
The Department is the authority responsible for setting speed limits on provincial
highways. Often to assist with the setting of speed limits on various highway sections,
special traffic speed data collection is required at selected sites to determine speed and
turning movements. The following section provides details of turning movement and
speed data requirements.
SECTIO 5 –EGIEERIG ASSESSMET
�ovember 2011 5-12
5.2.6.2 Turning Movement Studies
The following steps are to be followed to acquire data on Turning Movements Studies
for engineering assessment and other purposes.
1. The number of and location of intersections on the highway segment being
assessed should be determined.
The Department website below should be accessed to determine if current traffic
volume data is available for the intersections. There is information available for
over 1900 intersections in Alberta.
www.transportation.alberta.ca/3459.htm
2. If an intersection is not available on the website, the consultant should check with
the local municipality to see if the local road intersecting with the provincial
highway has been counted.
3. If an intersection has no traffic information, the consultant should determine if a
turning movement study is warranted. The rough guidelines for this are that the
Average Annual Daily Traffic (AADT) on the provincial highway should exceed
1000 and the AADT on the intersecting road should exceed 200. Reference
“Highway Geometric Design Guide” Figure D-7.4.
4. The Department provides AADT volume data for all primary highways which can
be found on the web page above.
5. The volume on the intersecting road can be estimated by knowing the local land
use, recreational activity, and industrial activity. Trip generation rates for various
land uses are available in the “ITE Trip Generation Manual”.
6. Once it has been determined that an intersection traffic study is required, the
consultant shall request authorization from the Project Sponsor to undertake the
study. If authorized, the consultant shall do the study following the procedures
outlined in the “Turning Movement Training Manual”.
7. At the completion of the study, the data collected must be transferred from field
sheets to a spread sheet in Microsoft Excel.
8. This spreadsheet shall be sent to the Department’s approved consultant for
factoring to annual statistics. For information on the Department’s current traffic
factoring consultant, please contact the Traffic Data and Forecasting Engineer in
Strategic and Network Planning Section, Planning Branch.
SECTIO 5 –EGIEERIG ASSESSMET
�ovember 2011 5-13
9. The consultant shall pay for factoring the traffic data to annual statistics and bill it
back to the Department under the assessment contract.
10. The Turning Movement Study is not completed until the factored data is presented
back to the Project Sponsor in the required format.
5.2.6.3 Speed Data Requirements
The consultant may choose to collect spot speed data by a reliable method as they see
fit. This may be done through manual observations using a radar device, or through
the placement of portable equipment to automatically record vehicle speeds.
For automatic speed data sampling, a minimum of 24 hours of data are required for
each travel direction. The consultant shall adhere to the Department’s traffic
accommodation guidelines when installing or removing devices from the highway
lane.
For manual speed data sampling, a minimum of 4 hours of observation is required
with a minimum number of representative speed samples taken within this period to
be statistically viable. For low volume roads, it may be necessary to extend the 4
hours of observation to attain a minimum sample requirement. Periods of inclement
weather, poor driving conditions, and congested periods, which may alter the speed
results, should be avoided.
The following information is required for speed data:
1. Highway number, control section, and kilometre
2. Date and day of week
3. Location description
4. Start and end times
5. Sampling scheme (as indicated on the request)
6. General weather and wind conditions
7. Posted speed and limit of speed zone
8. Direction of traffic being monitored
9. Lane observed
10. Vehicle number (number of sampled observations with recorded speed)
11. Road surface type and condition
The Consultant is responsible for performing a statistical analysis of the raw spot
speed data, including mean speed, 85th percentile speed, median, mode, and 15 km/h
pace (15 km/h interval having the most occurrences). The results must be included in
a graphical format.
SECTIO 5 –EGIEERIG ASSESSMET
�ovember 2011 5-14
5.2.7 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS
A written report is required for all Engineering Assessments for each roadway project,
unless this is specifically excluded in the Terms of Reference. The report will include
a copy of the completed Geometric Assessment or other relevant checklist, supporting
documents such as reproduced existing Department drawings (if available) or new
drawings. The drawings shall show the geometric and other pertinent information, and
recommendation for improvement.
As a minimum, these drawings shall show horizontal alignment, vertical alignment,
cross-section elements, details of all major intersections, and any other pertinent
information. The information on geometric improvement needs shall be provided in
electronic (MicroStation) and hardcopy format that can be used for a Terms of
Reference for detailed design and construction supervision components of the work.
A relatively detailed construction estimate shall also be provided in the report. This
estimate shall be more precise than an “A” Estimate since adjustments would have
been made for all of the identified geometric improvements.
Draft reports should be sent to the Project Sponsor for review. Comments from the
Department should be taken into consideration before finalizing the reports.
Departmental acceptance is required for all Engineering Assessment reports due to the
cost implications to the construction program. Refer to Section 2.8 for details of
reporting requirements.
The Consultant may be required to participate in an Engineering Assessment
completion meeting if issues arising from their submission cannot be satisfactorily
resolved.
5.3 SURFACI�G E�GI�EERI�G ASSESSME�T
5.3.1 SURFACI�G STRATEGY A�D BASIC PAVEME�T STRUCTURAL
DESIG�
The Department develops a Multi-Year Construction and Rehabilitation program on
an ongoing basis. This program identifies the projects which are proposed for
construction on the provincial highway network. Construction programming is a
continuous process and is subject to revisions due to changing circumstances in terms
of projected expenditures, current budget levels, and technical needs.
Since surfacing strategy has major cost implication for construction projects, it is
important that an appropriate Engineering Assessment is undertaken to identify the
scope of work prior to detailed engineering. Generally, this is done by the
Department’s Regional Consultant as an assignment under the Preliminary
Engineering Regional Assignment and included in the Terms of Reference for
detailed design.
SECTIO 5 –EGIEERIG ASSESSMET
�ovember 2011 5-15
The current Roadway Preliminary Engineering Regional Assignment agreements
include Surfacing Strategy and Basic Structural Design for new construction (base
and paving), final paving, and rehabilitation projects which are scheduled for detailed
design and subsequent construction. The work shall be done in general accordance
with the Department’s “Pavement Design Manual”, “Pavement Preservation Manual”,
and subsequent Design Bulletins.
The project tasks shall consist of the following:
1. Obtain design inputs such as project description and limits, traffic, planning
report, mosaic plans, soil logs, as-built pavement structures, pavement evaluation
data (Falling Weight Deflectometer (FWD), International Roughness Index (IRI),
and rut measurements) from the Department, as applicable.
2. The Consultant’s designer shall conduct and document a detailed field
reconnaissance for all projects. The field reconnaissance shall be carried out in
accordance with Section 2.5 of the “Pavement Design Manual”.
For existing grades (base and paving projects) it may be necessary for the
consultant to undertake a field reconnaissance to confirm the existing subgrade
width and subgrade condition if this information cannot be obtained from
Department records.
3. Carry out the analysis and interpretation of FWD testing data in accordance with
the “Pavement Design Manual” for the 10 and 20 year design life.
4. Carry out design to establish basic pavement thickness, material types, alternate
treatments such as Cold In-Place Recycling (CIR), cold mill and inlay, etc.
5. For establishing that a project may be a suitable candidate for CIR, a review of
past construction records and pavement condition data shall be carried out.
Detailed field coring and laboratory evaluation program for evaluating CIR may
be required.
6. For rehabilitation projects, the consultant shall include surfacing strategy(ies) for
any geometric improvement elements as identified by a geometric assessment
provided by the Department. These elements may include widening, intersections,
climbing lanes, access roads, and reconstruction.
In cases where a geometric assessment has not been carried out for a rehabilitation
project the consultant shall confirm that finished widths meet the requirements of
the Department’s 3R/4R guidelines in the “Highway Geometric Design Guide”. If
widths will not meet the 3R/4R guidelines, direction shall be sought from the
Project Sponsor. A design exception may be required.
SECTIO 5 –EGIEERIG ASSESSMET
�ovember 2011 5-16
A detailed report shall be prepared which shall include, as a minimum:
� All pertinent design inputs (i.e. existing structure, traffic, soils characteristics,
etc.)
� Typical cross section drawings for the recommended pavement design strategy
� Site photos to illustrate general roadway condition and typical condition of
distresses such as cracking
� Graphical presentation of calculated moduli, overlay needs, rut and roughness
data, and existing cross sections
� Site plan showing project limits
� Recommended surfacing strategy(ies) and basic structural design including any
special requirements such as pre-treatment of existing cracks
� Detailed field reconnaissance notes identifying specific distress areas and other
observations supporting design recommendations
� A “B” type construction estimate based on the recommended surfacing strategy
and current construction costs. Multiple estimates may be requested to satisfy
programming needs
� Discussion of the inputs used to arrive at the design recommendations and the
rationale used in selecting the recommended design strategy
5.3.2 SEAL COAT PRIORITIZATIO�
There is a need to select those pavements which have the greatest need for seal-coat in
order to optimize the effectiveness of the Department’s annual seal coat program.
This Engineering Assessment is generally done on a Regional basis under the terms of
a Regional Preliminary Engineering Agreement. The Department will provide the
Consultant a list of potential seal coat projects in a Region. The Consultant shall
prioritize the projects on the list in accordance with the Department’s “Guidelines for
Assessment, Rating and Prioritization of Seal Coat”. The procedure to be followed
involves assessing potential seal coat projects from on-site inspection of the pavement
condition, gathering input from the Region (i.e. Construction and/or Operations
Managers), and application of a set of criteria to evaluate the needs of particular
pavements.
5.3.3 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS
For Surfacing Strategy, the Consultant shall provide a design report (including
methods of addressing rehabilitation requirements and cross-section drawing) in a
similar format as contained in the “Pavement Design Manual”. The report shall also
include a type “B” Estimate for the construction cost based on the recommended
surfacing strategy.
For Seal Coat, the Consultant shall submit to the Project Sponsor a priority list for the
construction year (arranged in order of highest to lowest priority) and all the scoring
SECTIO 5 –EGIEERIG ASSESSMET
�ovember 2011 5-17
sheets used in the evaluation of the potential projects. The Consultant shall provide a
unit cost estimate for each of the projects in the list.
5.4 BRIDGE ASSESSME�TS A�D/OR BRIDGE PLA��I�G
The procedure to be followed for Bridge Assessments is covered in Section 10.10.1.
SECTIO 5 –EGIEERIG ASSESSMET
�ovember 2011 5-18
Current References for Section 5:
Below are references identified in this Section. Please see the Department website for a complete list of available
documents.
Benefit Cost Analysis (Summary Guide and User Guide and Manual), 1991, Alberta Transportation
Canadian Capacity Guide for Signalized Intersections, Current, ITE
Canadian Traffic Signal Warrant Matrix Procedure, 2005, TAC
Guide for the Design of Roadway Lighting, 2006, TAC
Guidelines for Assessing Pavement Preservation Treatments and Strategies, 2006, Alberta Transportation
Guidelines for Assessment, Rating and Prioritization of Seal Coat, 1997, Alberta Transportation
Highway Capacity Manual (Transportation Research Board), 2000, TRB, FHWA, USA
Highway Geometric Design Guide, 1999, Alberta Transportation
Illumination of Isolated Rural Intersections, 2001, TAC
ITE Trip Generation Manual (5th Edition), 1991, ITE
Pavement Design Manual, 1997, Alberta Transportation
Pedestrian Crossing Control Manual, 1998, TAC
Road/Railway Grade Crossing Guidelines, 1997, Alberta Transportation
Road Safety Audit Guidelines, 2004, Alberta Transportation
Turning Movement Training Manual, 1994, Alberta Transportation
SECTIO 6 –PRELIMIARY EGIEERIG
�ovember 2011 6-1
SECTIO� 6 - PRELIMI�ARY E�GI�EERI�G
6.1 GE�ERAL
Before undertaking any preliminary engineering, Designers are to revisit any pertinent
planning and Terms of Reference (TOR) documents to examine basic assumptions,
current design practices, concepts, staging plans, cost-effectiveness (based on life
cycle costing methods), safety, preservation of design flexibility for the future, and
other considerations. The Designer shall ensure that all decisions related to the above
are fully explored, discussed and agreed with the Project Sponsor before proceeding
with preliminary engineering.
The Consultant shall revise/update and/or undertake any of the following preliminary
engineering tasks as stipulated in the Terms of Reference for the project.
6.1.1 BRIDGE PLA��I�G
Bridge Planning for bridges is a distinct and different process compared to roadway
preliminary engineering. This function is described in Bridge Planning Section 10.10.
The bridge planning process combines planning, hydrotechnical design, relevant
roadway preliminary engineering, and detailed geometric design to provide pre-design
parameters for structural design for bridge structures. The timing and complexity of
bridge planning is dependent on the type of bridge and crossing under consideration.
It is normally undertaken well in advance of detailed structural design of the structure.
Early advancement of roadway preliminary engineering components such as survey
and finalization of geometric design parameters at the structure and approaches, along
with constant coordination between the roadway designer and the bridge planner, are
generally required for successful bridge planning.
6.1.2 PROJECT SET-UP A�D REVIEW EXISTI�G I�FORMATIO�
The Consultant shall assemble and review all relevant information (i.e. existing
design and project data) available from Alberta Transportation and shall plan a
Preliminary Engineering Strategy based on this information. All acquired data from
sources at Alberta Transportation and for this Preliminary Engineering phase shall be
assessed with respect to its impact on the design.
SECTIO 6 –PRELIMIARY EGIEERIG
�ovember 2011 6-2
6.1.3 I�ITIALIZATIO� MEETI�G
Prior to commencement of the work, the Consultant will attend a meeting with the
Project Sponsor to discuss with him/her their work plan, scheduling, evaluation
criteria, and project file review.
6.1.4 PRELIMI�ARY SURVEY
6.1.4.1 General Requirements
The Consultant shall complete a preliminary survey that will include:
� Title search
� Horizontal and vertical survey
� Survey control points
� DTM modeling
� Survey transit notes
All surveys are to be tied to the Alberta Survey System NAD83 3TM Coordinates and
survey closure accuracy shall be as follows:
� For general roadway work, the following survey closure accuracy shall apply:
� Vertical level circuit closure accuracy
allowable error (mm) = 12 x square root (distant of circuit (km))
� Horizontal linear closure to within 1 in 5000
� For sensitive (critical) locations with very high accuracy requirements (e.g. bridge
structures, curb & gutter, etc.), survey closure accuracy shall be suitably precise to
comply with construction tolerances
All surveys shall be carried out according to the Department’s current procedures as
shown in the latest “Survey Manual” and “Guide to Electronic Survey and Data
Management”. These manuals provide specific information on work methods,
procedures, and practices that are to be followed for electronic survey activities
required for highway work. In particular, the modules on Establishing a Control
Network, Stake-Out, Data Pickup, Data Processing, Data Management and Final
Quantities shall be followed by all Consultants unless an alternative method has been
proposed by the Consultant and accepted by the Project Sponsor in advance of
commencement of the survey.
SECTIO 6 –PRELIMIARY EGIEERIG
�ovember 2011 6-3
6.1.4.2 Chainages
Chainages will begin on the south end of projects running in a general south-north
direction and on the west end of projects running in a west-east direction. The
chainage at the beginning of a project shall match the control section kilometre value
at the same location. For example, if the km value is 10, the initial chainage is
10+000.
Twinning projects may require special chainage e.g. along centre-line or
independently along each roadway if they are independent alignments, however the
same general convention should be followed where feasible.
NOTE: The 'km' is defined as the length along centre-line from the beginning of the
control section, with the south end of each control section being '0' on north-south
alignments and the west end being '0' on east-west alignments. Alberta
Transportation Control Section �umbering System and Kilometre Datum
Measurement must be used.
6.1.4.3 Construction Control Points
Control points, as references for future stages of construction, shall (as required) be
established at locations that will provide protection from damage or loss. The
construction, location, and marking of these control points shall be appropriate to
ensure their integrity for the duration of the project. Steel Pins (min 45cm) are
considered sufficient as control points. Brass caps shall not be used for construction
control points due to possible confusion with legal survey markers.
The Consultant shall follow the procedure of establishing a three dimensional control
network as described in the “Guide to Electronic Surveying and Data Management”.
The Consultant shall also use standardized descriptor codes for all data pickup, and
the guidelines related to naming conventions and data handling, to ensure the
integrity, validity, and security of all data.
6.1.4.4 Elevations
Elevations during bench mark levelling are to be recorded to the nearest 0.001m (the
third decimal figure is usually estimated).
6.1.4.5 Bridge Surveys
Bridge Surveys shall be conducted in accordance with the following:
SECTIO 6 –PRELIMIARY EGIEERIG
�ovember 2011 6-4
� Appendix J – Example of a Bridge Report in “Guide to Electronic Surveying and
Data Management”
� Section 1.3.3 Site Survey Requirements in “Bridge Size Culverts – Design and
Drafting Guidelines”
6.1.5 DRAI�AGE REVIEW (SIDE DITCHES, MEDIA�S DITCHES, �O�-
BRIDGE SIZED CULVERTS, A�D STORM WATER MA�AGEME�T
FACILITIES)
The condition of all existing culverts shall be checked and inventoried. The sizing of
the ditches, culverts, and storm-water management facilities, existing and proposed,
should be checked to ensure it is appropriate and adequate to allow safe passage of a
design major event, along or across the highway without:
� Inundating the highway surface
� Causing overflow of side or median ditches
� Saturating the base course
� Causing erosion
� Causing pounding for excessive periods
� Allowing the passage of spills or wastes from the highway onto private lands or
sensitive water courses, or
� Exceeding safe discharge rates into natural drainage runs, permitted discharge
rates into outfalls, irrigation systems or watercourses.
If any culverts are deteriorated, they shall be checked for excessive deformation to see
if condition is suitable for installation of a plastic liner. If the culvert is deformed too
much to install a liner, then the Consultant shall recommend an alternative to
rehabilitate/replace existing culverts. Best practice guidelines are available on the
department web-site for the selection of both new culverts and culvert liners.
All drainage patterns along and adjacent to the roadway alignment shall be
determined and surveyed (if necessary). The Functional Planning Report and
Geometric Assessment Report (when available) will be reviewed, and additional
verification of condition of various drainage structures will be completed as needed.
6.1.6 RIGHT-OF-WAY COORDI�ATIO�/ PERMISSIO� TO E�TER &
TEST
Prior to the commencement of roads, bridges, utility, or soil preliminary surveys on
private or crown land, written permission shall be obtained to survey and test from the
property owners or renters, land management agency and/or utility company where
required. Permission must be obtained for cutting down of any trees, brushing or
clearing.
SECTIO 6 –PRELIMIARY EGIEERIG
�ovember 2011 6-5
Land acquisition has occasionally created problems for the Department and Utility
Companies. The Consultant should advise Utility Companies as early as possible even
in the functional planning design stage. Once the right-of-way plans and the design
detail work are done, the Consultant should forward them to the Utility Companies
immediately to allow the Utility to begin negotiating with the land owners for utility
easements.
6.1.7 SOIL SURVEY
Soil survey requirements are outlined in Section 7 – Geotechnical Considerations.
6.1.8 UTILITY SURVEY
6.1.8.1 Utility Search
The Consultant shall search and locate all utilities during the Utility Survey stage. The
Consultant shall contact all affected utility companies to gather detailed information
and inform them of the proposed design and construction schedules. This shall
include, but is not limited to, the following:
� “Alberta One-Call” at 1-800-242-3447 (for buried utility locations). Consent from
the utility companies shall be obtained prior to surveying over the utility
easements. A minimum of two (2) full working days are required for the lines to
be located.
�OTE: Consultants should be aware that not all utility companies subscribe to
“Alberta One-Call” and therefore additional searching may be
required. Please note that Alberta Transportation is currently not a
member of Alberta One-Call.
� Energy Resources Conservation Board (ERCB). The ERCB can provide high and
low pressure location plans in township format (“Township Platf’s”) in the area of
the project
� Planning mosaic plans
� Land Titles (ownership, easements, caveats, etc.)
� Registered Pipeline Utility Plans are available at the Land Titles office. The plan
numbers are usually shown on the roadway legal plans.
� Preliminary field survey
� Alberta Transportation Edmonton office
� Alberta Transportation Pipeline Crossing Plan archives (microfiche and
electronic; contact the Planning Standards Technologist, Planning Branch)
� Land Agents (when right-of-way is required)
� Landowner contact (i.e. private water lines). Contact with the landowners can best
be done through the land agent during right-of-way and/or borrow negotiations.
SECTIO 6 –PRELIMIARY EGIEERIG
�ovember 2011 6-6
Obtaining “Permission to Enter and Test” approvals are also opportunities to
inquire about utilities.
� Local Municipality
The Consultant shall complete a thorough search for all utilities. Searching all sources
available as shown above as well as searching the site for signs of the utilities will
demonstrate due diligence on the part of the Consultant.
The results of any initial contact made by the Department will be made available to
the Consultant.
6.1.8.2 �otification Letter
The Consultant’s first contact with each utility company should be done at the
preliminary survey stage, in writing, and indicating:
� The Consultant name and contact personnel
� The Consultant is representing the Department for this project
� The project description, scope, and type of work
� The tentative design completion and tender advertising dates
A set of preliminary mosaic plans or township plans should accompany the letter,
with each of the applicable utilities highlighted. The letter should request that all
Utility Companies provide:
� All of its utilities within the project limits
� The name, e-mail address, telephone and fax number of their contact personnel for
field and design coordination
� Tentative commencement and completion dates
The Consultant should provide the names of all utility field contact, e-mail addresses,
and telephone and fax numbers in the contract document.
As soon as the need to relocate a utility has been identified, the Consultant shall
communicate the requirement to the utility company reiterating the schedule for the
proposed roadwork and obtain a preliminary relocation schedule from the utility
company. The Consultant shall remain in contact with the utility company on a
regular basis until the relocation has been completed.
6.1.8.3 Pipelines
The Consultant shall make arrangements with the field representative of each affected
company to locate and flag the alignment of each pipeline for the purpose of obtaining
survey data.
SECTIO 6 –PRELIMIARY EGIEERIG
�ovember 2011 6-7
The Consultant shall obtain exact locations of all buried pipelines in the highway
right-of-way. This shall include the horizontal alignment and vertical depth of the
utilities (by hand exposing or hydrovac) and then recording the elevations (generally
at the proposed ditch locations and right-of-way boundaries). This requirement is
normally used for major pipelines (high pressure), and may not be necessary for low
pressure gas lines. It is advised to arrange the Pipeline Companies to do the hydrovac,
and the Consultant shall ensure the cost charged by the Pipeline Company is
reasonable.
Because adjustment to buried pipelines is required in most cases when the highway
horizontal/vertical alignment and/or cross-section elements are improved, it may be
more cost effective for Consultants to simply arrange for utility adjustments on low
pressure gas lines based on highway design information rather than undertaking a full
(hand-exposure) survey. This practice is acceptable, provided that the low pressure
gas line depth information is not needed at the design stage, and provided that utility
adjustments can be scheduled so that they do not adversely affect construction
operations and safety. When a low pressure pipeline’s adjustment/relocation is
perceived to be expensive (e.g. pipeline parallel to the highway), a full exposure at the
preliminary survey stage is generally required.
Where it has been determined by the Consultant that a full survey of a pipeline is
required, the exposure of the pipeline shall be undertaken by the Pipeline Company or
a Contractor hired by the Consultant for the Department. With the presence of field
representatives of the Pipeline Company, the pipeline shall be hand exposed, and
elevations taken both left and right in the proposed ditch areas and right-of-way
boundaries. These four elevations are critical to the roadway design and assessment of
any potential pipeline alterations. The company field representative shall be present
during backfilling operations. Backfilling with acceptable materials and appropriate
compaction shall be done as per the applicable utility agreement. The Consultant shall
monitor the backfill operation to ensure that the disturbed area is left in a neat and
tidy condition.
Due to the fragile nature of plastic pipelines, extra care and attention is required
during their exposure.
The Consultant shall make allowance for the cost of hand exposing the pipeline or
other means of locating utilities in their engineering proposal. The Consultant shall
also be responsible for preparing utility crossing plans and agreements as required.
When a major relocation of pipeline is necessary, the Consultant shall contact the
affected Pipeline Company as soon as possible. Pipeline relocation work could take
up as much as eight (8) months lead time from design to completion.
SECTIO 6 –PRELIMIARY EGIEERIG
�ovember 2011 6-8
6.1.8.4 Power Lines
It is critical to relocate power poles in a timely manner to facilitate the highway
grading work. The Consultant shall contact the power company as soon as possible so
the power poles can be relocated/removed prior to the commencement of the grading
work.
During the survey of power lines, the exact location of poles and/or structures shall be
noted by chainage and offset from the proposed centerline (it is important at this stage
to determine whether the poles and lines are within the existing right-of-way due to
relocation cost implications). The number of wires, height of conductors in the field,
voltage, and ownership shall be noted. Information concerning voltage shall be
obtained from the local power company representative. Detailed plans are required for
any location where power lines cross the highway or other roadways which will be
constructed, improved, or obliterated.
Detailed plans shall be prepared at all major intersections (for only the intersections
that will be impacted by construction) that contain power poles, power lines, traffic
signals, and street lighting.
In the case of buried power facilities, the power company representative will locate
and flag their cable alignment and provide all relevant data. The exact location of the
buried lines shall be noted by offset from the proposed centerline and crossings by the
chainage.
The location of Department owned street lighting buried cable is not available
through the Alberta One-Call system. The Consultant needs to arrange a qualified
locator to locate and flag their cable alignment and provide all relevant data.
6.1.8.5 Telephone Facilities
Owners of telephone lines will establish the location and flag the horizontal alignment
of buried cables. The exact location of telephone cables, fibre optic lines, manholes,
and pedestals shall be noted. The size and type of cables shall be recorded and any
special features shall be noted.
Overhead telephone lines running parallel to the highway right-of-way are to be noted
giving exact locations of poles, chainage and offset from proposed centerline, and
number of wires. Lines crossing the right-of-way shall be noted by chainage. The
exact location of poles and anchors located beyond right-of-way boundaries, which
may be affected by construction, shall be noted.
SECTIO 6 –PRELIMIARY EGIEERIG
�ovember 2011 6-9
6.1.8.6 Railway Crossings
At those locations where the proposed roadway alignment crosses a railway, or where
it is proposed to widen an existing railway crossing, a special survey shall be
completed to provide details of any railway crossing signals, control boxes or power
sources present. The complete details of survey requirements and typical plans for
railway crossings are shown in Section 1 of the “Drafting Guidelines (CB4)”. All
railway coordination shall be in accordance with the “Road / Railway Grade Crossing
Guidelines” and “Procedural Guidelines for Railway Grade Separations”– manuals.
6.1.8.7 Other Cables
Other cables include television, telecommunication, pipeline company
instrumentation, telegraph, railway operating cables, traffic counters, traffic light
sensors, cathodic protection, and high impact fibre optics. Television cables shall be
referenced in detail in the survey field books. Overhead telegraph and railway
operating cables shall be referenced with exact location of poles and number of wires.
Traffic counter locations shall be coordinated with the Department through Strategic
and Network Planning. Strategic and Network Planning shall be advised of the type of
work to be done and the tentative scheduling.
Traffic lights (including sensor loops), pedestrian crosswalk lights, and all warning
beacons (amber and red) are owned by the Department and shall be coordinated
through the Project Sponsor.
Cathodic protection cables are usually associated with bridge-sized culverts and shall
be coordinated through the Department’s Regional bridge section.
6.1.8.8 Illumination Assessment
The assessment of the need for illumination and/or determining the extent of
illumination that is warranted (i.e. partial or full, etc.) will normally be done in
advance of detailed design under an Engineering Assessment. Where this is the case,
the Consultant will discuss the recommendations with the Project Sponsor to obtain
additional direction as required. See Section 5.2.5 for details.
6.1.8.9 Reporting Requirements
The Consultant shall provide Mylar and digital copies of the completed drawings
showing detailed information on utilities. For pipelines, “Pipeline Crossing Plans”
must be completed. For all other utilities, the mosaic and/or intersection drawings can
SECTIO 6 –PRELIMIARY EGIEERIG
�ovember 2011 6-10
be used to show survey details. Utility survey information shall be recorded in the
Survey Field Books and shall be submitted to the Department at the completion of the
project. See Appendix K.
6.1.9 REVIEW ACCESS MA�AGEME�T
The Consultant shall review the access management for the project as outlined in the
“Highway Geometric Design Guide”. Proper access management on highways
enhances safety for all road users.
6.1.10 SIG� I�VE�TORY
Existing signage on the project and signs adjacent to the project which may be
affected by the proposed improvements shall be inventoried. The information
collected shall include size, number, location and type of all signs (public and
private). The condition of existing sign mounts, structures, and sign faces shall be
noted. Faces that are damaged or non-reflective shall be identified. See Section 8.9 for
information on sign design.
6.1.11 GEOMETRIC A�D SAFETY ASSESSME�T, A�D SURFACI�G
STRATEGY
In the event that these activities have not been done in the planning or Engineering
Assessment stages, these activities may be included as part of the preliminary
engineering tasks at the discretion of the Project Sponsor. See Section 5 –
Engineering Assessment for details.
Where this work has been completed previously, the Consultant responsible for
preliminary engineering is required to review the previously compiled data,
engineering guidelines/warrants used, and the recommendations made.
Repetition of the original analysis and assessment undertaken at the planning or
engineering assessment stages is not required unless new information has become
available or some design guidelines or technical needs have changed.
Consultants shall strive to achieve highly cost-effective designs while providing the
standards which are appropriate for the highway according to the “Highway
Geometric Design Guide”.
When pavement rehabilitation and/or geometric improvements are considered on
existing paved roadways, designers shall use the information contained in Chapter G -
3R/4R Geometric Design Guidelines of the “Highway Geometric Design Guide”.
Where various options are being considered, for example for horizontal or vertical
alignments, the guidelines contained in the “Benefit-Cost Analysis” shall be followed
SECTIO 6 –PRELIMIARY EGIEERIG
�ovember 2011 6-11
to ensure that total societal cost and benefits are considered in a uniform way.
Through the use of a consistent set of guidelines it will be possible to compare the
merits of various alternatives on a particular project and to rank various projects
according to economic indicators.
� Any changes proposed to the original reports will be documented and verified by
the Project Sponsor and Technical Standards Branch.
� Where a Geometric Assessment, Safety Assessment, Surfacing Strategy or other
Engineering Assessment task must be completed at the Preliminary Engineering
Stage, the reporting requirements are as shown in Section 5. In the event that an
Engineering Assessment was completed in advance of Preliminary Engineering,
the Consultant is required to document any changes that are proposed to the
previously accepted recommendations. These changes should be supported by a
suitably detailed rationale / analysis which may include a life-cycle economic
analysis.
6.2 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS
� An ASCII geographic coordinate file (xyz values such as latitude, longitude,
elevation) is required for roads and bridge site surveys to be submitted to the
Project Sponsor upon completion of the preliminary survey. In cases where
horizontal alignments are being improved or new alignments constructed and
there is no planning study, an ASCII file of the alignment shall be submitted by
the Consultant to the Project Sponsor as soon as the horizontal alignment has been
finalized in the field. The purpose of this submission is to facilitate the Project
Sponsor sending the information to the Highway Geomatics Section, Divisional
Services Branch to keep the inventory up to date. This digital ASCII file shall also
include raw and processed data of survey, including geodetic datum, and any other
survey specific information.
� All titles, survey data (hard copy and electronic data), copies of all pertinent
correspondence and the original or all permits and approvals (e.g. permission from
landowner to survey and/or enter land, and/or clear vegetation for survey
purposes), shall be submitted to the Project Sponsor as part of the project
documentation at the completion of the project.
A written report and an appropriate construction cost estimate are required for the
Geometric Assessment, Safety Assessment, and Surfacing Strategy of each
construction project. See Section 5 for details.
The estimate for Surfacing Strategy should be a type “B” Estimate. The estimate for
Geometric/Safety improvements should be a “B” Estimate if grading quantities have
been calculated. If grading quantities have not been run, an estimate that is in the
format of an “A” Estimate but with more accuracy (due to knowledge of the
geometric improvement requirements) is required.
SECTIO 6 –PRELIMIARY EGIEERIG
�ovember 2011 6-12
See Appendix K for more information on records management. The Consultant shall
keep copies of all permits and approvals for their records. Any information that might
affect the cost of the survey or incur liability to the Department shall be included.
SECTIO 6 –PRELIMIARY EGIEERIG
�ovember 2011 6-13
Current References for Section 6:
Below are references identified in this Section. Please see the Department website for a complete list of available
documents.
A Guide to Electronic Surveying and Data Management, 1996, Alberta Transportation
Benefit Cost Analysis (Summary Guide and User Manual), 1991, Alberta Transportation
Drafting Guidelines (CB4), 1990, Alberta Transportation
Highway Geometric Design Guide, 1999, Alberta Transportation
Procedural Guidelines for Railway Grade Separations, 2nd edition - 2004
Road/Railway Grade Crossing Guidelines, May 1997, Alberta Transportation
Survey Manual, 1988, Alberta Transportation
SECTIO 6 –PRELIMIARY EGIEERIG
�ovember 2011 6-14
This page left blank intentionally.
SECTIO 7 – GEOTECHICAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 7-1
SECTIO� 7 - GEOTECH�ICAL CO�SIDERATIO�S
7.1 GE�ERAL
Geotechnical investigations are required for highway, geotechnical, and bridge
projects. This Section presents basic principles and requirements with which to guide
the Consultant in the preparation of proposals and completion of their investigations.
Irrespective of the requirements listed in this document, it is important that the
Consultant clearly outlines in their proposal what assumptions were made in
estimating the effort and resources necessary to complete the scope of work.
A project may consist of new road construction, grade widening, bridge and culvert
design, and specific geotechnical projects such as landslide repair. Within any of these
types of projects there may be numerous major areas of investigations, including
roadway; borrow; bridge and culvert; soft ground or muskeg; landslide; erosion; and
rock. General requirements for these types of investigations are outlined in the
following sections. Requirements for culvert corrosion surveys are provided in this
section. It should be noted that there are specific qualifications for personnel
responsible for gathering field data and testing related to corrosion surveys.
Requirements for topsoil survey related to topsoil conservation within the highway
right-of-way, and for pre- and post-borrow assessments are provided in Section 4.
This section provides minimum requirements for test hole spacing. Sound engineering
and application of ‘common sense’ principles should govern the project requirements
for test hole spacing and locating. Minimum drilling requirements through
problematic areas should be supplemented as required to provide a reasoned basis on
which to proceed with the design, using a balance of risk acceptance and avoidance in
harmony with project costs and objectives. For the purposes of this 1Section, ‘test
hole’ and ‘bore hole’ are interchangeable terms. Minimum requirements for field
investigations, laboratory tests, and reports are summarized in each subsection.
The Consultant’s Geotechnical Engineer assigned to the project shall make at least
one (1) site visit, preferably prior to start of the field investigation. This trip will help
the engineer to familiarize himself with the site conditions and aid in the positioning
of test holes. Several site visits may be required for complex sites such as major
landslide or bridge projects.
SECTIO 7 – GEOTECHICAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 7-2
TABLE A provides a summary of field, laboratory and reporting requirements for each type of project listed below.
Refer to the legend for numeric codes.
TABLE A - I�VESTIGATIO� A�D REPORT CO�TE�T REQUIREME�TS
Type of Investigation
Office review
Minimum Field Investigation Minimum
Laboratory
Testing
Reporting
Requirements
Location Depth Instrumentation
Roadway
(Section 7.2)
New
construction
1, 2, 6 7, 8 21, 22, 23, 25 28, 30 32, 33, 34 37-43
Grade
widening
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 7, 9 21, 22, 24, 25 28, 30 31, 33, 34
Borrow (Section 7.3) 1, 2, 6 7, 10 21, 23 29 32, 33
Bridges
(Section 7.4)
Abutments 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 7, 11 23, 24, 25 29, 30 32, 33, 34,
35
Piers 7, 12 22, 24, 25 28, 30 32, 33, 34,
35
Culvert 7, 13 23, 24, 25 29, 30 32, 33, 34,
35
MSE/retaining
walls
7, 14 23, 24, 25 29, 30 32, 33, 34,
35
Wingwalls 7, 15 23, 24, 25 29, 30 32, 33, 34,
35
Approach fills 7, 16 22, 23, 25 29, 30 31, 33, 34
Culvert – Corrosion Survey
(Section 7.4)
3, 4, 5, 6 17 26 26 36
Soft ground/ muskeg
(Section 7.5)
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 7, 18 23, 25, 27 28, 30 31, 33, 34
Landslides (Section 7.6) 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 7, 19, 22 23, 25 28, 30 32, 33, 34
Expansive Soils (Section 7.7) 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 7, 19 22, 23 29, 30 32, 33, 34
Erosion (Section 7.8) 1, 2, 3, 5, 6 7, 19 21, 23 32, 33, 34
Rock (Section 7.9) 1, 2, 3, 4, 6 7, 20 21, 23, 24 28 31, 33, 34
SECTIO 7 – GEOTECHICAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 7-3
Legend:
Office Review
1. Surface geology, bedrock geology maps and reports
2. Air photo review
3. Consultant and Department geotechnical, bridge and design reports and file
records
4. Construction records
5. Maintenance records, local peoples perspective
6. Site visit by Project Engineer
Field Investigation
7. Test hole or test pit
8. Drill at 200 m maximum spacing (for topsoil survey assessment requirements
refer to Section 4). Offset test holes as appropriate to provide coverage across the
full width of the proposed construction. As a suggested guideline, alternate
drilling of centerline holes with test holes advanced along the right and left ditch
lines.
9. Drill at 300 m maximum spacing if it can be determined that previous soils
information is available and relevant; otherwise use 200 m maximum spacing. For
topsoil survey assessment requirements refer to Section 4. Offset test holes as
appropriate to provide coverage across the full width of the proposed construction.
Drill along shoulder of the road to assess the existing road structure, along the
existing embankment slope to determine the presence of waste materials for
benching requirements, and along existing ditch which will form the foundation
for the new fill.
10. Minimum of two (2) test holes per borrow, for pre- and post-borrow disturbance
assessment requirements refer to Section 4.
11. Minimum of one (1) test hole per abutment. Siting of abutment and pier test holes
should be done in conjunction with bridge planning objectives and existing site
constraints.
12. Minimum of one (1) test hole per land based pier. Drilling at all river based piers
is preferred, however the use of Ground Penetrating Radar (GPR) tied into land
based test holes, or approved technique to determine soil conditions at river based
pier locations may be acceptable. Limitations of the technique used should be
discussed in the report. Siting of abutment and pier test holes should be done in
conjunction with bridge planning objectives and existing site constraints.
13. Minimum of one (1) test hole per 25 m culvert length at new culvert sites. Use
judgement at culvert replacement sites.
14. Minimum of two (2) test holes along each wall base, otherwise at 50 m spacing
along Mechanically Stabilized Earth (MSE) structure.
15. Wing wall drilling is left to the discretion of the Consultant. The Consultant will
be required to document reasons for not doing an investigation.
16. Typically drill one (1) test hole per approach fill, about 50 m from abutment seat.
SECTIO 7 – GEOTECHICAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 7-4
17. See Section 7.4.
18. Where feasible use an auger truck to probe; alternatively use a muskeg probe or
vane testing. Some test hole sampling of muskeg and underlying mineral soils is
required. Probe muskeg at 20 m spacing along alignment, and alternate left and
right offset probes.
19. The actual number of test holes required is typically site specific. The number,
location, and depth of test holes to be determined by the Consultant after the site
visit. For proposal purposes, the Consultant should use engineering judgement and
provide documentation of reasoning. Instrumentation requirements are also to be
determined by the Consultant on a site-specific basis.
20. Probe to rock surface at 50 m intervals and core rock at 100 m intervals.
21. Drill a minimum 2 m below ditch level or below bottom of borrow.
22. Drill to a depth equal to the fill height, or to a minimum of 2 m below existing
natural grade in fill sections, whichever is greater. The depth of drilling should be
consistent with the data requirements for stability analysis, etc.
23. Samples are to be taken of each major soil type encountered and where moisture
conditions show abrupt change. Block samples of muskeg may be required.
Undisturbed (pushed thin wall tube) samples and/or cores to be retrieved for
advanced laboratory testing as appropriate.
24. Drill a minimum 3 m below pile foundation depth or a minimum 3 m below
footing depth. Core a minimum 3 m into competent bedrock where encountered.
25. Standard Penetration Test (SPT), Cone Penetration Test (CPT), Dynamic Cone
Penetration Test (DCPT), vane testing, pressure meter, dilatometer and/or muskeg
probe as appropriate.
26. Corrosion survey. For requirements see Section 7.4.
27. Probe to firm ground at least 1 m below bottom of organic layer where organic
terrain is encountered. Where buried valleys are infilled with loose or soft
compressible materials, probe to at least three (3) times the embankment height or
10 m, whichever is greater.
28. The Consultant may elect to install slotted standpipe piezometers and slope
indicators at deep cut locations.
29. Slotted standpipe piezometers should be installed in at least one (1) test hole per
borrow, and may be appropriate for installation at culvert and MSE excavations
and along approach cuts into bridge or culvert sites.
30. Recommendations for instrumentation during construction should be included in
the report. Such instrumentation may include standpipe and pneumatic
piezometers, horizontal and vertical slope indicators, settlement monitoring
devices, pile dynamic analyzer (PDA), etc.
Laboratory Test Program
31. The frequency of testing shall be a minimum of one (1) ‘suite’ of tests per
borehole. A ‘suite’ of tests consists of a moisture content test, an Atterberg limit
test and/or a grain size analysis (whichever is appropriate), and estimates of
optimum moisture content and maximum dry density for each tested sample.
SECTIO 7 – GEOTECHICAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 7-5
32. The frequency of testing shall be a minimum of two (2) ‘suites’ of tests per
borehole. A ‘suite’ of tests consists of a moisture content test, an Atterberg limit
test and/or a grain size analysis (whichever is appropriate), and estimates of
optimum moisture content and maximum dry density for each tested sample.
33. Moisture content profile shall be completed for each test hole, meaning that all
samples will be tested for moisture content.
34. Advanced testing as determined by the Consultant. This may include direct shear,
triaxial, unconfined compressive, permeability, consolidation, point load, slaking,
pinhole dispersion, or other tests as deemed appropriate and justified by the
Consultant.
35. Soluble sulphate testing for determination of cement type for locations where
concrete will come into contact with soil.
36. Corrosion survey: soil resistivity and pH testing, sulphide, sulphate, and chloride
testing.
Report Content
The project report shall be a complete and comprehensive document. The report
format is left to the discretion of the Consultant. The report shall provide the
following information and any additional information as indicated in the project
Terms of Reference
37. Executive summary
38. Office information review
� Surface geology, terrain, and drainage description
� Bedrock geology if appropriate
� Air photo review comments
� Existing geotechnical reports and file review
� Discussions with locals, maintenance personnel, etc.
39. Field investigation
� Field observations: terrain description, ground cover, drainage pattern,
scarps, cracks, distressed ground, seeps, heaves, pavement distress,
weather at time of inspection, etc.
� Description of drilling program, including test hole locations and depths
summary
� Adverse conditions encountered during drilling, caving or sloughing, loss
of drill fluid circulation, refusal conditions, etc.
� Discussion of groundwater conditions encountered during drilling,
immediately after drilling, and after stabilization
� Generalized soil condition descriptions, with exceptions noted as
appropriate
� Description of field tests and results, SPT, CPT, etc.
� Details of instrumentation and monitoring program
� Field corrosion test results, as applicable
SECTIO 7 – GEOTECHICAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 7-6
40. Laboratory testing
� Table of results indicating sample data, soil description, Unified Soils
Classification System (USCS) description as modified by Prairie Farm
Rehabilitation Association (PFRA), and all test results
� Description of advanced test results, indicating limitations of test and test
conditions, type of sample
� Chemical test results, soluble sulphates, etc.
41. Engineering Assessment
� Discussion of type of analysis undertaken
� Discussion of material parameters used
� Presentation of analysis findings and limitations if any
� Discussion of risk, including uncertainty, associated with findings
� Discussion of various hazard mitigative options, pros and cons, cost -
benefit
42. Recommendations
� Requirements for mitigation of geotechnical risk at the site including but
not limited to:
� Requirements for contract special provisions
� Staged construction, rate of fill placement
� Surcharge or overbuild
� Cut and fill slope angles
� Stabilization measures for natural slopes, embankment, or cut slopes
and cost estimates for it.
� Site dewatering, soil moisture conditioning
� Swelling soil and frost heave mitigation
� Soft ground construction
� Fill and foundation settlement estimates
� Volume modification factors for various fill materials to be
encountered
� Erosion control requirements
� Foundation options and design parameters, bearing and skin friction
values, negative or down-drag consideration, and cement type related
to soluble sulphate concentrations
� Consolidation design, wick drains, and drainage designs
� Lateral earth pressure
� Other construction related issues – requirements for monitoring and
instrumentation, PDA or test pile requirements
� Other geotechnical related recommendations as appropriate
43. Appendix
� List of references
� Test hole logs, including electronic copy
� Muskeg probe logs
� Instrumentation records and readings
� Stratigraphic cross-section and plan drawings
� Photographs, site sketches
� Advanced test result sheets
SECTIO 7 – GEOTECHICAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 7-7
7.2 ROADWAY
The selection of the most desirable grade-line and alignment for highway grading
projects are normally conducted through shallow test hole drilling methods inside and
immediately outside of the proposed roadway prism. The reporting requirements for
grade widening investigations are considered to be the same as for new construction.
However there may be room for a relaxation in the frequency of test hole and
laboratory testing requirements for grade widening projects, depending on the
availability and quality of existing soil information.
Requirement for the depth and distribution of test holes/test pits should be determined
based on findings of the office review and site visit by the Project Engineer. It is
expected that additional test holes beyond those stated in Table A will be undertaken
if adverse soil conditions are expected or encountered during the course of the field
drilling. Consideration should be given to augment the roadway investigation at deep
cuts and high fills with offset test holes in order to provide sufficient stratigraphic
data for a stability analysis to be undertaken. The possible presence of ‘snake pits’,
narrow pits excavated to dispose of wet or otherwise deleterious soils along the toe of
existing embankments should be evaluated through the file review, air photo
assessment, field inspection, and drilling program.
Soil samples shall be taken of each change in soil type within a test hole. The size of
samples shall be sufficient to meet the laboratory testing requirements.
Requirements for topsoil survey are provided in Section 4.
7.3 BORROW
The selection of suitable borrow material can have a significant impact on the success
of a project during construction and in the long-term. Consultants are directed to
avoid the use of frost susceptible materials as a road building material unless it can be
demonstrated that no economically viable alternative exists and the design is
optimized to limit the influence of the silt. Most borrow investigations are completed
using auger drilling techniques or test pits. Typically borrow reports form a
subsection of a geotechnical report, although project requirements may occasionally
dictate that a stand-alone report be prepared.
Requirement for the depth and distribution of test holes/test pits should be determined
based on findings of the office review and site visit. It is expected that additional test
holes, beyond those stated in Table A will be undertaken if adverse soil conditions are
expected or encountered during the course of the field drilling. Long term monitoring
of groundwater conditions is a requirement of borrow investigations. This typically
requires the installation of standpipe piezometers, and the consultant should be
prepared to revisit the site several weeks or months after drilling to monitor
groundwater levels.
SECTIO 7 – GEOTECHICAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 7-8
Groundwater tables can change seasonally, and as such, a single standpipe reading is
generally not sufficient to predict the range of water table level possible.
Soil samples shall be taken of each change in soil type within a test hole. The size of
samples shall be sufficient to meet laboratory testing requirements.
7.4 BRIDGE A�D MAJOR CULVERTS
It is recommended that senior personnel with relevant experience be assigned to these
projects. A field visit by the Project Engineer is a prerequisite that must be completed
prior to field drilling. Site conditions may be adverse at the proposed site, but
favourable a short distance away. Although a bridge site may be feasible, the
approach cuts into a particular valley may traverse unstable terrain, requiring costly
mitigative work. The Project Engineer must have sufficient experience to identify
such conditions and to bring field issues forward to the design team at an early stage.
Similar equipment and methods of sampling used for grading design are commonly
used for investigating bridge approach fills and foundations. The use of rotary drilling
or wire-line coring may be required to retrieve intact rock samples. In-situ vane shear,
pressure meter, cone penetration, and dilatometer tests are also undertaken where
results from these tests would allow better interpretation of ground conditions for
design.
Predicted foundation depths shall not exceed the known soil stratigraphic profile. It is
not acceptable to design foundation elements to be placed in unknown soil or bedrock
conditions or to choose foundation types that are in conflict with the known soil and
bedrock conditions. If the depth of the proposed bridge foundations is below the
probed depth at borehole locations, a satisfactory rationale is required to support the
design. Re-drilling of the site may be required to meet these design criteria.
The potential geotechnical issues at a bridge or culvert site may also involve
consideration of the construction sequence and methods required to complete the
project. If a culvert bore or push is to be undertaken, comments on tunnelling aspects
of the project are required. If a deep fill is to be excavated to replace a culvert,
consideration of where the excavated fill can be temporarily placed and the
excavation cut-slopes is required. Stockpiling of excavated material on metastable
valley slopes can be an issue and should be addressed in the geotechnical report.
Recommendations for quality assurance measures consistent with the scale of the
project and requirements of the design methodology (limit states design geotechnical
factor selection) should be provided. Various confirmatory and quality assurance tests
are becoming practical and may be appropriate for the bridge foundations under study.
Recommendations for Pile Driving Analysis (PDA), Osterberg, Statnamic,
conventional pile load test and other methods should be provided in the geotechnical
report.
SECTIO 7 – GEOTECHICAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 7-9
It is expected that the structural engineer will dialog with the geotechnical engineer on
foundation and other geotechnical issues. The foundation design drawings should be
reviewed by the geotechnical engineer to ensure that all geotechnical
recommendations are being followed. Any deviations from the geotechnical
recommendations should be documented, and rationale provided to support the
deviation.
7.4.1 CORROSIO� SURVEY
Corrosion surveys may be required as stand-alone projects or as a component of a
larger study. The following steps provide a recommended procedure for determination
of the corrosive potential of the soil and water at a culvert site. Procedures for
determination of time to first penetration for water-side and soil-side corrosion, and
design of cathodic protection systems are not included in this section.
Procedures for field determination of pH and resistivity:
a) Take the pH and resistivity values of the soil on the road side-slope on both sides
of the road, and in the upstream and downstream banks.
b) Take the pH and resistivity values of the water at the upstream and downstream
ends.
c) Check for the presence of sulphide, sulphates, and chlorides.
Sufficient testing to accurately establish the corrosive nature of the soil and water in
which the culvert is to be located must be carried out, and the location and numbers of
the readings (or samples) is to be at the discretion of the Consultant.
d) If the existing structure is a metal culvert, take static potential readings between
the soil and culvert at 3, 6, 9, and 12 o'clock positions at the upstream and
downstream ends. Readings shall be taken using a copper - copper sulphate half
cell or approved equivalent.
The Consultant may be required to undertake all the above tasks (a to d), or partial
tasks. The site-specific requirements will be as directed by the Project Sponsor with
input from the Consultant.
7.4.1.1 Reporting Requirements
� Provide a summary of all pH, resistivity, sulphide, sulphate, and chloride values
obtained, together with the average values used for calculation purposes.
� Provide brief details of the testing methods used to obtain the values, and the
significance of the results.
SECTIO 7 – GEOTECHICAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 7-10
7.4.1.2 Qualifications
A Corrosion Technologist with at least 3 years related experience is the minimum
qualifications required for personnel responsible for gathering field data, testing,
adjusting, and servicing cathodic protection systems etc.
A Professional Engineer who has specialized in corrosion engineering is the
minimum qualification required for personnel responsible for preparing reports,
interpreting data, providing recommendations, and designing cathodic protection
systems, etc.
7.5 SOFT GROU�D/MUSKEG
Muskeg investigations are usually undertaken as part of a grading project. Test pits
using backhoe’s, track mounted auger drilling, probing using muskeg probes, or other
acceptable methods of investigating the depth and characteristics of soft soils and
muskegs provide supplementary means of acquiring relevant subsurface information
to assist in site evaluation and assessment.
On occasion, the Consultant may consider block sampling peat deposits and
subsequent laboratory strength or consolidation testing. Owing to the difficulty and
cost of this procedure, the Consultant should be prepared to justify the expenditure.
In-situ vane shear testing can also be used for strength estimation.
The Consultant should identify any specific construction techniques required to build
on muskeg or soft ground. In addition, the risk factors associated with construction
and long term maintenance of the roadway over muskeg terrain should be identified.
An engineering and cost/benefit analysis should justify recommendations for
inclusion or removal of the muskeg or soft ground. Muskeg probe logs should be
maintained and included in the report Appendix.
7.6 LA�DSLIDE
Landslide investigations are typically a stand-alone project, however these types of
investigations may also be undertaken as part of a grading design. The scope of the
investigation can range from a site visit to more elaborate, costly drilling and
monitoring programs. The project scope for landslide projects can be complex and
time-critical. Consultants who work on these types of projects must be experienced
geotechnical or geological engineers. It is recommended that senior personnel with
relevant experience be assigned to oversee these projects.
A detailed air photo interpretation shall be included in all landslide projects, in
addition to a thorough review of past site information and nearby sites located in
similar geologic settings.
SECTIO 7 – GEOTECHICAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 7-11
A field visit by the Project Engineer is a prerequisite that must be completed prior to
field drilling. Site observations should be well documented through photographs and
plan view sketches annotated with field observations. The site may be actively failing
such that several visits may be required for the Project Engineer to fully comprehend
and appreciate the failure mode and scale of the project. A multi-staged investigation
may be required, spanning several weeks or months, depending on the level of activity
at the site and the consequences of failure of the slide. The landslide geotechnical
assessment is to be completed in two phases: a preliminary assessment, and a detailed
design.
At least two (2) feasible mitigative options shall be presented in the form of a
preliminary landslide assessment. The preliminary assessment should include
documentation of the investigation completed to date, the various soil parameters
used, appropriate reference sources, relevant slope stability analysis results, and
current instrumentation monitoring results. The preliminary reports should identify
the risk factors at the landslide site, and the associated probability of occurrence and
consequence of occurrence. Relative terms such as low, medium, or high may be used
provided that these subjective terms are well defined. Lack of site information is
considered to be a risk factor, and this should be identified in the preliminary report.
Large true-scale (same scale on both axes) stratigraphic cross-sections shall be
included with the preliminary assessment.
The Department will undertake a review of the preliminary options and direct the
Consultant to continue to detailed design of one (1) approved option. Additional
investigative, monitoring, and analysis requirements may be added after the
Department reviews the preliminary assessment. Any changes to the original scope of
work will be negotiated.
7.7 EXPA�SIVE SOILS
Roadway embankments built on or with expansive soils are known to exhibit
volumetric expansion (heave) or contraction (shrinkage) depending on the moisture
content of the soil and confining stresses acting on the soil. Within embankments,
heaves are often expressed at ground surface as wave-like irregularities, longitudinal
cracking, localized deformations, and/or generalized (alligator) cracking. Localized
heave of a subgrade at transverse crack locations has occurred in Alberta in areas of
expansive soil and is a major concern to the Department. Repair or remedial options
for these issues are generally expensive and disruptive to traffic. It is preferred to
address the presence of these problematic soils during the investigation and design
phase rather than during the operation phase of a road life-cycle.
At the investigation phase, the Consultant should determine the prevalence of soils
with moderate to very high swelling potential within the construction area, including
borrow locations. Lake bed clay deposits and other high plastic clay soils often
possess significant swell and shrinkage potential and are common throughout Alberta.
SECTIO 7 – GEOTECHICAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 7-12
Several published correlations are available to predict swell potential; many are based
on Atterberg limit parameters or soil activity. If required, the swelling potential of
high plastic clays should be quantified through the use of advanced laboratory testing
(e.g. one dimensional swell or settlement potential tests). Where a swelling potential
is identified, consultants are directed to avoid the use of these soils as a road building
material unless it can be demonstrated that no economically viable alternative exists,
and the design and construction procedures are optimized to reduce the influence of
soil expansion. Inclusion of swelling soils in embankment may be done with the
inclusion of capillary breaks or with sufficient overburden confinement. Treatment
with chemicals, such as lime, may reduce swelling potential. Strict compaction
moisture content control (optimum to two percent wet of optimum) would be
expected to be a minimum construction consideration. Compaction of moderate to
very high swell potential soils at conditions dry of optimum shall not be permitted.
7.8 EROSIO�
The Department has developed two manuals (“Design Guidelines for Erosion and
Sediment Control Guidelines for Highways” and “Field Guide for Erosion and
Sediment Control for Highways”) to assist in the assessment and design of erosion
control measures. The first manual addresses issues related to long-term or permanent
erosion control. Primarily consultants use this manual. The second manual addresses
issues related to short-term or construction related erosion and sediment control. This
field manual is intended for use by contractors and consultant field personnel. It
provides guidance for contractors in the development of ECO Plans and erosion
control installation techniques.
The consultant should determine what types of erosion and sediment control measures
are suited to each particular site. The most effective means of sediment control is
erosion prevention; hence the design should be directed to prevention techniques,
where these techniques can be shown to offer practical and economically competitive
solutions. Innovative solutions are encouraged.
Typically there may be several alternative designs appropriate for a given erosion
condition. The permanent erosion control requirements shall be designed using an
engineering approach based on acceptable principles of open channel flow hydraulics
and soil mechanics. At least two (2) feasible options should be prepared identifying
pros and cons, relative costs, and associated risk factors for each option. The designs
shall be supported by documentation of any design assumptions, soil and hydraulic
parameters used in the analysis, method of analysis, and philosophy for selection of a
given erosion control method. Erosion plans and sediment control related to wetlands
and sensitive water bodies may require special design treatment stipulated by other
agencies. Referrals to the appropriate agencies (e.g. Alberta Environmental
Protection) shall be done at an early stage of the design.
SECTIO 7 – GEOTECHICAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 7-13
7.9 ROCK
For projects where bedrock or boulders are encountered (e.g., shale, sandstone, rock
boulders of size 0.5 cubic metres and greater, or a combination of these materials), a
“rock investigation” shall be undertaken as part of the geotechnical investigation. This
rock investigation is to be conducted through rock core drilling and/or test pitting.
The percent recovery and Rock Quality Designation (RQD) of cored materials is to be
reported. Strength tests are to be conducted to determine classification of rock in
terms of the rock classification outlined in the “Canadian Foundation Engineering
Manual”. Seismic or GPR techniques may be useful in determine the bedrock horizon
and in estimating the shear velocity of the rock. Shear velocity can be correlated to
rip-ability, as noted in various equipment supplier handbooks. At this time the
Department recognizes the compressive strength and point load index tests to
determine classification of rock materials for pay item purposes.
For grading projects, a rock investigation report is required as a separate document.
This report shall contain a detailed description of the investigation, test results,
photographs of cores, photographs of test pits, logs of stratigraphy, and quantity and
classification of rock materials. In Section 2.3 of the “Standard Specification for
Highway Construction”, rock materials are classified as either Rippable or Solid
depending upon whether they can be ripped by a D9 size dozer. For payment
purposes, the rock excavation is paid as common excavation (or borrow, etc.) plus an
extra amount for “Rippable Rock Excavation – Premium” or “Solid Rock Excavation
– Premium” as applicable. The rock investigation report shall provide quantity
estimates to support design and tender documents.
7.10 BACKFILLI�G OF TEST HOLES A�D RESTORATIO� OF TEST
PITS
Test pits are considered to be large excavations. Test pits that are not properly
restored may cause premature road distress. Deep excavations along the highway side
slope or ditch may destabilize the embankment. For these reasons where test pits are
to be advanced in an existing roadbed or along the embankment side-slope or along
the ditch at the base of the highway embankment slope; a test pit plan containing the
method of excavation and backfilling test pits is required for approval by the Project
Sponsor.
Test holes are to be properly backfilled in accordance with the established practices of
backfilling test holes. In areas with environmental sensitivity, holes may have to be
backfilled with cement grout, or other approved materials, to avoid cross
contamination of aquifer zones and migration of surface waters or run-off to lower
aquifers. This is especially significant at bridge sites. Each site should be treated
separately and the Consultant shall provide proposed methods for backfilling the test
holes for approval by the Project Sponsor.
SECTIO 7 – GEOTECHICAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 7-14
If test holes are left open for a period of time, for the purposes of monitoring
groundwater or sloughing conditions, provisions shall be made to temporarily cover
and restrict access to the test hole and for permanent backfilling after the monitoring
period is complete. The pavement or gravel surface is to be restored to its original
condition after backfilling. Test holes that are not properly backfilled can cause injury
to humans and livestock that can be a cause for litigation against the Consultant.
7.11 I�STRUME�TATIO� I�STALLATIO� A�D MO�ITORI�G
Whenever instrumentation is required to monitor ground and groundwater conditions,
an instrumentation installation and monitoring report must be prepared and submitted.
A copy of the reduced monitoring data and analysis report must also be submitted to
the Project Sponsor.
Instrumentation shall be protected from environmental hazards such as wildlife,
recreational vehicles, construction traffic, maintenance vehicles, vandalism, etc. All
installations should be well marked with adjacent tall lathe or sturdy posts, and
labelled with permanent markings to identify the installation number, consultant and
drill date. Provisions should be made to provide protective housings for instrument
cables. In developed areas where vandalism is a concern, the used of locked metal
protectors is recommended, especially in highly visible and well trafficked areas.
Excess materials from the field program should be removed from the site and
disposed of at approved dumpsites. It is unacceptable to dispose of any excess
materials on site.
7.12 LABORATORY TESTI�G
Methods of undertaking laboratory testing and reporting for geotechnical purposes are
outlined in ASTM and AASHTO standards with modifications for special non-
standard requirements.
For grading projects, the standard laboratory testing ‘suite’ shall include:
i) Visual description and classification according to Unified Soils
Classification System as modified by the PFRA (ASTM D2487-98)
ii) Field moisture content (ATT-15, Part I or IV as appropriate, or ASTM
D2216)
iii) Atterberg limits (AASHTO Designation T89 or T90 or ASTM D4318
Method A)
iv) Washed sieve analysis, including the 5000, 1250, 315, 160, and 80 metric
sieves (AASHTO Designation T88)
SECTIO 7 – GEOTECHICAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 7-15
The following information shall also be included in these tests and form part of the
summary of test:
i) Estimates of Standard Proctor maximum dry density and optimum moisture
content based on the Department’s tables (refer to the Department’s
Transportation Laboratory Test Procedures)
ii) Plasticity Index and Liquidity Index
Field visual description and classification, and laboratory moisture content tests shall
be conducted on all soils samples.
Additional testing may be required depending on the project requirements. Test
methods for: triaxial; direct shear; consolidation; swell; dispersion; hydraulic
conductivity; rock quality, durability and strength; and other advanced geotechnical
testing shall follow applicable ASTM test methodologies.
7.13 GEOSY�THETIC A�D EROSIO� CO�TROL MATERIALS
The need for geosynthetics and erosion control materials must be supported by an
analysis and design. Specifications for geosynthetic materials shall reference material
properties that are appropriate for the design use intended. The use of ‘generic’ or
‘all-purpose’ specifications is considered appropriate only when these specifications
address the analysis and design requirements of the project. Where judgment is used
in selecting materials, reasons must be provided to show the practical, as well as
economic, benefits of such material usage.
7.14 BOREHOLE DATA REPORTI�G
Reporting of test hole logs shall be done through a geotechnical borehole database
system, such as GCA gINT software (Geotechnical Computer Application), or an
acceptable end product equivalent. A Department customized template for gINT is
available (free of charge) on the gINT website. An electronic copy of all borehole logs
shall be submitted to the Director, Geotechnical and Materials Section.
7.15 PRESE�TATIO� OF SOILS A�D ROCK I�FORMATIO� O�
MOSAICS
Soil descriptions on the mosaics are to consist of the principal soil types. Where rock
or rock type materials are encountered, only the field visual descriptions must be
shown on the mosaic logs with the corresponding graphic symbol. The results of the
identified rock test will normally be made available to bidders.
SECTIO 7 – GEOTECHICAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 7-16
7.16 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS
Where applicable, geotechnical conceptual requirements for planning, design,
construction, and maintenance shall be submitted for discussion and evaluation at an
early stage of the project life cycle. Content requirements for geotechnical reports are
outlined in Table A and preceding subsection.
The methods for field work, laboratory work, and preparation and submission of
reports must be well defined and compatible with the overall design and synchronize
with the project schedule. The geotechnical report must accompany the design when
submitted for review. The grading or bridge design shall have the soils logs and the
proposed erosion and sediment control schemes included. Refer to Section 7.8 for
reporting requirements for permanent erosion control measures. Depending on the
nature of the project, some of this information may be needed at the concept
engineering stage, if acceptance of concepts is required.
The Consultant shall provide two (2) copies of the report to the Project Sponsor,
unless otherwise directed.
The final project report must include a section or sections on the geotechnical issues
identified in the earlier design stages, and how these were treated during construction.
Record drawings (in MicroStation format) must be provided and any variations of
methods, etc., outlined. Comments, notes, and recommendation provided to the
Project Sponsor should be included in the construction completion report.
7.16.1 DIFFERI�G SITE CO�DITIO�S (DSC) CLAUSES
Subsurface conditions are a result of natural geologic processes modified over time by
natural events or the actions of man. Geotechnical investigations are undertaken to
provide subsurface information to the designer and contractor. However,
unanticipated ground conditions can and do occur. Contractors will be paid based on
the terms of their contract. This may involve changes in compensation where
unforeseen conditions are encountered. Nothing can completely remove the risk of
encountering a differing site condition; however, the potential for costly disputes over
what constitutes differing site conditions is greatly reduced through a well-defined
geotechnical baseline. To this end, full disclosure of the geotechnical investigation
report will be available to contractors at the tender stage and at the construction stage
should the Contractor request it. The Consultant is therefore responsible for setting
the geotechnical baseline through the accuracy and factual representations of their
work and to the contract conditions and specifications developed through the
recommendations contained in the report.
Geotechnical reports are composed of factual, interpreted, and qualified information.
It is preferable to include all geotechnical information in the contract documents;
however a stand alone geotechnical report can be referenced in the contract
SECTIO 7 – GEOTECHICAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 7-17
documents and made available at a prescribed time and location for inspection by the
bidders. Factual information includes test hole logs, field and lab test results, and the
like. Interpreted information represents the opinions of a qualified geotechnical
engineer based on the factual information. This should describe the thought process
that led to the design, specifications, and special provisions included on the plans and
in the contract documents. Qualified information is factual information where the
source of the data was not under direct control of the geotechnical design staff.
Historical construction records, previous geotechnical reports, and the like are
examples of qualified information.
There are two principle types of DSC claims. A Type I DSC refers to subsurface or
latent physical conditions at the site, including surface conditions that differ
materially from those indicated in the contract. Type I DSC is usually related to the
factual information presented in the contract. A Type II DSC refers to unknown
physical conditions at the site of an unusual nature differing from those ordinarily
encountered and generally recognized as to be inherent in work of the character
provided for in the contract. Type II DSC is usually related to the interpreted
information presented in the contract. Both types of DSC can be greatly reduced
through the establishment of a well defined geotechnical baseline with which to
compare the encountered site conditions and the predicted or interpreted site
conditions. To this end, the Consultant should be neither overly optimistic about site
conditions nor overly pessimistic, but should rely on a rational and objective approach
to interpretation of the site conditions.
Specific disclaimer clauses can be used as plan notes to define factual and interpreted
information, particularly in the case of bridge and culvert projects. This is preferred to
the inclusion of blanket or general disclaimer. An example of a specific clause might
be: “The test hole logs for TH100 to TH110 are representative of the condition at the
location where each boring was made but conditions may vary between test holes.”
This note indicates that the Consultant has used proper drilling techniques to locate,
drill and log the test holes shown on the plans and documents. Soil conditions
encountered at the location of the test holes that differ materially from those stated on
the logs form the basis of a Type I DSC. Soil conditions between boreholes that differ
substantially from those noted at the test hole locations, or that could not have been
reasonably interpreted from the drilling logs, or that are unknown in the region would
form the basis of a Type II DSC.
SECTIO 7 – GEOTECHICAL COSIDERATIOS
�ovember 2011 7-18
Current References for Section 7:
Below are references identified in this Section. Please see the Department website for a complete list of available
documents.
American Association for State Highway and Transportation Officials (AASHTO) – Provisional Standards and Volume II
Test, 1995, AASHTO
American Society for Testing Materials (ASTM) Specifications, 1996, ASTM
Canadian Foundation Engineering Manual, 4th Edition, 2006, Canadian Geotechnical Society
Canadian System of Soil Classification, 1987, Agriculture Canada
Design Guidelines for Erosion and Sediment Control for Highways, 2003, Alberta Transportation.
Field Guide for Erosion and Sediment Control for Highways, 2003, Alberta Transportation
Guidelines for Consulting Geotechnical Engineers and Technologists Assignments, May 1998, Alberta Transportation
Standard Specifications for Highway Construction, Current, Alberta Transportation
SECTIO 8 –GEOMETRIC DESIG
�ovember 2011 8-1
SECTIO� 8 - GEOMETRIC DESIG�
8.1 GE�ERAL
Before undertaking any geometric design, designers are to revisit any pertinent
planning and Terms of Reference documents to examine basic assumptions, current
design practices, concepts, staging plans, cost-effectiveness (based on life cycle
costing methods), safety, preservation of design flexibility for the future, and other
considerations. The designer shall ensure that all decisions related to the above are
fully explored, discussed and agreed with the Project Sponsor before proceeding with
geometric design.
The Consultant shall use the Department’s “Highway Geometric Design Guide” and
Design Bulletins for all geometric design. The Consultant is responsible for all
highway design activities including but not limited to:
� Grading and geometric design including horizontal and vertical alignment grade
lines, passing lanes, climbing lanes, intersection geometric layout, interchange and
roadside turnouts
� Establishment of cross-section elements, drainage design (including culverts, curb
and gutter, storm sewers), fencing design, retaining walls, etc.
� Roadside facilities (refer to Chapter “F” of the “Highway Geometric Design
Guide”)
� Access management (refer to Chapter “I” of the “Highway Geometric Design
Guide”)
� Roadside design (refer to the Department’s “Roadside Design Guide”)
� Railway crossings (at-grade and grade separated)
� Coordination of utility relocations and preparation of crossing agreements
� Seeding
� Signing
� Guide posts (delineators)
� Pavement markings
� Preparation of the Grading Design Package (see Section 8.1.1)
� Special First Nations Agreements (Special Provisions for contract, etc.) if required
(see Section 1.4.4)
� Optimization of stream and grade separation bridge crossings including
geometrics, grading, bridge planning, and structural design considerations
� Pedestrian, cyclist, and pathway accommodation and geometrics in accordance
with the “Roadside Design Guide” and TAC standards
A “Consultant Highway Grading/Surfacing Design Coordination Flow Diagram” is
provided for guidance in Appendix E.
SECTIO 8 –GEOMETRIC DESIG
�ovember 2011 8-2
The Consultant shall prepare a detailed computer aided design package for contract
tendering. The Consultant shall use an appropriate and proven roadway design
software package for geometric design, earthwork and quantity calculations, cross
sectioning, and mass-haul diagrams. All work shall be done in accordance with
applicable guidelines, standards, and specifications. Standard drawings shall be used
wherever possible. For relatively simple projects, especially if the grading work will
be tendered as a lump sum contract, a design produced manually (without the aid of
computers) may be acceptable. Information submitted for tendering purposes must be
in electronic format.
8.1.1 GRADI�G DESIG� PACKAGE
The Consultant shall prepare a grading design package which will provide all the
necessary details for the grading component of the Tender Package (see Section 11.1).
The grading design package includes the following detailed design work:
� Design Exceptions (documents, economic analysis, etc.)
� Grading Estimate Summary
�OTE: A grading estimate summary for each project is required for multiple
project submission
� Summary of Estimated Grading Quantities
� Unit Price Analysis
� Intersection Analysis
� Bridge documentation (written instructions, sketch) with Estimate Sheet
� Design Review (Minutes of Review Meetings)
� Pavement Design cross-section
� Utility Crossing Agreements and Adjustment Estimate (including all applicable
Approvals, licenses, permits)
� Geotechnical requirements
� Illumination requirements
� Signing requirements
� Fencing requirements
� Drainage and culvert requirements and drainage notes
� Notes to Consultant’s Representative
� Applicable Special Provisions, Specification Amendments, and Supplemental
Specifications
� Lists of Standard Drawings and Special Drawings
� One set of full size and one (1) set of reduced (11”x17”) mosaic* plan-profile
drawings, plans for intersection geometric layout, utility plans, overhaul diagram,
and other special drawings (signed as required for tendering) in MicroStation
format.
� Contract Location Map (Key Plan)
* Air photo mosaics as stipulated in Appendix D are required in PDF format for the
full size (22”x34”) drawings unless otherwise specified in the Terms of
SECTIO 8 –GEOMETRIC DESIG
�ovember 2011 8-3
Reference. The 11”x17” drawings (reduced sized mosaic plans) shall be submitted
without the photo mosaic image.
8.2 ROADSIDE FACILITIES
The Consultant shall assess the need for roadside facilities such as roadside turnouts,
vehicle inspection stations, historical turnouts, etc. Consultants should review the
latest information in Design Bulletins as well as the design content in this regard. The
work required may involve upgrading of existing facilities or construction of new
facilities. The Consultant should first review the Terms of Reference and any relevant
design or planning documents (Geometric Assessments, files, and reports) for
direction on this subject. Planning Reports are available which identify the suggested
spacing and approximate location of roadside turnouts on all divided highways and
some undivided highways in the Province. Contact the Highway and Roadside
Planning Section of Technical Standards Branch for more information. If there is no
clear direction contained in these documents, the Consultant shall ask for direction
from the Project Sponsor on the adequacy of existing facilities as well as the need and
feasibility of constructing additional roadside facilities on the project and on adjacent
segments of highway. The general guidelines regarding spacing of roadside facilities
contained in Chapter F of the “Highway Geometric Design Guide”, together with a
review of on-site conditions, may be used to gauge the need for new or improved
roadside facilities. Any additional roadside facilities that are considered desirable or
necessary should be brought to the attention of the Project Sponsor for concurrence
before proceeding with right-of-way purchases, survey or detailed design.
8.3 I�TERSECTIO� DESIG�
The Consultant shall prepare intersectional analysis using traffic volumes, turning
movement diagrams, and collision history which can be obtained from the
Department. The Consultant shall also review with the Department Project Sponsor
prior to finalizing the intersection design. Guidelines regarding intersection design
can be found in the Chapter D of the “Highway Geometric Design Guide”.
8.4 RIGHT-OF-WAY A�D BORROW
The Consultant shall assess the need for right-of-way or borrow based on design
information and basic right-of-way requirements. The Consultant shall, as required,
prepare plans for right-of-way purchase, and Borrow Agreements to obtain final
agreements between the Department and landowners. See Section 3 for more detail.
SECTIO 8 –GEOMETRIC DESIG
�ovember 2011 8-4
8.5 ROADSIDE DESIG� (Clear Zone, Mitigation of Hazards, Barrier
Protection, etc.)
On new construction projects the Consultant shall evaluate the traffic volume, traffic
speed, highway function, terrain type, and typical hazards and develop an appropriate
strategy for clear zone, mitigation of hazards, and barrier protection for the project.
The design of guardrail at the edge of the finished road surface shall be minimized
through the use of flatter side slopes and berms to either eliminate or offset the
guardrail. Recommended fill heights and side-slopes shall be used to reduce the
extent of guardrail installation. On existing highways, the Consultant shall carry out
all necessary survey, inspection, and evaluation of existing traffic barriers. Efforts
shall be made to eliminate the need for traffic barriers wherever possible by reducing
the severity of hazards, relocating fixed objects outside of the clear zone and side-
slope improvement. When assessing the need for traffic barriers, all scenarios shall be
examined to achieve the best possible engineering solution to minimize risks and cost
to road users, the Department, etc. In some cases, the preferred solution may involve
no protection being used. Where it has been decided that existing barrier shall be
retained/replaced, the condition of the various components should be assessed for
possible replacement. Wood components will generally need replacement when they
have rotted, cracked, or become weakened due to age or weathering.
Where necessary, barrier installations shall be designed with locations shown on the
roadway design plans. The “Roadside Design Guide” shall be used as a guide for the
choice of barrier system type. Where more than one barrier system is suitable for a
project, the Department normally prefers the more forgiving type (i.e. the one
expected to produce less severe collisions). Therefore flexible systems (such as high
tension cable barrier) are preferred over semi-rigid systems (such as the strong post
W-beam) which are in turn preferred over rigid systems (such as concrete barriers).
The choice shall be suitable for the highway type and AADT. Similarly, the types of
end treatments to be used shall be in accordance with the “Roadside Design Guide”.
Bridge rails and approach guardrail transitions shall meet requirements of the “Bridge
Structures Design Criteria”.
8.6 RAILWAY CROSSI�GS
The Consultant shall produce design plans for each railway crossing that is created or
modified as a result of the highway improvement project.
The design submission package for each crossing shall include, in addition to the
crossing design plan, the required Environmental Screening Report, a road and
railway traffic estimate, and all other documentation required for an application for
approval to carry out the proposed work. In some cases, commitments related to cost
sharing and maintenance distribution will be involved. As the approval process may
take up to 18 months to complete, the Consultant shall complete this phase of the
project as early as possible.
SECTIO 8 –GEOMETRIC DESIG
�ovember 2011 8-5
Consultants doing this work shall make themselves familiar with Railway Crossing
Cost-Sharing arrangements and historical agreements. Refer to the “Road/Railway
Grade Crossing Guidelines” for more information.
8.6.1 AT-GRADE CROSSI�GS
The Consultant shall refer to the engineering assessment that is normally completed
prior to design. Refer to Section 5.2.4 in conjunction with the “Road/Railway Grade
Crossing Guidelines” for more details on the at-grade crossing agreement procedures
and engineering and safety standards.
8.6.2 GRADE SEPARATED CROSSI�GS
In addition to the review of the assessment and recommendation mentioned in Section
8.6.1 the Consultant shall undertake the following tasks:
� Bridge assessment
� Bridge planning and DD Drawings
� Evaluation of repair options
� Advisement of adjacent landowners with respect to safety issues
� EARP (Environmental Assessment Review Process) when applicable
� Completion of the structural design, construction drawings, contract documents,
and construction inspections in accordance with Section 10.
8.7 UTILITIES
8.7.1 GE�ERAL
“Utilities” shall mean all power, telecommunications, pipelines, and/or other cables or
lines facilitating a utility system, including Department owned utilities (street lighting
system).
Wherever possible and available, the Consultant shall contact the Department to
obtain the as-built drawings of Department owned utilities. These drawings shall be
included as part of the tender document.
The Consultant shall locate all utilities and prepare plans showing the relocation or
adjustments required and shall begin making arrangements to have the work
performed whenever possible.
The Consultant shall determine the impact to all utilities (including anchoring)
affected by the proposed work. This shall include utility protection, relocations, and
soil stability (stability of the soil beneath existing pipelines and back-slope cut
SECTIO 8 –GEOMETRIC DESIG
�ovember 2011 8-6
stability should all be considered). These impacts shall be conveyed to and
coordinated with the Utility Companies.
The Consultant shall determine, in conjunction with Utility Companies, the most
economical and practical method of utility relocation and/or adjustment by
investigating all possible options such as:
i) Revision of alignment
ii) Highway grade-line adjustment
iii) Concrete slab pipeline protection
iv) Installation of pipe casing
v) Lowering and replacing of pipeline with thick walled pipe
vi) Relocation of the pipeline, power, and telecommunication lines
vii) Thermal protection (water pipelines)
viii) Providing sufficient earth cover (i.e. ditch blocks)
ix) Other recommendations
The Consultant shall search for utilities in proposed borrow locations and avoid
locating such borrows where there is a big impact on buried pipelines, if possible.
In general, borrows shall be located to avoid an impact on buried utilities. Borrow pit
haul roads may need to cross such buried lines. If this is the case, reference must be
made for such a crossing in the contract special provisions and a temporary crossing
agreement must be obtained from the utility companies by the Contractor.
Projects involving utilities relocation or adjustment work require ‘As-Constructed’
drawings upon completion of the work. These drawings shall be prepared by the
Consultant and submitted to the Department as part of the Final Details.
It is the Department’s desire to have all utility relocations completed prior to
commencement of the road Contractor’s work. In some cases, the relocation of utility
work can be done a year ahead. The Consultant should contact the Project Sponsor to
ensure funding is available. The approval for such construction is required from the
Department.
When a pipeline relocation or adjustment work is completed prior to the construction
of the roadway or bridge, the Consultant shall prepare and provide an ‘As-
Constructed’ pipeline crossing plan to the Contractor. This plan shall indicate the
exact horizontal location of the pipeline in relation to the station and offset and the
vertical elevation of the pipeline in relation to the roadway centerline pavement
elevation.
When utilities adjustment/construction work is considered along the highway in the
vicinity where the road construction will be undertaken at the same time, the Utility
Company shall be advised to contact and liaise with the Department’s Consultant to
avoid potential problems with the road construction work. The Consultant shall obtain
SECTIO 8 –GEOMETRIC DESIG
�ovember 2011 8-7
information such as detailed plans/drawings, traffic accommodation, and construction
schedule from the Utility Company and coordinate all the information with the
highway Contractor.
The Consultant shall monitor Utility Companies’ operations for compliance with the
Department’s latest version of the “Traffic Accommodation in Work Zones” manual.
The Consultant shall include Utility Companies contact names and emergency
telephone numbers in the special provisions and forward the final drawing(s) to the
respective Utility Companies.
8.7.2 COORDI�ATIO�
The Consultant shall coordinate with all Utility Companies at the following milestone
dates of the design, tender, and construction process:
i) Detailed Design (mid-design stage): The Consultant shall provide updated
mosaic plans, utility crossing plans with the existing utilities shown on
them, and a letter of confirmation from the Consultant to authorize Utility
Companies to proceed with the work. For simpler projects, such as
intersectional improvements, intersection plans with hand-sketched
locations of the utilities will be sufficient. All plans at this stage should be
marked “Preliminary”. This shall be completed as early as possible, to
provide the Utility Companies enough lead time for preparing adjustments
to the design. It is recommended that the Consultant hold interim
coordination meetings as required to discuss the on-going design with the
Utility Companies. The Consultant should request the Utility Companies
to commence their adjustment design and their preparation of estimated
costs at this time.
ii) Final Design: The Consultant shall submit design drawings, utility crossing
plans, and copies of the agreements for final design review to all affected
Utility Companies. At this stage, the Consultant shall finalize the utility
adjustment costs by requesting the final costs in writing from the Utility
Companies. This shall be done a minimum of two (2) weeks prior to the
Final Design Review Meeting. (See Appendix H for sample agreements
and letters)
iii) Final Design Review Meeting: The Consultant may invite all Utility
Companies to the Final Design Review Meeting. All design concerns and
costs associated with the utilities shall be finalized at this stage. A letter of
confirmation is requested by the Consultant and provided by Utility
Companies indicating the final costs, the cost sharing arrangement with
the Department, and the starting and completion dates.
SECTIO 8 –GEOMETRIC DESIG
�ovember 2011 8-8
iv) Signing of Crossing Agreements: The Consultant shall get all agreements
signed, with agreed costs, within the Department’s right-of-way, the
Department standard crossing agreement shall be used (See Appendix H).
As-built/Record drawings from the Department are available prior to
tendering (one month in advance of tendering). The as-built drawings shall
be included in the contract documents.
v) The Consultant should provide a table listing all the utilities within the limits
of the project. This table will be provided in the Special Provision as part
of the tender document. An example is given as below:
Station to
Station
Angle to Centerline Offset Utility Name Product or Voltage Comments
10+000 45 degrees LH fwd ATCO Pipelines High Pressure
Natural Gas
Xing Agreement
# APL 31313
5+000 to
15+750
Parallel - Eastside 23.0 Rt Fortis 500 KV power line
7+500 30 degrees RH fwd Star Gas Sour Gas
1+000 to
21+000
Parallel - Westside 11.3 Lt TELUS 400 pair phone line To be Abandoned
vi) Tender Advertising: The Consultant shall inform all Utility Companies
affected by the work about the tender advertising date and the tender
opening date. This shall be done in writing.
vii) Pre-Tender Meeting (Optional): If a pre-tender meeting is held, the Consultant
may consider inviting the Utility Companies depending on the nature of
the meeting and the level of impact the utilities are to the project.
viii) Construction Schedule: Once the successful Contractor’s schedule is provided
to the Consultant he shall provide this schedule to all Utility Companies
affected by the work. At this stage, a letter should be sent by the
Consultant to the Contractor with a copy to the Utility Company indicating
that the Contractor is responsible for all utility coordination henceforth.
ix) Pre-Construction Meeting: The Consultant may invite all Utility Companies to
the main Pre-Construction meeting to coordinate the Contractor’s
interaction with the Utility Companies. The meeting chaired by the
Consultant with the Utility Companies and the Contractor can be held
separately from the main Pre-Construction meeting.
8.7.3 UTILITY EASEME�TS A�D CLEARI�G
The Consultant shall review the need for Utility easements along the project with the
Utility Companies and provide this information to the Department’s Land Agent
(internal or external). The Consultant shall also advise Utility Companies that
additional easements are required. The Department Land Agent will not negotiate for
SECTIO 8 –GEOMETRIC DESIG
�ovember 2011 8-9
any easements on behalf of Utility Companies, but may advise the land owners so the
land owners clearly understand the impact to their land.
The Consultant shall provide the name and telephone number of the Department’s
Land Agent to all Utility Companies. It is recommended that the Utility Companies
should negotiate easements with the land owners at the same time as Department.
Utility Company can contact the land owner separately to obtain their own easements.
The Consultant shall coordinate with the Utility Companies to determine the need and
timing for clearing within the right-of-way and easements (existing and/or proposed).
The Consultant shall consider the following options:
� Clearing to be completed as per the Department’s construction contract (standard
practice). If timing is a concern, the Consultant may, if permitted by the Project
Sponsor, specify an earlier completion date for the clearing in the Tender
document
� The Utility Company provides their own clearing for their utility relocation unless
otherwise specified
� A separate Department contract is prepared for clearing the right-of-way and
easements
� The Utility Company clears the highway right-of-way and their easements under
their own contract. The Utility Company’s contract must contain the same level of
clearing and timber salvage specifications as in a Department contract
When applicable, the Consultant shall discuss these options with the Project Sponsor,
and the Project Sponsor shall make the decision on which option is to be used.
The cost for the highway right-of-way clearing typically will be paid by the
Department. The cost for the utility easement clearing will normally be paid by the
Utility Company except as specified below.
When utility easements from land owners are obtained and registered by the Utility
Company before arrival of the Department’s clearing Contractor, the Department will
clear any proposed easements by the Utility Company at the Department’s cost. The
Utility Companies must notify this to the Consultant in writing. Failure to do so will
result in the cost of clearing the proposed utility easements remaining with the
responsibility of the Utility Companies.
When there is no existing easement, or the existing easement is not cleared, the
Department will not pay for clearing in any old or new easements.
SECTIO 8 –GEOMETRIC DESIG
�ovember 2011 8-10
8.7.4 CROSSI�G ADJUSTME�T AGREEME�TS
The Consultant shall first check with the Project Sponsor to see if any historical
agreements and permits for utility work exist and to review the approval condition(s)
of a particular utility installation. Older “Utility Construction” agreements (which
may only be useful for new alignments) are stored in the Semi-Active Records Centre
at the Twin Atria Building. Utility crossing agreements stored in the Semi-Active
Records Centre may be accessed by reference to the legal land description at the
crossing location. Request for Corporate Bridge Information form and Historical
Agreements/Permits District Contact Persons list may be obtained from the Senior
Utilities Engineer, Technical Standards Branch.
The following are the current general practices which apply to cost responsibility
for utility relocations/adjustments:
� Power lines - Those within the right-of-way are adjusted/ relocated at the Utility
Company’s cost. Distribution lines (less than 69kv) anywhere outside the right-of-
way are relocated at the Department’s cost. Transmission lines (greater than 69kv)
within 30 metres of the right-of-way (particularly paralleling lines) may have a
condition requiring the Department’s approval but the Utility Company is
responsible for the relocation costs. The Department has a master agreement with
ATCO Electric and Fortis for the placement of their lines within primary highway
rights-of-way.
� Existing lighting located along three digit provincial highways – While working
with three digit provincial highways which were previously under the
Municipalities’ jurisdiction, Consultants should check with Municipalities for
copies of permits and agreements. The Department will honour these agreements
signed by the Municipalities until they expire.
� Telecommunication lines - Those within the right-of-way (ROW) are adjusted/
relocated at Utilities Companies’ cost. Those outside the right-of-way are
adjusted/ relocated at the Department’s expense. The Department has a master
agreement with TELUS and AltaLink dealing with their lines within primary
highway right-of-way. There are and will likely be more agreements with other
telecommunication companies such as Shaw Cable, Total Telecom, etc.
� Pipelines governed by the Pipeline Act (major oil and gas lines) - For these types
of crossings, generally the Department pays for adjustments and relocations
outside the Department right-of-way. Those within the Department’s right-of-way
are adjusted/relocated at the Pipeline Company’s cost.
� Lines which run parallel highways are normally positioned (by practice) at a
minimum offset of 30 metres outside of the right-of-way boundary (any line offset
at 30 metres or greater from the right-of-way boundary does not require the
SECTIO 8 –GEOMETRIC DESIG
�ovember 2011 8-11
Department’s approval). Where there are cases of these pipelines paralleling a
highway within 30 metres outside the right-of-way, the Department’s approval
may have included a condition that the company pays for future adjustments or
relocations. It is very rare that these lines will be found paralleling the highway
within the right-of-way. If this is the case, it is very likely that an agreement or
condition of approval exists, making the Utility Company responsible for any
adjustments/relocations.
� Pipelines governed by the Public Highways Development Act (water, sewer, low-
pressure gas) - Any of these lines located within 30 metres outside the highway
right-of-way require the Department’s approval. Generally, lines within the
highway right-of-way paralleling the roadway are adjusted or relocated at the cost
of the Utility Company. There may be permit/approval condition(s) applied to a
paralleling line within 30 metres outside the right-of-way requiring the owner to
adjust/relocate the line at his own cost. For many gas cooperatives, if not all, there
are agreements in place which deal with relocation/adjustment costs.
If, prior to the construction of a new pipeline crossing, the Department issues a
permit and specifies that the crossing be at a particular depth and/or location, the
Company must meet these specifications. If the Utility Company chooses not to
meet these specifications and elects to construct the new pipeline crossing, to
current minimum standards, as set out in the Energy Resources Conservation
Board Act and subsequent relocation is required by the Department, the relocation
will be at the sole cost of the Utility Company.
In the case where the road right-of-way within the crossing area, is widened as
requested by the Department, beyond the width defined in the permit as required for
the improvement of the road, the cost to adjust or lower, or relocate that portion of the
pipeline within the added right-of-way will be borne by the Department. The portion
of the pipeline within the Department’s original (the existing) right-of-way will be
borne by the Pipeline Company unless there is a governing cost sharing agreement.
Prior to submitting for Department’s approval, the Consultant shall finalize and sign
utility plans/drawings based on negotiations and crossing agreements with the Utility
Companies.
The Consultant shall use standard Department crossing agreements. Examples of
typical agreements to be used for adjustments to telecommunications, power, pipeline
utilities, and railway crossing material cost are shown in Appendix H or the “Alberta
Transportation Utility Guidance Manual”. Any cost implications are to be attached to
the agreements. The Project Sponsor will be a signatory in all crossing agreements
and cost apportionment as per the Department policy.
All agreements shall be in place prior to tendering (one month in advance of
tendering).
SECTIO 8 –GEOMETRIC DESIG
�ovember 2011 8-12
8.7.5 UTILITY AGREEME�TS
Within the Department’s right-of-way, a Standard Crossing Agreement shall be used.
The Utility Agreement shall also include the following:
� The Utility Company must implement traffic accommodation procedures in
accordance with the Department’s typical standards outlined in the latest version
of “Traffic Accommodation in Work Zones” manual when working inside the
highway right-of-way
� The Consultant’s role and responsibility to deal with utility construction is
outlined in the latest version of “Traffic Accommodation in Work Zones” manual
8.7.6 UTILITY SPECIAL PROVISIO�S
The Consultant shall prepare utility special provisions based on the above
negotiations and agreements. See Section 11.1.4 for more information on accessing an
up-to-date version of the standard Special Provisions.
8.8 SEEDI�G
The Consultant shall prepare seeding and fertilizer requirements for disturbed areas.
See Section 11.1.4 for more information on accessing an up-to-date version of the
standard Special Provisions.
8.9 SIG�I�G
The Consultant is responsible for preparing an inventory of existing permanent signs
(which will identify signs, posts, etc. that may be reused) and produce a plan of all
permanent signs required for the project. The tender documents for a project will need
to show the number of “remove and re-install” as well as the number of “supply and
install” signs. Standard signing plans may be used in some cases, for example for
standard intersection treatments or for climbing/passing lanes (see the “Traffic
Control Standards Manual”). Customized plans shall be prepared whenever the
standard plans do not show the necessary detail. The plan shall include any signing
off the site which is required as a consequence of the project. Approval of the Project
Sponsor is required for customized signing plans.
A best practice guideline for the selection of sign materials is available on the
Department’s website.
SECTIO 8 –GEOMETRIC DESIG
�ovember 2011 8-13
If identified by the Project Sponsor in the Terms of Reference, the above plans may
be used for bidding purposes on a lump sum basis (rather than the conventional
payment per sign method).
A detailed schedule of all signing requirements must be prepared and made available
at the tendering stage if a lump sum bid is used. A Special Provision may be used to
modify the payment method.
8.9.1 PRIVATELY OW�ED SIG�S
The Consultant shall be aware that the Department has several sign programs
available to private facilities and businesses along highways. The Department leases
or assigns space in the highway right-of-way for placement of these signs, and the
private sign owners are responsible for the installation and maintenance of their own
signs. Any adjustment to these private signs, such as removal and reinstallation during
construction, are the private sign owners’ responsibility. Examples of privately owned
signs include Community Business Signs, Sponsorship Signs, Brown Facility Signs,
etc.
The Consultant shall prepare a list of existing private signs requiring adjustment along
the highway, including the sign owners’ contact information. The Consultant shall
obtain the ownership information and existing lease agreements for the privately
owned signs from the appropriate Department Regional Offices. The Consultant shall
include Special Provisions in the tender document outlining the Contractor’s
responsibility for arranging sign adjustments with sign owners prior to construction
activities. These privately owned signs are excluded from the bid item schedule, as
the Department will not compensate the Contractor for removal and installation of
private signs.
8.10 GUIDEPOSTS (DELI�EATORS)
Delineators shall be designed as per the design guidelines contained in Section C7 of
the “Highway Pavement Marking Guide” and “Traffic Accommodation in Work
Zones” manual. These guides provide warrants, recommended spacing, and
installation details for delineators.
8.11 PAVEME�T MARKI�GS (COMBI�ED GRADI�G/ SURFACI�G
PROJECTS A�D SURFACI�G PROJECTS)
The pavement marking requirements for all intersections, interchanges, passing lanes,
rest areas, vehicle inspection stations, auxiliary lanes, and similar highway features
shall be shown. This may be done through the use of standard plans where applicable
SECTIO 8 –GEOMETRIC DESIG
�ovember 2011 8-14
(see the “Alberta Highway Pavement Marking Guide”) or through the use of
customized plans for the project.
The Consultant shall identify pavement markings (including pavement messages)
required for school zones, railway crossings, R.C.M.P. aircraft patrol zones, stop
lines, etc., where these are required on the project.
If identified by the Project Sponsor in the project Terms of Reference, the above plans
may be used for tendering purposes on a lump sum basis (rather than the conventional
payment by quantity method).
8.11.1 LA�E WIDTHS (PAI�TI�G)
Because lane width standards have changed over the years, there is a need to follow a
consistent practice to implement the current standards. The current practice for
painting lane widths on rural and urban roadways is as follows:
1. Normal maintenance involves repainting lines in the same location as the existing
lines. This avoids the problem of having two lines visible.
2. When projects come up for construction or pavement rehabilitation, lane widths
are painted as per the current geometric design standards. This includes all types
of construction contracts (e.g. new construction, grade widening, overlay, seal-
coat, etc.). After the roadway has been built to the current metric standards,
periodic repainting will preserve the standard lane width.
8.12 RUMBLE STRIPS
Rumble strips will normally be installed in regular highway projects whenever a new
paved surface is constructed.
Guidelines for placement (utilization) of rumble strips on shoulders, centerlines, and
at stop conditions are available from the Technical Standards Branch. These
guidelines/practices have been developed based on experience and take into
consideration accommodation of cyclists, mitigation of noise near residences,
collision experience at intersections and on curves, and other factors. These
guidelines/practices are shown on the relevant standard drawings.
8.13 HIGHWAY ILLUMI�ATIO� (LIGHTI�G)
The Consultant shall prepare plans identifying all existing highway illumination
systems which will require modification, expansion, or replacement on the project,
SECTIO 8 –GEOMETRIC DESIG
�ovember 2011 8-15
and recommend new lighting installations which may be required as a result of the
highway construction or improvement.
Consultants shall be aware that:
� Lighting design shall be the Consultant’s responsibility (the electrical utility
company may provide design input and advice) and shall be included in the
Tender Package
� Each lighting installation is the subject of an agreement with the Department
� Where additions or alterations to existing lighting arrangements are proposed, the
Consultant shall research the ownership and operating conditions pertaining to the
existing installation
� Because of time requirements, it is necessary that lighting needs be identified
early in the project design to allow for discussion/concurrence with the Project
Sponsor, detailed design, review, and co-ordination with electrical utility
companies
� The Consultant shall prepare a draft agreement to be signed by the electrical utility
company and the Department, detailing the capital and operating costs and any
proposed cost sharing arrangement
Warrants and Operating Guidelines for Highway Lighting should be referenced from
the “Guide for Design of Roadway Lighting”.
8.14 TRAFFIC CO�TROL SIG�ALS
The Consultant shall produce a plan for each traffic control signal and/or pedestrian
crosswalk signal that may be required on the project. The plan shall include all details
of the signals, signs, markings, roadway geometrics, and ancillary features.
The warrant for traffic control signals will normally be 80 percent of the traffic and
safety warrant contained in the “Manual of Uniform Traffic Control Devices for
Canada”. As signal installations are normally subject to internal Departmental review
and approval, the Consultant shall identify potential signal requirements prior to
undertaking the actual design.
8.15 I�DEPE�DE�T DESIG� CHECK
The Consultant shall carry out a complete check of the design and drawings (stamped
and signed) using an engineer other than the individual responsible for the design.
SECTIO 8 –GEOMETRIC DESIG
�ovember 2011 8-16
8.16 FI�AL DESIG� REVIEW
If required, a final design review meeting will be organized and attended by the
Consultant, Project Sponsor, and representatives of other concerned branches of the
Department. The Consultant will select the time and place for the meeting (after
consultation with the Project Sponsor), will establish an agenda and shall act as
chairperson at the meeting.
Assuming that all significant design decisions have been made at this point, this
meeting should concentrate on reviewing the final design, confirming that all
necessary changes have been made, finalizing, and packaging the design (including
the drawings) for submission. Specification shells, Special Provision requirements,
etc., should be checked and tender schedule and design submission date confirmed.
8.17 COST SUMMARY
Where the “C” estimate for the project exceeds the approved funding (“B” Estimate)
by more than 20 percent, the Consultant shall provide written reasons for the increase
in estimated cost.
8.18 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS
The Consultant shall deliver the final roadway design to the Project Sponsor for
review no later than two (2) weeks before the date scheduled for delivery of the final
tender package. See Section 11.1.7 for information on timing for submission of the
finalized Contract Tender Package.
The final roadway design package shall include both electronic and hard copy of the
tender documents, and an electronic copy and set of blueprints of the plans.
Documents and plans required for record purposes are listed under Roadway Design
in Appendix K. The Roadway Tender Package requirements are included in Section
11.1.
SECTIO 8 –GEOMETRIC DESIG
�ovember 2011 8-17
Current References for Section 8:
Below are references identified in this Section. Please see the Department website for a complete list of available
documents.
Alberta Transportation Utility Guidance Manual, 2001, Alberta Transportation
Bridge Structures Design Criteria, Current, Alberta Transportation
Guide for Design of Roadway Lighting, 1983, TAC
Highway Geometric Design Guide, 1999, Alberta Transportation
Highway Pavement Marking Guide, 2003, Alberta Transportation
Manual of Uniform Traffic Control Devices for Canada, 1996, TAC
Road/Railway Grade Crossing Guidelines, 1997, Alberta Transportation
Roadside Design Guide, 2007, Alberta Transportation
Traffic Accommodation in Work Zones, 2008, Alberta Transportation
Traffic Control Standards Manual, 1995, Alberta Transportation
SECTIO 8 –GEOMETRIC DESIG
�ovember 2011 8-18
This page left blank intentionally.
SECTIO 9 – SURFACIG DESIG
�ovember 2011 9-1
SECTIO� 9 - SURFACI�G DESIG�
9.1 GE�ERAL
This section deals with the detailed design, quantity estimates, and related
requirements for all projects with a surfacing component. Other items identified under
Section 5 through 8 must also be addressed, as required, to provide a complete
design/tender package.
Surfacing includes:
� First course gravel for grading projects
� Base and paving (either first or full stage placement)
� Final paving
� Portland cement concrete pavement
� Pavement rehabilitation
� Surface treatments (seal coats or micro-surfacing)
� In-place recycling (CIR, HIR, FDR)
9.2 SURFACI�G DESIG� PACKAGE
The Consultant shall complete a Surfacing Design package (using the Department’s
standard format as per Appendix F) that will include but is not limited to:
� Basic surfacing strategy
� Detailed structural design
� Aggregate requirements
� Binder material
� Special Provisions (if needed)
� Supplemental specifications and specification amendments (if required)
� Bid items description
� Quantity and cost estimates
�OTE: A surfacing estimate for each project (combined projects) and a surfacing
estimate summary are essential requirements for every job submitted to
Program Management Branch.
� Plans
� Pavement markings (see Section 8.11)
The Surfacing Design and Tender Package (see Section 11.1) shall consist of all
information needed for tendering purposes. Detailed surfacing design information
does not have to be submitted with the Surfacing Design and Tender Package;
however, it shall be retained as outlined in Appendix K (Records Management by
Consultants).
SECTIO 9 – SURFACIG DESIG
�ovember 2011 9-2
9.2.1 SURFACI�G STRATEGY A�D BASIC STRUCTURAL DESIG�
The Department’s design practices and philosophies for pavement design are outlined
in the following:
� “Pavement Design Manual”
� “Guidelines for Assessing Pavement Preservation Treatments and Strategies”
� “Alberta Infrastructure Guidelines for Assessment, Rating and Prioritization of
Pavements for Seal Coat”
� Various Design Bulletins
The Consultant shall adhere to the Preliminary Surfacing Strategy as prepared by the
Regional Consultant (see Section 5.3) and included as part of the Information Package
in the Terms of Reference for the project. The Consultant shall perform a site
inspection of the roadway at the time detailed design is being undertaken to pinpoint
and finalize the project limits. The roadway condition shall be assessed to identify and
rationalize the need for preliminary levelling, repair of failed areas, additional ACP
quantities for cross-fall/ super-elevation corrections, and special treatment of cracks.
If for any reason it is deemed necessary to revisit the surfacing strategy and basic
structural design, the work shall be referred to the Project Sponsor and the Surfacing
Standards Specialist, Technical Standards Branch. Examples where the original
assessment or surfacing strategy should be revisited include:
� Stale or outdated designs (i.e. 5 years or older)
� Changed traffic patterns resulting in increased or decreased traffic volumes or
loadings
� Revised mix types or material selection criteria
� Significant deterioration of roadway since completion of the original assessment
or surfacing strategy
� New elements added that were not included in the original assessment such as
climbing lanes, intersection improvements, park/approach roads, etc.
Prior to undertaking new assessments or surfacing strategies the Consultant should
seek guidance from the project sponsor and applicable Department specialist.
For projects where a Preliminary Surfacing Strategy is not available and is not to be
completed by the Regional Consultant, the Consultant shall undertake the necessary
structural design following the above design procedures and practices or procedures
as directed in the Terms of Reference. A draft surfacing strategy shall be submitted to
the Project Sponsor and the Surfacing Standards Specialist for acceptance. After
revisions, if required, the final copy shall also be submitted.
SECTIO 9 – SURFACIG DESIG
�ovember 2011 9-3
9.2.1.1 Pavement and Laboratory Testing
The Consultant shall carry out all necessary laboratory testing and evaluation which
may have been identified in the Terms of Reference or which were deemed necessary
at the detailed engineering stage. The results of this testing and evaluation shall be
documented and appended to the design package.
For projects involving in-place recycling of pavement materials (Hot or Cold-In-Place
Recycling or Full Depth Reclamation) the following information is typically collected
and included within the tender submission:
� Pavement cross-section diagrams indicating the material types, thicknesses,
widths, and year of construction. These are usually contained within the
Preliminary Surfacing Strategy.
� Where available, historical quality assurance test results for the asphalt concrete
pavement materials can be obtained from the Surface Engineering and Aggregate
section. This information is to be summarized in regards to average lift thickness,
asphalt content, aggregate gradation, and percentage of RAP additives (where
applicable).
� The use of ground penetrating radar (GPR), or other methods, may be required for
Full Depth Reclamation projects where the depths of the surfacing materials may
be variable or are in doubt.
If historical quality assurance test results and/or layer thickness data are not available,
or there is doubt in the type or quality of the granular base materials, additional
pavement sampling and laboratory testing may be required. Test data to be collected
includes:
� Pavement material types and layer thicknesses
� Aggregate gradation analysis of asphalt and granular layers
� Two face fracture count of aggregate materials
� Atterberg limits for the fines component of granular base or subbase materials
� Asphalt content of asphalt bound layers
� Rheology testing of recovered asphalt cement (hot in-place recycling only)
� GPR (possible procedure to provide plots on layer thickness)
General sampling frequencies should be in accordance with Transportation
Laboratory test procedure TLT 300 Recycling Asphalt Concrete Pavement.
Test data is to be tabulated and included within the tender documents. Mix designs for
in-place recycling is the Contractor’s responsibility and not normally performed by
the Consultant.
SECTIO 9 – SURFACIG DESIG
�ovember 2011 9-4
9.2.2 GRAVEL SURFACI�G A�D SEAL COAT
Department guidelines for gravel surfacing design and seal coat type are included in
Appendix F.
9.2.3 GEOMETRICS A�D CLEARA�CES
Where the project is primarily a “surfacing” job, the Consultant shall confirm the
appropriate roadway geometrics including minimum vertical clearances allowed
under overpass structures and shall include in the design package all works such as
interchanges (including ramps and loops), intersection treatments, side-slope
improvements, super-elevation corrections, horizontal and vertical alignment
improvements, railway crossings, guardrail design, culverts, and treatment on bridge
decks and approaches to bridge decks. Where the project involves a significant
grading component, the review and analysis of geometric elements is normally
undertaken as part of the Geometric Design. Liaison with the Project Sponsor is
essential.
9.2.4 AGGREGATE REQUIREME�TS
The Consultant shall quantify all aggregate requirements and coordinate aggregate
supply conditions for the project.
The volume of aggregate required needs only to be an estimate based on the major
components of the project. Coordination of the aggregate supply conditions shall be in
accordance with Section 9.3.
9.2.5 ASPHALT MIX TYPE A�D BI�DER SELECTIO�
Asphalt mix type and binder selection shall be as described in the Pavement Design
Manual and associated Design Bulletins. Asphalt binders and mix types are generally
provided as part of the Preliminary Surfacing Strategy; however, when not provided,
the Consultant shall select, specify, and quantify all ACP mix types and binder
materials.
9.2.6 SPECIAL PROVISIO�S
The Consultant shall assemble all necessary standard Special Provisions and develop
such project specific Special Provisions as may be required. Refer to Section 11.1.4
for details on accessing up-to-date versions of the standard Special Provisions.
SECTIO 9 – SURFACIG DESIG
�ovember 2011 9-5
9.2.7 SUPPLEME�TAL SPECIFICATIO�S & SPECIFICATIO�
AME�DME�TS
The Consultant shall identify all supplemental specifications and specification
amendments applicable to the project.
9.2.8 BID ITEMS QUA�TITY A�D COST ESTIMATES
The Consultant shall provide detailed bid item descriptions, bid item codes, quantity
and cost estimates and summaries for the required surfacing work in the Department
standard format. Examples of this format are included in Appendix F. Note that for
estimating purposes, a factor of 2.33 t/m3 is used for converting compacted granular
and asphalt material quantities to tonnes.
If multiple projects are to be included in the contract works, a materials distribution
chart must be included in the tender document. A sample of this chart is included in
Appendix F.
The Consultant shall discuss with the local Maintenance Contract Inspector or Project
Sponsor if there is a need to include the bid item “Asphalt Mix for Others”.
Where applicable, the Consultant shall also include bid item descriptions and cost
estimates for:
� Roadway and intersection line painting
� “Milled” rumble strips on shoulders, at centre-lines, or at stop locations
� Side sloping
� Guardrail (removals and installations) signing
� Any sidewalk, raised median, or curb and gutter requirements
9.2.9 PLA�S
The Consultant shall provide a key plan showing the project location and limits, plus
the location of all major intersections, bridge structures, vehicle turnouts, and
climbing lanes included within the project limits or scope of works. Detailed
customized plans of intersections need only be provided where new construction or
changes in layout are involved. An example of the necessary key plan is included in
Appendix F.
In addition, the Consultant shall produce all necessary drawings to provide clear
delineation of the work required.
The Consultant shall attach aggregate plans as part of the design tender package.
SECTIO 9 – SURFACIG DESIG
�ovember 2011 9-6
9.2.10 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS
The Consultant shall deliver the complete Surfacing Design Package to the Project
Sponsor for review no later than two (2) weeks before the date scheduled for delivery
of the final tender package. See Section 11.1.7 for information on timing and details
for submission of the finalized tender package.
9.3 SUPPLY OF AGGREGATE
9.3.1 AGGREGATE SOURCES
9.3.1.1 General
These guidelines cover the consultant responsibilities related to Specification 5.2
Supply of Aggregate and to a lesser extent, Specification 3.2 Aggregate Production
and Stockpiling in the “Standard Specifications for Highway Construction”. A
description of the various categories of aggregate sources is provided in Section 5.2.2
of Specification 5.2. The two main categories are:
� Aggregate sources controlled by the Department
� Aggregate sources not controlled by the Department
Each category is further sub-divided based upon “legal status” (Department owned or
controlled source, crown source, or private source). The Consultant must be familiar
with the specifications and tendering/payment practices regarding Supply of
Aggregate including the legal status of any sources being offered to, or that has been
selected, by the Contractor.
In general, the Contractor is responsible for the supply of aggregate materials. To
assure an economical supply of aggregates and to obtain competitive bids, a
Department controlled aggregate source will normally be offered as an option. In
some cases the Contractor is required to use a specified source controlled by the
Department (Designated Source) for all or a portion of the project.
The Department’s policy regarding aggregate management at the construction and
post-construction stage is identified in “Engineering Consultant Guidelines for
Highway and Bridge Projects – Volume 2 – Construction Contract Administration”.
9.3.1.2 Aggregate Data Summary Request
The Consultant shall request an aggregate source from the Regional Aggregate
Coordinator as soon as a reasonable estimate of the gravel component is available. An
electronic copy of the Aggregate Data Summary Request form shall be obtained from
the Regional Aggregate Coordinator.
SECTIO 9 – SURFACIG DESIG
�ovember 2011 9-7
The Aggregate Data Summary Request (Appendix G) shall be used to identify the
project, project limits, type of work, type of material, and the approximate quantity of
aggregate that is required. The request shall be submitted a minimum of six (6) weeks
prior to the tender submission date (unless the Department advances the project on
short notice). The Department will issue to the Consultant the finalized Aggregate
Data Summary Request for all projects, including those with no optional aggregate
source. The Consultant shall use this information in the design. The consultant is
responsible to review the Special Provisions, Plans, and the Aggregate Data Summary
Request, and convert the data for inclusion into the tender documents.
For projects where the tender date is unknown, or the pit is currently unavailable, the
Department may advise that the plans and special provisions will be provided closer
to the tender date.
An amended summary shall be submitted at any time that the aggregate quantity
increases because this may necessitate a change to the pit-operating plan or require a
change to a different aggregate source.
Additionally, any time the Consultant is required to update the “C” Estimate prior to
the tender, the Regional Aggregates Coordinator shall be contacted to ensure the
aggregates information is still relevant.
9.3.1.3 Payment for Supply of Aggregate
Payment for the supply of aggregate will be made to the Contractor through a separate
Supply of Aggregate bid item which is only paid for aggregate obtained from sources
not controlled by the Department. The Supply of Aggregate bid items are:
� Supply of Aggregate – With Option. The Contractor is allowed to use one or more
specified sources controlled by the Department, or may use his own source(s). The
Supply of Aggregate value is expressed in $/tonne and its unit rate value is
determined by the Department and reported to the Consultant on completed
Aggregate Data Summary Request.
� Designated Source. No Supply of Aggregate bid item is required.
� Supply of Aggregate – No Option. The Department does not offer a source and
the Contractor selects the unit rate value to be used.
During construction, an adjustment to the Supply of Aggregate unit rate is made for
material obtained from crown sources not controlled by the Department as outlined in
Specification 5.2 of the “Standard Specifications for Highway Construction”.
At the conclusion of the project, the Contractor may request a letter confirming the
quantity of aggregate incorporated into the work in order to apply for a royalty
exemption from Sustainable Resource Development.
SECTIO 9 – SURFACIG DESIG
�ovember 2011 9-8
The request shall be processed when there is a bid item in the contract. For lump sum
bid items where quantities are not available or tracked by the consultant, the
Contractor must provide additional information to justify their request. A letter may
not be provided if the Department is not satisfied with how quantities were tracked.
9.3.1.4 Pit Reclamation
Progressive reclamation of pits in conjunction with construction or crushing contracts
is a normal practice followed by the Department. It is reasonable and desirable to
follow this practice to minimize double handling of overburden and reduce the
Department’s outstanding liability for reclamation.
The Regional Aggregates Coordinator shall assess the need for pit reclamation on
each project, as well as whether a Department controlled source is offered as an
option. The Special Provisions of the tender shall be revised accordingly.
9.3.1.5 Aggregate Source Controlled by the Department
Where a Department source is made available for a project, the Department will
provide the relevant pit information including Aggregate Source Summary Request,
Aggregate Testing Plan, Approvals, operating plan and Special Provisions, Summary
of Aggregate Sieve Analysis, and the aggregate value (which is to be used for the
“Supply of Aggregate” bid item). The Consultant shall use this information to form
the Special Provisions to ensure all issues listed on the Aggregate Source Summary
Request have been addressed. If the plans or approvals require updating or are not
available, the Consultant is responsible for obtaining them and providing them to the
Department. This includes surveying the source in an approved manner, and
redrafting the plans using the Department standards. The plans and approvals include,
but are not limited to:
� Legislated Environmental Approvals
� Water Resource Permits
� Aggregates Testing Plans and Pit Plans
� Detailed Operating plans
The Consultant shall specify in the Tender Special Provisions any special operating
conditions that are not included in the “Standard Specifications for Highway
Construction”. The Code of Practice for pit or Reservation conditions is not included
in the tender.
SECTIO 9 – SURFACIG DESIG
�ovember 2011 9-9
9.3.1.6 Tender Package Requirements for Aggregates
Based on the information provided in the Aggregate Data Summary Request form, the
Consultant shall check the appropriate box, AMC_S9.4, AMC_S9.5 or AMC_S9.6,
on the Specification Amendment table. When provided, the aggregate value shall be
inserted in the Unit Price Schedule.
The consultant shall include legible testing plans and operating plans for any optional
source made available for the contract.
If available, the Aggregate Coordinator will provide digital Testing Plans and
operating plans in MicroStation or PDF formats. The Consultant shall convert the
images into an electronic format for inclusion into the tender document. Scanned
plans are not acceptable.
Along with the full testing plan, the portion of the testing plan to be operated shall be
enlarged and included in the tender document. Examples of testing plans are shown in
Appendix G. More than one (1) enlarged plan may be required to show the area
clearly. Alternately, full size plans in PDF shall be included with the other
engineering plans as described in Section 11.1.2 – Design and Tender Package
Submission Requirements.
The Consultant shall verify the quality of the plans by printing out the image from the
word perfect file prior to submission of the tender document.
SECTIO 9 – SURFACIG DESIG
�ovember 2011 9-10
Current References for Section 9:
Below are references identified in this Section. Please see the Department website for a complete list of available
documents.
Alberta Infrastructure Guidelines for Assessment, Rating and Prioritization of Pavements for Seal Coat, 1997, Alberta
Transportation
Engineering Consultant Guidelines for Highway and Bridge Projects – Volume 2 – Construction Contract Administration,
Current, Alberta Transportation
Guidelines for Assessing Pavement Preservations Treatments and Strategies, Edition 2, July 2006, Alberta Transportation
Pavement Design Manual, 1997, Alberta Transportation and Utilities
Standard Specifications for Highway Construction, Current, Alberta Transportation
SECTIO 10 –BRIDGE PLAIG, DESIG AD ISPECTIO
�ovember 2011 10-1
SECTIO� 10 - BRIDGE PLA��I�G, DESIG� A�D
I�SPECTIO�
10.1 DESIG� STA�DARDS
All design work shall be done in accordance with relevant codes, current Department
standards, specifications, and recognized engineering practices.
10.2 E�GI�EERI�G DRAWI�GS
The current version of the Department’s standard title block shall be used for all
drawings. The Department will assign drawing numbers (DD, P, N, S, etc.) for all
engineering drawings required to complete projects. These numbers and the standard
title block template are issued by the Bridge Standards Technologist, Technical
Standards Branch.
Whenever possible, the Department’s standard drawings shall be referenced for the
construction of bridges and culverts. The drawings are now available at the
Department’s website (see Section 10.9).
See Appendix J1 for schedule of milestone dates of submission of drawings and
reports.
10.3 I�DEPE�DE�T DESIG� CHECK
A complete check of the bridge planning, structural design, and drawings shall be
carried out by a Checker. The Checker shall provide design check notes and shall also
stamp, sign, and seal the drawings. This independent design check shall be carried out
by another Consultant when the design Consultant does not have adequate in-house
capabilities to provide this check or if so directed by the Department.
Typically, an Independent Design Check involves the following activities:
� Complete review of bridge planning and assessments
� Complete re-analysis of all aspects of the original structural design, preferably
(but not essentially) by a methodology or computer program other than that used
in the original design
� Ensuring that the engineering drawings accurately convey the design philosophies
of the original design and the checkers design
� Ensuring the completeness, integrity, and accuracy of all aspects of the
Engineering Drawings
SECTIO 10 –BRIDGE PLAIG, DESIG AD ISPECTIO
�ovember 2011 10-2
To resolve issues of concern, an independent check of a specific component of the
structure may be requested by the Department at any time.
10.4 BRIDGE SURVEYS
Refer to Section 6.1.4.5.
10.4.1 BE�CH MARKS
The Department will assign reference numbers for the bench mark tablets when
applicable (major bridge only). These numbers are issued by the Survey/Imagery
Coordinator, Divisional Services Branch. When available, the final geodetic elevation
for the bench marks shall be incorporated into the Record drawings and reported back
to the Coordinator.
10.5 RIGHT-OF-WAY REQUESTS FOR STA�D ALO�E BRIDGE
PROJECTS
Refer to Section 3.
10.6 STAKEHOLDER I�PUT
The Consultant shall discuss the proposed alternatives with municipalities and
regulatory agencies as required to facilitate stakeholder input and feedback. The
Consultant shall formulate a public participation strategy where required. Any
strategy not detailed in the project Terms of Reference requires prior approval of the
Department.
10.7 APPROVALS, LICE�SES, A�D PERMITS
The Consultant shall follow the process laid out in Section 4.3.
10.8 SUBMISSIO�S OF DRAWI�GS A�D REPORTS
Stages of the project that have been identified (in Appendix J1 or the Terms of
Reference) as requiring a review by the Department shall be submitted in a timely
manner. The submission shall take into account the ‘milestone dates’ that have been
specified in the Consulting Services Contract (or Appendix J1 in the absence of
SECTIO 10 –BRIDGE PLAIG, DESIG AD ISPECTIO
�ovember 2011 10-3
detailed dates in the Agreement), and allow sufficient time to enable a level of review
appropriate to the work involved to be undertaken.
All bridge drawings and reports submitted to the Department must contain a reference
to the unique bridge file number (BF#) that has been assigned to the project.
Two (2) hard copies of all reports are to be submitted, accompanied by an electronic
format version in either MS Word or PDF format. Electronic files are to be identified
with bridge file number and date of document.
10.9 BRIDGE E�GI�EERI�G WEBSITE
Additional Information on bridge planning, design, construction, and standard
engineering drawings etc. can be found at the ‘Bridges’ section of the Alberta
Transportation website.
http://www.transportation.alberta.ca/565.htm
10.10 BRIDGE PLA��I�G A�D ASSESSME�TS
Unless otherwise noted, the provisions of CAN/CSA-S6-06 shall NOT apply to this
phase of the work. All bridge planning and assessments shall be done in accordance
with current Department guidelines, standards, best practices, specifications, and
recognized engineering practices.
Unless advised otherwise by the Department, all major bridge or culvert structures
and/or associated river engineering works shall require preparation of Design Data
(DD) Drawings in accordance with Appendix J1. DD drawings confirm feasibility of
the proposed bridge plan, communicate site geometric requirements to the detailed
design phase, and document planning data and decisions that may not be part of the
tender package for future reference. For sites where DD drawings are not required,
sketches detailing bridge planning elements superimposed on the site survey shall be
provided within the Bridge Planning Summary Report. At a minimum, these sketches
shall include a Site Plan, Elevation View, and Roadway Profile with similar features
to those described in Appendix J1 for DD drawings.
10.10.1 ASSESSME�TS
Bridge assessments should follow bridge best practice guideline No. 5, which is
available from the Bridge web page.
SECTIO 10 –BRIDGE PLAIG, DESIG AD ISPECTIO
�ovember 2011 10-4
10.10.2 I�PUT TO FU�CTIO�AL PLA��I�G STUDIES
� Identify all relevant site constraints based on available data and site inspection for
each existing or proposed structure.
� Review functionality and current strategies of existing bridges for consistency
with any proposed highway improvements.
� Participate in the identification, optimization, and assessment of highway
alignment options that involve bridges, considering structure geometric
requirements and feasibility, crossing location impacts, river engineering/
hydrotechnical issues, future flexibility, and stageability.
� For grade separation bridges, provide sketches of cross-sections including staging
for the bridge opening and the bridge deck showing laning and required
clearances. Pier location/span limitations within planning level tolerance shall
also be provided on a plan.
� For stream crossing bridges, provide sketches of site plan, elevation view, and
roadway grade-line. Estimated bridge fills location and river protection works
extents (if any) should be shown.
� Provide cost estimates and approximate configuration for any proposed bridges or
modifications to existing bridges.
� Describe proposed life cycle strategy for each structure, including impacts of
future highway modifications.
10.10.3 BRIDGE PLA��I�G
The Consultant shall:
� Collect all relevant data including file history, site survey, site inspection
observations, geotechnical investigation, right-of-way and land ownership
information, required environmental assessments, and corrosion survey (culvert).
� Establish hydrotechnical design parameters based on the “Hydrotechnical Design
Guidelines for Stream Crossings in Alberta”. Review any published
hydrotechnical design parameters for consistency with site observations survey
and any additional knowledge gained.
� Identify appropriate location, alignment, grade-line, bridge fills, and structure type
alternatives (consideration shall be given to right-of-way requirements, utilities,
geotechnical and hydrotechnical information, traffic accommodation detour, and
staging requirements).
� Prepare Draft Bridge Planning Summary Report including a summary of all
constraints and parameters, description of all conceptual alternatives identified
including cost estimates, sketches, and description of pros and cons.
SECTIO 10 –BRIDGE PLAIG, DESIG AD ISPECTIO
�ovember 2011 10-5
� Complete hydrotechnical, river engineering, and geometric design for selected
option.
� Prepare draft DD drawings or detailed sketches superimposed on the survey as
detailed in Appendix J1.
� Finalize the Bridge Planning Summary Report and DD Drawings (if necessary)
with modifications as discussed with the Department. The final report will include
a description of the selected option and justification for its selection.
10.10.4 SUMMARY OF REPORTI�G A�D SUBMISSIO� REQUIREME�TS
The final Bridge Planning Summary Report and Design Data (DD) drawings
(stamped and signed) are to be received by the Department the date identified in the
Consulting Services Contract.
Any materials procured in the bridge planning phase that may be of value to the
Department in future analysis, such as air photos and DEM files, shall be submitted at
the completion of the bridge planning phase.
All reports and sketches are to be submitted in hard copy and electronic format (MS
Word or PDF). Electronic files are to be identified with bridge file number and date of
document.
10.11 BRIDGE STRUCTURAL E�GI�EERI�G
The Consultant shall complete the bridge designs for the project as detailed in the
following sections:
10.11.1 STRUCTURAL ALTER�ATIVES A�ALYSIS
The Consultant shall prepare a Structure Alternatives and Choose Design Report for
structure options considered suitable for the site (including rehabilitation when
appropriate), illustrative drawings, and “B” Estimate and life cycle cost, etc., for each
alternative. See Section 1.1.1 for definitions of various types of cost estimates and to
Appendix I for examples.
The report should include considerations for suitable types of foundation, abutment,
pier, girders, deck, and bridge rails; structure articulation system to handle
temperature, shrinkage and creep deformations; and scheduling and constructability
issues.
SECTIO 10 –BRIDGE PLAIG, DESIG AD ISPECTIO
�ovember 2011 10-6
10.11.2 DETAILED STRUCTURAL DESIG�
The Consultant shall prepare a Project Design Brief (See Appendix J1) for the chosen
structure (major bridges and overhead sign structures only) at the beginning of
detailed design, to confirm the department’s agreement on the basic bridge features.
The consultant shall have expanded sufficient engineering effort on the chosen design
alternative to affirm appropriateness of the information submitted in the Project
Design Brief. The submission shall also record any major outstanding issues to be
resolved later, if necessary.
The Consultant shall complete the detailed design and construction drawings for the
selected structure, including special provisions, “C” Estimate, bid items, contract
quantities, reinforcing steel bar lists, material lists, etc.
10.11.3 SUMMARY OF REPORTI�G A�D SUBMISSIO� REQUIREME�TS
At the conclusion of the project, the Consultant shall submit (or already have
submitted) the following documentation:
� Structures Alternatives and Choose Design Report, including “B” Estimates for
alternatives considered
� Choose Design form
� Any outstanding work as per Section 4.3 concerning environmental and regulatory
permits must be completed at this stage
� Corrosion survey report (culverts only), and life expectancy calculations
� Project Design Brief (major bridges and overhead sign structures only)
� Tender Drawings (stamped and signed Mylars and MicroStation files) to Bridge
Standards Technologist, Technical Standards Branch
� Special Provisions and “C” Estimate for final detailed design, in addition to the
requirements for plans and drawings prior to tendering as specified in Section
11.1.2.4
� After the contract is awarded, a “D” Estimate will be prepared and submitted to
the Project Sponsor
� Design Completion form
� Three (3) sets of the approved shop or fabrication drawings, erection drawings,
stressing, calculations, etc. (two (2) sets to Fabrication Standards Specialist,
Technical Standards Branch, one (1) set to Project Sponsor)
� Design notes including title page and table of contents, summary of design
assumptions, summary of superstructure shear and moment tables or plots,
support reactions, and all supporting structural and geometric calculations
� Independent design check notes including all calculations performed by the
checker to verify accuracy and soundness of the design
� Record Drawings (stamped and signed Mylars and MicroStation files), after all
design changes during construction have been incorporated, to Bridge Standards
Technologist, Technical Standards Branch. This data is required at the conclusion
SECTIO 10 –BRIDGE PLAIG, DESIG AD ISPECTIO
�ovember 2011 10-7
of the contract (see Engineering Consultant Guidelines for Highway and Bridge
Projects – Volume 2 – Construction Contract Administration and applicable
Design Bulletins).
For further details of “Reporting and Submission Requirements” see Appendix J1.
All reports and sketches to be submitted in hard copy and electronic format (MS
Word or PDF). Electronic file to be identified with bridge file number and date of
document.
10.12 MATERIAL FABRICATIO� A�D BRIDGE CO�STRUCTIO�
I�SPECTIO�
The Consultant shall perform quality assurance checks, inspections, and acceptance of
plant fabricated materials in accordance with Department standards and guidelines.
See Appendix J2 for qualifications of materials inspectors.
The Consultant shall inspect the Contractor’s work and ensure that all construction
work fully complies with the contract. See Appendix J3 for qualifications of bridge
construction inspectors.
For Requirements of Inspection, refer to “Engineering Consultant Guidelines for
Highway and Bridge Projects – Volume 2 – Construction Contract Administration”.
10.12.1 SHOP DRAWI�GS
Refer to “Engineering Consultant Guidelines for Highway and Bridge Projects –
Volume 2 – Construction Contract Administration”.
10.12.2 RECORD DRAWI�GS
As part of the Final Details Submission, the Consultant shall submit Record Drawings
(C-Drawings) to the Department electronically and on 3 mil Mylar film sheets as per
“Engineering Consultant Guidelines for Highway and Bridge Projects – Volume 2 –
Construction Contract Administration”. The Record Drawings shall provide an
accurate representation of the completed construction project, and shall be
authenticated by the Field Review Engineer indicating that the construction
substantially complies with the Design Drawings and all appropriate Contract Plans
and Specifications.
SECTIO 10 –BRIDGE PLAIG, DESIG AD ISPECTIO
�ovember 2011 10-8
Current References for Section 10:
Below are references identified in this Section. Please see the Department website for a complete list of available
documents.
Engineering Consultant Guidelines for Highway and Bridge Projects – Volume 2 – Construction Contract Administration,
2001, Alberta Transportation
Hydrotechnical Design Guidelines for Stream Crossings in Alberta, current, Alberta Transportation
SECTIO 11 –COTRACT TEDERIG
�ovember 2011 11-1
SECTIO� 11 - CO�TRACT TE�DERI�G
11.1 DESIG� A�D TE�DER PACKAGE
11.1.1 GE�ERAL
The contract tender submission is the end product of the design phase. The accuracy
and relevance of the information provided is critical to the bidding process, and
provides the framework for the construction supervision and contract administration
phase.
The Consultant shall undertake an independent check of all submissions in
accordance with Section 1.5.8 of these guidelines. A design and tender package shall
be submitted by the Consultant to the Project Sponsor. This formal submission shall
be accompanied by a signed covering letter from the Consultant; and shall include a
tender document, all associated plans, drawings, data sheets, design quantities, cost
summaries, and associated information documents as detailed below.
Once the Regional submission has been reviewed, revised as required, and approved
by the Project Sponsor; the package shall be submitted to Professional Services
Section. This submission shall be complete, and shall include all documents in
electronic format on CD unless otherwise noted below. Partial and/or e-mail
submissions are not acceptable.
11.1.2 DESIG� A�D TE�DER PACKAGE SUBMISSIO� REQUIREME�TS
Generally, there are five main components to the design and tender package
submission: the covering letter, design submission (including Project Sponsor sign-
off), tender document, associated separate contract plans and drawings, and
Environmental Risk Assessment (ERA).
Depending on the type of work involved, additional documentation may be required.
These may include, but are not limited to: reference drawings, design cross-sections,
geotechnical and/or environmental reports, etc. These documents will be made
available to prospective bidders for information purposes only.
11.1.2.1 Covering Letter
The covering letter may be submitted in electronic or printed form. The letter shall
contain the following information:
SECTIO 11 –COTRACT TEDERIG
�ovember 2011 11-2
� The name, address, telephone number, and signature of the Consultant
� The name, title, telephone number, and email address of the designer/contact
person responsible for the preparation of the design and tender submission
� The consulting services contract number, tender number, highway/control section
number, and the Work Activity number(s)
� A list of all enclosures
� The status of all right-of-way/borrow pit negotiations, if applicable
� The status of all utility crossing agreements, if applicable
� The status of all environmental permits, Fisheries and Navigable Waters
Authorizations, if applicable
� The memo shall identify the individual/company that performed the independent
check
� If the “C” Estimate varies from the most recent estimate shown in the
Department’s construction program by more than 20% (either greater or less
than), the Consultant shall provide a rationale for the variance
� A list of all Design Exceptions with the Technical Standards Branch approvals
� Indication that the tender package has been reviewed and accepted by the Project
Sponsor, and that all revisions requested by the Project Sponsor have been
incorporated or otherwise addressed.
11.1.2.2 Design Submission
The design shall include:
� Two (2) separate cost estimates: one shall be an Average Unit Price Estimate
based on the Department’s most recent average unit price report, and the second
(the “C” Estimate), which is the estimated cost of the project at the time of
tendering, shall be the Consultant’s best estimate of the project’s actual cost if it
were to be tendered on the date the “C” Estimate was prepared. The “C” Estimate
shall not include any estimate of inflation to account for any potential or expected
delay in the actual tendering of the project. For bridge construction and/or
rehabilitation work using lump sum bid items, or other projects incorporating
specialized types of work where the average unit price information is unavailable,
only the “C” Estimate will be required.
The Consultant shall take into consideration project specific local conditions
when preparing the “C” Estimate. These include, but are not limited to: project
location, contractor availability, aggregate availability and/or haul distances,
current asphalt binder prices, quality and/or availability of common and/or borrow
excavation material, delivery time for materials relative to contract completion
date(s), timelines available for construction completion, etc.
The Consultant shall include a memo explaining the rationale used to determine
the estimated prices. This information shall concentrate on the major bid items
only, and shall include sufficient information to allow the Project Sponsor and
SECTIO 11 –COTRACT TEDERIG
�ovember 2011 11-3
Program Management Branch staff to assess the validity of assumptions being
made. The memo shall include a sign-off area for the Project Sponsor to indicate
that he has assessed the validity of the rationale used, and has accepted the design
as complete.
� “C” Estimates shall include separate cost breakdowns summaries for the project
based on major work categories (i.e. grading, surfacing, bridge, etc.), as well as an
overall combined summary
� For tenders with multiple projects, the “C” Estimate shall also include overall
quantity and cost breakdown summaries for each individual project
� Each cost estimate shall include Contract Items, 10 Percent Contingencies,
Engineering Costs, Right-of-Way Costs, Utility Costs, and any other relevant
Project Costs
� All cost estimates shall be provided in electronic form (MS Excel) and in printed
format
� The Unit Price Schedule database created by the Consultant Bid Item System
(CBIS) program shall be provided in electronic format
� The Consultant shall provide updated “C” Estimates, including breakdowns by
project, whenever revisions are made to tender quantities via addendum
The Consultant is advised that in cases where tendering takes place more than 2
months subsequent to the design submission, the Department may request that the
Consultant provide updated Average Unit Price and “C” Estimates to be based on the
most recent information available. Resubmission of the memo explaining the
rationale used to determine the estimated prices will not be required except in cases
where the rationale has changed from that used in developing the original “C”
Estimate.
If, during tender review, Professional Services Section identifies changes to the
project schedule that are substantially different from that used by the Consultant in
preparation of the “C” Estimate, the Project Sponsor and Consultant will be advised.
The Consultant shall review the potential impact of the changes and shall make any
necessary revisions to the “C” Estimate.
11.1.2.3 Tender Documents
� The tender document shall be prepared in WordPerfect Version 8 or newer (must
be WordPerfect 8 compatible) format. Electronic conversion from other programs
into WordPerfect Version 8 is not acceptable
� All tender documents shall be created using the most recent version of the tender
document shell located on the Department’s website
� Whenever practicable, the tender document shall utilize either standard
specifications or the special provisions posted on the Department’s website
� Any non-typical special provisions, specification amendments, or supplemental
specifications shall be created in a format consistent with the Department’s
SECTIO 11 –COTRACT TEDERIG
�ovember 2011 11-4
standard specifications, and shall be in accordance with current Department
policies
� Any permits or authorizations, contract drawings, pit plans or other images which
are scanned for incorporation in the tender document shall be scanned using the
following settings:
� Save image in PCX, JPG, or TIF format
� Resolution: 300 dpi
� Image type: line art or black and white drawing, as applicable. Do not use
photo, colour, or grey scale settings
� All scanned images shall be easily legible when printed in the proper size
format
� Plans and drawings which are converted directly from MicroStation format
shall be in black and white format only. Do not use colour or grey scale
settings
� As a minimum, all tender documents shall include a Location Plan
11.1.2.4 Separate Plans and Drawings; Reference Drawings (if applicable)
Some tenders may require oversize drawings that are intended to form part of the
tender documents. Oversize plans are described as plans larger than 22”x34”. These
plans may be required due to the size or detail of a project and are occasionally
needed for interchanges, complex intersections, major utilities, etc. Whenever
possible the Consultant shall attempt to use standard size plans in lieu of oversized
plans.
Generally, separate plans are required on grading projects, bridge projects, and some
surfacing projects. These plans are typically considered essential to bidders for the
preparation of their bids and include project specific drawings and some reference
drawings. Drawings are typically made available in 11”x17” and 22”x34” formats.
One (1) set of 11”x17” plans is included with each tender document issued by the
Department. Full size (22”x34”) plans for roadway construction are made available
by the Department for viewing purposes and for separate purchase by interested
bidders. Full size (22”x34”) bridge plans are not made available during the tendering
period.
In addition, some tenders may reference drawings that are provided for information
purposes only and are not considered essential for the preparation of bids. These
reference drawings may include, but are not limited to, utility plans and as-
built/Record drawings. These drawings are made available to bidders for viewing
and/or separate purchase during the tendering period. Reference drawings may be
oversized depending on the size of the original drawing.
Submission requirements for plans and drawings include:
SECTIO 11 –COTRACT TEDERIG
�ovember 2011 11-5
� The Consultant shall submit one (1) set of Design Drawings (P-Drawings) on 3
mil Mylar sheets at the time of tender submission to the Project Sponsor. Each
drawing shall be signed and stamped by both the Designer and the Checker. Each
drawing shall be clearly marked with the appropriate date and/or revision number.
� The Consultant shall provide a CD containing the electronic copies of signed
Mylars in MicroStation format (as per the latest version of the “Engineering
Drafting Guidelines for Highway and Bridge Projects”).
� Except for stand-alone bridge projects, the Consultant shall submit two (2)
electronic versions of the drawings in PDF format. One version shall include
photo mosaics, and the other version shall have photo mosaics turned off. File
sizes shall be limited to a maximum of 2 MB per page. For stand-alone bridge
projects, an electronic version of the drawings, including associated reference and
standard bridge drawings, shall be submitted in PDF format.
� If the tender includes reference drawings, the Consultant shall supply the
reference drawings in PDF format.
� For bridge projects, full size drawings are not required unless the plan detail is
insufficient for bidders to prepare their bids.
� To facilitate printing, all drawings shall be converted to PDF format using black
and white settings. Do not use colour or grey scale settings. Notwithstanding the
preceding requirement, Consultant logos may be left in colour if desired.
11.1.2.5 Design Cross-Sections (if applicable)
For all Department grading or grade widening projects with more than 100,000 m3 of
excavation, the tender package shall include an electronic set of all available design
cross-sections for the project, submitted in PDF format.
Electronic design cross-section files shall meet the following requirements:
� Design cross-sections shall be provided for each 20 m distance
� Each cross-section shall show the station, horizontal and vertical scale, and both
horizontal and vertical gridlines
� Whenever practicable, the Consultant shall maintain constant horizontal and
vertical scales for all cross-sections. Changes to horizontal and vertical scale
should be avoided or minimized. In the event that project requirements dictate
scale changes, revised scales should be maintained for a length of at least 200 m.
� The recommended horizontal and vertical scales are as follows:
� Horizontal: 1:250 or 1:500 (Depending on width of cross-section)
� Vertical: 1:50, 1:75, 0r 1:100 (Dependent on terrain – i.e. flat or rolling)
� Each cross-section shall show all design surfaces (i.e. original ground, design,
undercut, finished surface, etc.)
� To facilitate printing, cross-sections shall be created or converted to black and
white. Different line types may be used to indicate different surfaces, however, the
Consultant shall ensure that the line types used can be reproduced using a standard
photocopier.
SECTIO 11 –COTRACT TEDERIG
�ovember 2011 11-6
� Each page shall be formatted to fit 8.5”x11” paper size (landscape orientation)
� Design cross-sections shall be printed one (1) cross-section per page
� Each page shall have ½” margins at the left hand, right hand and bottom of the
page, and shall have a top margin of 1” to facilitate binding
For projects with 750 or fewer individual cross-section pages, the information shall be
submitted in a single electronic file. For projects with more than 750 cross-section
pages, the information shall be split into two or more electronic files.
11.1.2.6 Additional Information Documents (if applicable)
Additional information documents include, but are not limited to geotechnical reports,
environmental reports and assessments, and/or other information that may be
considered relevant to the work.
Generally, the Consultant shall submit electronic copies of these documents in PDF
format. The Department will print hard copies of these documents, and provide them
to its tender distribution points where they will be made available for viewing by
potential bidders.
In instances where the information documents contain mixed page sizes due to fold
out content (i.e. plans, tables, spreadsheets, etc.), photographs and/or colour content,
the Consultant shall provide five (5) copies of each document in hard copy format in
addition to electronic format version.
11.1.3 TE�DER DOCUME�T PACKAGE
The format of the tender document is provided in the Tender Document Template
located on the Department’s internet web page. The format of the tender document is
as follows:
� Title page
� Table of contents (generated by WordPerfect)
� Instructions to Bidders
� Tender forms
� Unit Price Schedule (created by merging the CBIS database)
� Tender Amendment form
� Special Provisions
� Specification Amendments, where applicable
� Supplemental Specifications, where applicable
� Plans and Permits:
� Table listing separate and/or reference plans, where applicable
� Standard plans and drawings, where applicable
� Pit plan(s), where applicable
SECTIO 11 –COTRACT TEDERIG
�ovember 2011 11-7
� Aggregates testing plan(s) and data sheets, where applicable
� Environmental permits, licenses, approvals, and authorizations, where
applicable
� Engineering Plans and drawings
� Contract Plan(s) (location plan minimum) and typical sections where
applicable
� Addenda
11.1.4 STA�DARD SPECIFICATIO�S, SPECIAL PROVISIO�S,
SPECIFICATIO� AME�DME�TS A�D SUPPLEME�TAL
SPECIFICATIO�S
The Department’s website contains the most up-to-date versions of the tender
document templates, bid items, typical Special Provisions, Specification
Amendments, and Supplemental Specifications.
The Department maintains several specification manuals including the “General
Specifications, Specification Amendments and Supplemental Specifications for
Highway and Bridge Construction”, the “Standard Specification for Highway
Construction”, and the “Specifications for Bridge Construction” manuals. Whenever
possible, Consultants shall utilize the Standard Specifications rather than creating new
Special Provisions.
In the event that a special provision is required, the Consultant shall first review the
typical Special Provisions posted on the Department’s website. If it is necessary for
the Consultant to develop a new Special Provision, the Consultant shall ensure the
Special Provision is created in a format that is consistent with the Standard
Specifications and the existing Special Provisions posted on the website. It is
important that any new special provision be reviewed and accepted by the Project
Sponsor to ensure that there are no conflicts with other existing specifications (the
Project Sponsor may refer this to the Technical Standards Branch or Professional
Services Section).
11.1.5 ADDE�DA
Addenda are revisions to the tender documents that are issued to all known
prospective bidders during the tender period. Although any number of sources may
identify the need for an addendum; the Consultant is responsible for providing the
addendum information to Professional Services Section prior to the tender closing
date.
Typically, the Consultant shall notify the Project Sponsor as soon it becomes apparent
that changes to the tender documents are required. Where feasible, the Addendum
shall be submitted to the Project Sponsor and Professional Services Section on the
SECTIO 11 –COTRACT TEDERIG
�ovember 2011 11-8
same working day that the need is identified. If an addendum is submitted to
Professional Services less than two (2) working days prior to the scheduled close of
tenders, the closing date may be extended by the Professional Services Section to
allow all bidders the opportunity to properly evaluate the addendum content.
The addendum submission to Professional Services Section shall be in WordPerfect
Version 8.0 electronic or newer (must be WordPerfect 8 compatible) format. If the
addendum includes revised plans, the plans shall be provided in accordance with
Section 11.1.2.4.
If the addendum will result in a change to the estimated cost of the project, the
Consultant shall provide a revised “C” Estimate with the addendum submission.
11.1.6 MATERIALS
Typically, the supply of materials will be the responsibility of the Contractor as part
of the construction contract. In the rare instance where material supply is not included
in the construction contract, the Consultant shall be responsible for the preparation of
material orders for the Department.
11.1.7 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS
Unless otherwise agreed by the Department, the Consultant shall submit the draft
design and tender package to the Project Sponsor a minimum of 4 weeks prior to the
Tender Package Submission Date, or as otherwise stated in the Terms of Reference.
Following the detailed design review and acceptance of the tender documents by the
Project Sponsor, the Consultant shall submit the final design and tender package to
Professional Services Section on or before the scheduled Tender Package Submission
Date.
Within two (2) weeks after the Contract has been awarded, the Consultant shall
submit six (6) sets of full size drawings (four (4) to the Contractor, two (2) to the
Project Sponsor). These drawings shall be accompanied by a letter to the Contractor
and Project Sponsor indicating the revision number and/or date of the appropriate set
Design Drawings for use at the commencement of construction. Where significant
changes have not been made during the tender period through addenda, the Consultant
may refer to the set previously submitted as part of the Tender Package.
11.1.8 CO�SULTA�T SERVICES DURI�G THE TE�DER PERIOD
Inquires during the tender period are directed to the Consultant. The Consultant shall
not provide information to individual bidders that is contrary or supplemental to that
SECTIO 11 –COTRACT TEDERIG
�ovember 2011 11-9
contained within the tender documents. In instances where supplemental information
needs to be disseminated to all plan holders, Professional Services Section will issue
an addendum.
For many projects, it may be determined that a pre-tender meeting should be held
between the Consultant and interested bidders. In such cases, once the Consultant has
been advised that a tender has been scheduled for advertising he shall schedule a pre-
tender meeting to take place during the tendering period. The Consultant shall provide
this information to Professional Services Section prior to advertising so it may be
included in the tender document.
SECTIO 11 –COTRACT TEDERIG
�ovember 2011 11-10
Current References for Section 11:
Below are references identified in this Section. Please see the Department website for a complete list of available
documents.
Engineering Drafting Guidelines for Highway and Bridge Projects, Current, Alberta Transportation
Specifications for Bridge Construction, 2001, Alberta Transportation
Standard Specifications for Highway Construction, Current, Alberta Transportation
SECTIO 12 –WATER COTROL STRUCTURES AD DESIG
�ovember 2011 12-1
SECTIO� 12 - WATER CO�TROL STRUCTURES
PLA��I�G A�D DESIG�
12.1 GE�ERAL
This section outlines responsibility and authority of the Consultant that is specific to
the planning and design of water management projects. Those projects include:
� Dams, diversion weirs, lake stabilization structures
� Canals
� Erosion control work
� Flood control structures and dykes
� Pump houses
� Water pipelines
� Reservoirs
Any bridges or bridge-sized culverts on public roadways that are combined or
integrated into water management projects shall be designed to the requirements of
Section 10.
Even though the Consultant may need to liaise with other staff members of the
Department for various phases of water management projects, all discussions with
Department staff need to go through the Project Sponsor/Administrator.
12.2 DESIG� STA�DARDS A�D GUIDELI�ES
All work shall be done in accordance with relevant codes, current Department
standards, specifications, and recognized engineering practices.
Design standards and guidelines are available on the Department’s website. See
Section 2.0 of “Water Control Structures – Selected Design Guidelines” for a
thorough listing of codes, standards, and references for water control structures.
12.3 I�DEPE�DE�T DESIG� CHECK
A complete check of water management design, specifications, and drawings shall be
carried out by a Checker. The Checker shall prepare and retain design check notes and
shall also sign and stamp or seal the drawings. This design check shall be carried out
by another consultant if the design Consultant does not have adequate in-house
capabilities to provide this check or if so directed by the Department. See Section
1.5.8 for more details.
SECTIO 12 –WATER COTROL STRUCTURES AD DESIG
�ovember 2011 12-2
12.4 SURVEYS
Where required by the Terms of Reference to establish a project specific datum for
horizontal and vertical control, such a survey shall be tied into the Alberta Survey
Control Monument System as outlined in Section 6.1.4. All benchmarks for
rehabilitation projects must be tied into the same system.
Alberta Environment benchmarks are located on the Alberta Environment website at:
www.environment.alberta.ca/01533.html
12.5 LA�D ACQUISITIO� REQUIREME�TS
Refer to Section 3 for general Departmental land acquisition guidelines and to
“Reservoir Lands Guideline” for land assembly requirements for Water Control
Structures.
12.6 APPROVALS, LICE�SES A�D PERMITS
The Consultant shall, in consultation with the Department and Regulatory agencies,
determine which regulatory approvals, licenses, authorizations, and permits are
required for the project.
Alberta Environment is the owner of all water management projects. Alberta
Transportation, however, will apply for all regulatory approvals, licenses,
authorizations and permits that are required to deliver the project on behalf of the
owner. The Contractor shall be required to apply for any temporary approvals or
permits that are required based on the methodology adopted by the contractor during
construction.
The Consultant shall assemble and prepare the information needed for regulatory
approvals, licenses, authorizations, and permits. This may include but is not limited
to:
� Drawings and specifications
� Assessment reports
� Impact statements
� Proposed mitigation efforts
� Application forms
The Consultant shall incorporate conditions of any approvals, licenses, authorizations,
or permits that affect the construction work into the Special Provisions of the Contract
documents and shall include copies of approvals, licenses, etc. in the Contract
document.
SECTIO 12 –WATER COTROL STRUCTURES AD DESIG
�ovember 2011 12-3
12.7 CO�STRUCTIO� CO�TRACT SPECIFICATIO�S
Unless noted in the Terms of Reference, the Contract Specifications for water control
structures shall be based upon the latest version of the Civil Works Master
Specification (CWMS). The Consultant shall edit the CWMS as necessary to produce
the Contract Specifications.
For some water control structures the “Specifications for Bridge Construction” or the
“Standard Specifications for Highway Construction” may be used.
12.8 E�GI�EERI�G DRAWI�G STA�DARDS
Refer to the “Development of Project Drawings” guide, Section 10.2, Section 10.12.2,
and all applicable Design Bulletins.
12.9 CO�CEPTUAL STUDY
The Conceptual Study is a review of available information to determine the proposed
design criteria and identify any information gaps. The Consultant shall identify
available options to solve problems identified in the Terms of Reference. The
Conceptual Study will not generally require the acquisition of field data.
12.9.1 STUDIES
The Consultant shall:
� Inspect the site and inventory project components
� Review existing surveys, investigations, data, drawings, aerial photographs, and
reports
� Review issues and potential options with stakeholders of the project. See Section
2.5.
� Undertake studies that are necessary to complete the Conceptual Study
� Determine utility locations and project restrictions due to those utilities. See
Section 6.1.8
� For a rehabilitation project, evaluate the current design criteria for the existing
project and propose design criteria for the project. For a new project, propose
design criteria for the project
� Complete an environmental and historical resources overview as necessary
� Determine land ownership and preliminary land assembly requirements for the
project
� Prepare conceptual level drawings for the project
� Prepare an “A” Estimate for the project and a life-cycle cost analysis for the
various options
SECTIO 12 –WATER COTROL STRUCTURES AD DESIG
�ovember 2011 12-4
12.9.2 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS
The Consultant shall prepare a Conceptual Study report that includes the following
components:
� A summary of the investigations, surveys, and reviews
� A review of existing design criteria for rehabilitation projects
� Inventory of project components and utilities
� Relevant existing drawings
� Proposed design criteria
� Proposed alternatives that would meet the Terms of Reference
� Conceptual drawings of each alternative
� “A” Estimate (project cost) and life cycle cost for each option
� Right-of-way requirements
� Potential environmental, social, and historical impacts and mitigative measures
� A ranking of alternatives
� A listing of recommended investigations that would improve the decision making
process, refine the design, reduce the life cycle cost of the project, or reduce the
risk of the proposed alternatives.
12.10 PRELIMI�ARY E�GI�EERI�G
Preliminary Engineering is a detailed review of available alternatives that results in a
recommended alternative that provides the best solution. The Consultant shall
undertake required field studies and laboratory testing, consider all external factors,
and prepare preliminary design and costing to develop all the viable alternatives to a
level that one can be chosen for implementation. If a Conceptual Study is not required
by the Terms of Reference, the study requirements of that design phase must be
included in the Preliminary Design phase.
12.10.1 STUDIES
The consultant shall:
� Inspect the site
� Review surveys, investigations, data, drawings, aerial photographs, and reports.
Recommend any additional investigations that are required to assist in the
evaluation of options
� Undertake any required investigations
� Undertake required environmental and historical reviews or assessments
� Complete final hydrologic, hydraulic, and geometric design and preliminary
geotechnical and structural design of each alternative
� Review options with stakeholders of the project. See Section 2.5
� Determine utility relocation requirements
SECTIO 12 –WATER COTROL STRUCTURES AD DESIG
�ovember 2011 12-5
� Determine final land assembly requirements of each alternative for the project
� Prepare preliminary level drawings for the project. These drawings would include
detailed site plans; plans and various sections of each structure with enough detail
to cost the components; borrow, lay-down and waste disposal areas; and care of
water options for each alternative.
� Specify materials for major project components: rip rap, concrete, impervious fill,
etc.
� Determine material sources for each alternative
� Prepare a “B” Estimate and life cycle cost for each alternative
12.10.2 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS
The consultant shall prepare a Preliminary Engineering report that includes the
following components:
� A summary of the studies and investigations carried out
� Comparison of viable alternatives that would meet the Terms of Reference
� Final Design Criteria
� Preliminary Drawings
� “B” Estimate for each alternative and life cycle cost
� Final Land Assembly requirements for each alternative
� Utility relocations for each alternative
� Environmental impact overview or assessment and probable mitigation
requirements
� Historical resources overview
� The recommended alternative
12.11 FI�AL DESIG�
The Final Design is the phase where the chosen alternative is advanced to detailed
design stage and tender drawings and specifications are produced. The Department
will select the one (1) alternative from the Preliminary Engineering report for
construction and provide direction to the Consultant. Land Assembly often precedes
independent of Final Design by another consultant.
12.11.1 DESIG� ACTIVITIES
The Consultant shall:
� Complete final geotechnical and structural design of the selected alternative
� Prepare and obtain utility relocation or crossing agreements
� Identify right-of-way requirements
� Review the final design with stakeholders of the project. See Section 2.5.
SECTIO 12 –WATER COTROL STRUCTURES AD DESIG
�ovember 2011 12-6
� Prepare Tender Drawings for the project. These drawings would include but may
not be limited to: detailed site plans; contractor site limits including
environmentally and historically sensitive sites; plans and various sections of each
structure with enough detail to cost the components and determine material
requirements; borrow, lay-down and waste disposal areas; and care of water plans
where appropriate.
� Prepare Contract Specifications for the Contract
� Prepare a “C” Estimate for the project
12.11.2 REPORTI�G REQUIREME�TS
During the Final Design phase, unless otherwise noted in the Terms of Reference, the
consultant shall provide electronic copies of the tender drawings in PDF format to the
department at the 50 percent and 95 percent complete stages. Unless otherwise noted
in the Terms of Reference, the consultant shall provide electronic specifications for
review at the 75 percent and 95 percent complete stage.
The consultant shall prepare a Final Design Report that summarizes the:
� Final studies
� Final drawings
� Final right-of-way requirements
� Utility relocation agreements
� “C” Estimate.
12.12 CO�TRACT TE�DERI�G
Refer to Section 11 with the following exceptions:
� The Tender Documents shall be prepared on the CWMS Contract
� Drawings for water management projects shall be prepared in AutoCAD format
12.12.1 SITE MEETI�G
Where required by the Tender Documents, the Consultant will attend and guide a site
meeting with prospective bidders, as well as prepare notes from this site meeting.
12.12.2 TE�DER I�QUIRIES
The Consultant shall respond to tender inquiries by potential bidders. Any questions
that cannot be addressed by referring to the Tender Documents shall be forwarded to
SECTIO 12 –WATER COTROL STRUCTURES AD DESIG
�ovember 2011 12-7
the Project Sponsor. When required, the Consultant shall prepare addendums for
issuance by the Department.
SECTIO 12 –WATER COTROL STRUCTURES AD DESIG
�ovember 2011 12-8
Current References for Section 12:
Below are references identified in this Section. Please see the Department website for a complete list of available
documents.
Civil Works Master Specification for Construction of Provincial Water Management Projects, Current, Alberta
Transportation
Development of Project Drawings, 2004, Alberta Transportation
Reservoir Lands Guideline, 2005, Alberta Environment
Specifications for Bridge Construction, 2001, Alberta Transportation
Standard Specifications for Highway Construction, Current, Alberta Transportation
Water Control Structures – Selected Design Guidelines, 2004, Alberta Transportation and Alberta Environment
IDEX
�ovember 2011 i
A
Acceptance · 1-2
Access Management · 8-1
Accident Investigation · 1-9, 1-11
Acquisition of Aggregates · 3-3
Addenda · 11-7
Aerial Photography · 2-1
Affidavit for Acquiring Lands · 3-9
Aggregate Plans · 9-5
Aggregate Requirements · 9-1, 9-4
Aggregate Testing Plan · 9-8
Agreement · 1-1, 1-3, 1-8, 1-15, 1-16, 3-5, 5-16, 8-11, 8-
12, 10-2
Agreements
Railway Crossing · 1-17, 5-8, 8-1, 8-5
Utility Crossing · viii, 1-17, 3-6, 8-2, 8-10, 8-12
Air Photo Mosaics · 8-2
Alberta Construction Safety Association · 1-10, 1-11
Alberta Land Surveyor · 1-2
Alberta Land Surveyors · 1-12
Alberta One-Call · 6-5
Alignment · 3-8
All Terrain Vehicle (ATV’s) · 1-21
APEGGA · 1-7, 1-12
Approval · 1-2, 1-16, 1-17, 2-3
archives · 1-15
As-Constructed · 10-2, 10-7
At-Grade Railway Crossing · 5-7
AT-GRADE RAILWAY CROSSINGS · 8-4
Atterberg limits · 7-14
B
backslope agreements · 3-3
Basic Structural Design · 9-1
Bench Marks · 10-2
Benefit Cost Analysis · 2-2, 5-7
Best Value · 1-19
Binder Material · 9-1, 9-4
BOREHOLE DATA REPORTING · 7-15
Borrow Agreements · 8-3
Borrow Excavation · 4-4, 8-3
Owner Supply · 4-3
Bridge Design · 10-1
Bridge inventory · 2-1
Bridge Structural Design
Detailed · 10-6
Preliminary · 10-5
Bridge Structures · 1-2
Culverts · viii, 1-8
Major Bridges · 1-3, 10-6
Standard Bridges · 1-3
C
Cables · 6-9
Chainages · 6-3
Changes To Scope Of Work · 1-15
Chevrons · 5-7
Choose Design Record · 10-6
Clear Zone · 5-3, 8-4
Collision Experience · 5-3
Collision information · 2-1
Communication Plan · 2-3
Cone Penetration · 7-8
Construction Specifications · 1-12
Construction Phase · 1-11
Consultant · 1-3
Consultant Performance Evaluation · 1-18
Consultant Responsibility (Aggregate) · 9-6
Consultant’s Representative · 8-2
Contaminated Sites · 2-1, 4-6
Contour Plans · 2-3
Contract · 1-3
Contract claims resolution · 1-17
Contract Location Map · 8-2
Contract Tender Package · 1-8, 1-18, 8-15
Contractor · 1-3
Control Points · 6-3
Control Section · 6-3
Cost Apportionment · 8-11
Cost Estimates · 1-17, 9-5
COST SUMMARY · 8-16
Crossing Agreements · 8-10, 8-11
D
Data Collection · 2-1
DELINEATORS · 8-13
Department · 1-3
Design Data Drawings · 10-3
Design Exception · 1-16, 8-2
Design Package
Grading · 8-1, 8-2, 8-16, 9-1
Surfacing · 9-6
Design Phase · 1-10
Design Philosophy · 1-19
Design Tender Package · 1-4
detours · 1-11
Documentation · 1-4
E
Electronic file formats · 1-17
Elevations · 6-3
ENGINEERING DRAWINGS · 10-1
Environmental Impact Assessment · 8-4
Environmental permits · 1-17
Environmental Protection and Enhancement Act · 4-3
IDEX
�ovember 2011 ii
Estimates · 1-4, 7-15
"A" Estimate · 1-4, 1-17, 5-14
"B" Estimate · 1-5, 1-17, 5-16, 10-5
"C" Estimate · 1-5, 1-17, 10-6
"D" Estimate · 1-6, 1-18
Expropriation Surveys · 3-9
Extra work · 1-17
F
Field Moisture Content · 7-14
Field reviews · 2-3
FINAL DESIGN REVIEW · 8-16
Final Details · 1-6, 1-17
Functional Classification System · 5-3
G
Geographic Coordinate · 6-11
Geometric Assessment · 2-2, 5-2
GEOSYNTHETIC MATERIALS · 7-15
Geotechnical investigation · 1-17
Geotechnical Investigations · 2-2, 7-1
Grading Design · 8-1
Grading Estimate Summary · 1-5, 8-2
Grading Projects · 8-2, 8-13
Gravel Surfacing · 9-4
Guardrail Design · 8-4
GUIDEPOSTS · 8-13
H
Hazard · 1-9
HIGHWAY ILLUMINATION · 8-14
I
INDEPENDENT DESIGN CHECK
ROADS · 8-15
Independent Design Check · 1-18, 10-1
Insitu Vane Shear · 7-8
INSTRUMENTATION INSTALLATION · 7-14
INSTRUMENTATION MONITORING · 7-14
Internal Rate of Return · 5-7
Intersection Analysis · 8-2
INTERSECTION DESIGN · 8-3
K
Key Plan · 9-5
L
LABORATORY TESTING · 7-14, 9-3
Land Surveyor · 3-7, 3-8
Land titles · 3-1
Lane Painting · 8-14
Lane Widths · 8-14
Lead-Time · 3-2
Legal Survey · 3-7
Legislation · 1-1, 1-21
Level of Service · 5-3, 5-6
Liaison · 1-16
Lighting Design · 8-15
Liquidity Index · 7-15
Low Pressure Gas Lines · 6-7
M
Major Bridge · 1-7, 10-2, 10-3
Manuals · 1-14
Masshaul diagrams · 8-2
Microstation · 2-3
Microstation format · 2-3
Mosaic Plans · 1-2, 2-3
Multiple Projects · 9-5
O
Occupational Health and Safety Act · 1-9
Optional Department Source · 9-8
Overpass Structures · 9-4
P
Pavement condition · 2-1
Pavement Markings · 5-3, 5-6, 5-7, 8-13, 8-14, 9-1
Pavement Rehabilitation · 9-1
Pavement Structural Design · 5-14
Payment for Aggregate · 9-7
Permission to Survey · 3-7
Pipelines · 6-6, 8-10, 8-11
Planning Study · 2-1, 2-4, 3-1
Planning Phase · vii, 1-4, 1-5, 1-10, 1-16, 1-17, 2-3
Plasticity Index · 7-15
Posting Boundaries · 3-8
Power Lines · 6-8, 8-10
Pre-Construction Meetings · vii
Preliminary Engineering · 1-10, 5-2, 5-14, 5-15, 5-16, 10-
3, 10-4, 10-6
BRIDGE · 5-17
ROADWAY · 5-2
SURFACING · 5-14
Preliminary engineering report · 1-17
Preliminary Survey · 6-1
Pressuremeter · 7-8
Professional Seal · 1-12
Professional Engineer · 1-7
Professional Registration · 1-12
Project Administrator · 1-7
Project Co-Sponsor · 1-7
Project Design Brief · 1-7, 10-6
IDEX
�ovember 2011 iii
Project Initialization · 1-16
Project Sponsor · 1-7
Property Agreements · 1-16
Public participation · 1-16
R
R.C.M.P. · 8-14
Regional Assignment · 5-14
Regional Assignments · 5-2
Regulations · 1-1
Regulatory Agencies · 2-3, 10-2
Responsibilities · 1-15
Review of Work · 1-18
Right-of-Way · 8-3
Acquisition · 3-3
Basic · 3-1, 4-3
Crown Land
Basic · 3-2
Final · 3-3
Supplementary · 3-3
Expropriation · 3-2, 3-5, 3-6, 3-9
Final · 3-2
Plan Preparation · 3-8
Supplementary · 3-2
RIGHT-OF-WAY
ISOLATED BRIDGE PROJECTS · 8-3
Road Drainage Structures · 1-8
Roadside Facilities · 8-1, 8-3
Rock Investigation · 7-13
Rumble Strips · 5-7, 8-14, 9-5
S
Safety Certificate · 1-9
Safety Requirements · 1-8, 1-10
Seal Coat · 9-4
Seal Coat Prioritization · 5-16
Sediment Control · 7-12, 7-16
SEEDING · 8-12
Shop Drawings · 10-7
Signing · 1-1, 1-11, 1-18, 5-3, 5-7, 8-1, 8-2, 8-12, 8-13, 9-
5
Special Monitoring Locations · 5-3
Special Provisions · 1-12, 4-2, 8-7, 8-12, 9-1, 9-4, 9-8, 10-
6, 11-7
Utility · 8-2, 8-12, 9-4, 9-8
Staging · 2-2
Stakeholder Input · 2-3, 10-2
Sub-Consultant · 1-8
Summary of Estimated Grading Quantities · 8-2
Supplemental Specifications and Specification
Amendments · 9-1, 9-5
SUPPLY OF AGGREGATE · 9-6
Surfacing Design · 9-1
SURFACING PROJECTS · 8-13
Surfacing Strategy · 5-14, 5-15, 5-16, 9-1
Survey Monuments · 3-8
T
Telecommunication Lines · 8-10
Telephone Facilities · 6-8
Tender Amendment form · 11-6
Tender forms · 11-6
Tender Package
Final · 8-16, 9-6
Surfacing · 9-1
Terms of Reference · 1-1, 1-8, 1-15, 1-16, 1-22, 2-1, 3-1,
3-3, 5-14, 8-3, 8-13, 8-14, 10-2
TEST HOLES · 7-13
TEST PITS · 7-13
Traffic Accommodation · 1-10
TRAFFIC CONTROL SIGNALS · 8-15
Traffic data · 2-1
Typical Public Input Process · 2-3
Typical Study Considerations · 2-2
U
Unified Soils Classification System · 7-14
Unit Price Analysis · 8-2
Unit Price Schedule · 11-6
UTILITIES · 8-5
Utility Impact · 2-2
V
Value Engineering Proposal · 1-20
Value Engineering Proposals · 1-17
Vertical Clearances · 9-4
W
Warrants · 1-8, 8-15
Water Resource Permits · 9-8
IDEX
�ovember 2011 iv
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX A
November 2011
APPENDIX A GENERAL ENGINEERING PROCESSES
FOR MANAGEMENT OF ALBERTA’S HIGHWAYS
AND BRIDGES
APPENDIX A
November 2011
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX A
November 2011 A-1
GENERAL OUTLINE OF THE ENGINEERING PROCESS FROM LONG RANGE PLANNING TO CONSTRUCTION COMPLETION FOR PROVINCIAL HIGHWAYS
A. Long Range Planning 1. Alberta Transportation’s Mission is to contribute to Alberta’s economic prosperity and quality
of life through the provision of a safe and efficient transportation network. The Department’s Core Business in this regard is to ensure continuous improvement of the provincial highway infrastructure through efficient planning, design, construction, rehabilitation, operation, and maintenance.
2. To begin, the Department monitors all Provincial Highways for traffic volume, collision
experience, operations, pavement/bridge condition, level-of-service, etc. on a regular basis.
An inventory of existing highways including details of features and appurtenances together with various information regarding condition, age, serviceability, etc. is also maintained and stored in the Transportation Infrastructure Management System (TIMS –an important tool in establishing future highway programs).
3. Using this information, the Department develops and refines its Long Range Plan which
identifies overall transportation needs and priorities for various time horizons (e.g. 5, 10, 15, and 20 year) for the entire highway system.
4. At any given time there is a three-year program in place. The three-year program is a
“rolling program” which is generally approved in the spring session of the legislature each year and is freely available public information. Projects that are included in the three-year program are subjected to planning, engineering assessment, detailed design, etc. as required to deliver the construction work.
Program Management Branch (PMB) coordinates input from the Regions, Transportation Safety Services Division, Technical Standards Branch (TSB), and other stakeholders to identify projects for inclusion in the construction/rehabilitation programs. Projects are approved based on demand, needs, and available budgets. A Flow Diagram is attached to show the various stages followed in the Highway Engineering Process for projects in the 3 to 10 year programs. The “Process of Notification of Provincial Highway Construction Projects to Municipalities” is also attached.
An initial “Scope Review” is undertaken by the Department on all projects or highway segments that are under consideration for the 3 to 10 year program. This initial scope review is generally undertaken by the Infrastructure Manager with input from other staff and using the most current technical information. The information available may include planning studies, engineering assessments, pavement management systems information, video log, etc. At this time, the Department will make an initial determination of whether the project requires planning, engineering assessment, or if it can be advanced directly to the preliminary engineering stage.
APPENDIX A
November 2011 A-2
B. Consultant Selection 5. The Department employs competent consulting engineering firms registered with the
Association of Professional Engineers, Geologists and Geophysicists of Alberta (APEGGA). All consultants must be pre-qualified for engineering work required on provincial highway projects.
Sub-consultants and other firms providing specialized services are not necessarily pre-
qualified by the Department. 6. Professional Services Section (PSS) of PMB administers the consultant procurement
process. PSS compiles preliminary information for several projects into a Ranking List, and sends out a Request for Expression of Interest to all consultants pre-qualified in that category. Based on the relative rankings and submissions received, a short list of typically three Consultants is created for each project.
7. A Project Sponsor is designated by the Department to act as liaison between the Department and Consultant. The Project Sponsor is assigned the management duties for the consultant assignment. The Project Sponsor also ensures that funding is in place for the engineering and construction work, that upset fees are not exceeded, and requests increases in upset fees if required are justified. The Project Sponsor takes responsibility for delivery of the project as per the program or other defined schedules.
8. A Terms of Reference (TOR) for a project is prepared by the Project Sponsor based on the
project requirements and through consultation with technical specialists or others as required. The TOR defines the scope of work, deliverables and schedules expected by the Department.
9. PSS sends out a Request for Proposal (RFP) to the consultants on the approved short list.
PSS receives proposals from interested/short listed consultants and arranges for the selection meeting with the Region and TSB to determine the preferred Consultant.
The proposals are evaluated based on specified criteria and a selection of the preferred
Consultant is made. PMB obtains approvals for the selection and the final terms of agreement are negotiated between the preferred Consultant and the Department. An agreement is prepared by PSS.
10. In specific instances, sole sourcing may be utilized by the Department for obtaining
consultant services if it is in the best interests of the Department based on value and schedule. Sole source assignments may require special knowledge or experience, and the scope of work will be clearly defined. For sole source assignments, the Department expects the Consultant to have good knowledge and capabilities in the area concerned as well as a thorough understanding of the effort required to perform the work.
11. In some situations, the Department hires consulting firms to undertake Regional planning or
engineering assessments as required to assess the need to reconstruct/rehabilitate existing roads and bridges (These assessments follow the 3R/4R guidelines or other established engineering practices for assessment of roads and bridges. An “A” Estimate is submitted as part of the final report on planning work.).
APPENDIX A
November 2011 A-3
For engineering assessments, the type of engineering information provided by these firms consists of geometric assessment, surfacing strategy, safety assessment, railway crossing improvement requirements, lighting assessment, traffic signal assessment, seal coat requirements, etc. The production of construction cost estimates that are more detailed and reliable than the programming estimate is part of an engineering assessment. (For surfacing work a “B” Estimate is produced at the preliminary stage. Because the need for geometric improvements is defined at this stage, the original ballpark “A” Estimate for roadway grading/base/paving may be fine-tuned accordingly.).
12. Generally, the engineering work required for preliminary engineering, detailed design,
tender preparation, construction supervision, and contract administration are bundled together in one assignment. In instances where the project schedule is of particular importance to the Department, the award of construction supervision and contract supervision may be contingent upon satisfactorily meeting the timelines for other phases of the project. The conditions for these projects are clearly outlined in the project TOR.
C. Consultant Roles 13. Following the assignment of a project to a Consultant, the Project Sponsor calls a Project
Initialization Meeting with the Department’s Project Administrator, Consultant, and the Department Safety Officer to review and clarify project scope, roles, schedule, and requirements.
14. The Consultant performs the detailed engineering work using all relevant manuals,
guidelines, and practices that apply to highways in Alberta. The Consultant submits all deliverables as noted in the TOR including right-of-way plans,
right-of-way agreements, utility agreements, environmental permits, licenses, and approvals.
The Consultant submits a “B” Estimate to the Project Sponsor on completion of preliminary
designs. The Consultant prepares grading, surfacing, and bridge design packages which are used as
the basis for preparation of the contract tender. The Consultant delivers a completed and independently checked design, mosaics,
drawings, and electronic copies which include summaries of all estimates including a “C” Estimate for project expenditure.
The Consultant submits the tender package to the Project Sponsor as per the schedule
specified in the RFP/TOR and as may be adjusted by the Department. As required, the Consultant calls for a Design Review Meeting(s), a Pre-Tender Meeting,
and a Pre-Construction Meeting.
APPENDIX A
November 2011 A-4
D. Tendering Process 15. The Project Administrator carries out a complete detailed design and tender package
review; and updates the Programming Estimate in PMA with the Consultant provided “C” Estimate.
Once all revisions requested by the Project Administrator have been incorporated, the Project Sponsor forwards the complete approved tender package and Project Sponsor sign-off letter to Professional Services Section. Professional Services Section schedules advertising of the project; and carries out final stage review, editing, and tendering of the project. Hard copies of the tender documents are distributed to the Department tender sales centres.
16. All projects over $100,000 are advertised and tendered by Program Management Branch. Program Management Branch obtains approval to tender and advertises the tender on the Alberta Purchasing Connection (APC) website, in the Construction Alberta News, and on the Edmonton and Alberta Construction COOLNet electronic tendering system websites.
Hard copies of the contract tender documents are distributed to the Department tender sales centres.
17. Generally, the Regions advertise and tender contracts where the estimated contract cost is
less than $100,000. Where regional tenders are based on either lump sum or unit price quotation, the
Department obtains quotes from at least three sources. The Consultant evaluates the quotes and submits the recommendations to the Department for approval.
E. Construction Administration (Volume 2 of this document) 18. Throughout the project, the Consultant provides project management and submits weekly
reports complete with relevant comments on material testing to the Project Sponsor. The Consultant submits monthly invoices for engineering fees as well as project expenditure
reports for construction activities on a timely basis to the Project Sponsor. In addition, the Consultant certifies and submits contractor invoices to the Department for payment.
The Project Sponsor monitors construction activities and progress of individual construction
projects, liaises with consultants and contractors, and provides monthly progress reports in the Program Management Application (PMA).
As required, site visits are conducted by representatives from the Region, TSB, and PMB to
monitor various aspects of the project such as construction supervision, adherence to specs/standards, compliance to terms of agreements, and public/worker safety.
19. The Consultant initiates contract changes (i.e. changes in scope of work, estimated cost)
within certain defined limits.
APPENDIX A
November 2011 A-5
20. The Consultant performs segregation inspection and rating of finished pavement surfaces within the time limits required in the contract specifications. A segregation rating sheet is filled out to calculate bonuses and penalties.
21. The Consultant calls for a Final Inspection tour when the Contractor advises the Consultant
that the project is complete. 22. Upon completion of the project, the Consultant indicates to the Project Sponsor that the
work is complete. A conditional Construction Completion Certificate is issued advising the Contractor of all outstanding work (i.e. seasonal deficiencies), the date by which this work is to be completed and the amounts to be retained in holdbacks for the work (at least twice the estimated cost of the remaining work).
Unless otherwise notified, the Consultant Project Manager holds back 10% of progress
payments. In general, the holdback is retained until:
1. Contract has been accepted as complete. 2. Contractor’s Statutory Declaration has been received. 3. W.C.B. clearance has been received.
23. When the construction contract has been completed, the Consultant submits the complete
“Final Details” and Project Records file to the Projects Sponsor. Selected road and bridge information (i.e. As-Constructed Details, Record Drawings, design calculations and checker notes for bridges, etc.) is forwarded by the Project Sponsor to the appropriate Section(s) for processing and subsequent record retention. Consultants must follow TSB standards for file identification.
The department does not pay for any post-construction engineering work until the
complete “Final Details” and Project Records file has been received. Rationale for collection of Record information is as follows:
i) Information on bridge structures is needed for load ratings. ii) Pavement width and thickness information is needed for pavement management
purposes. iii) Information on geometry/traffic control is needed for future assessment of
improvement needs, investigation of need for additional traffic control devices and lighting, for on-going monitoring of safety performance, and to record drainage information.
iv) To generate year-end summary reports on construction quality. All of the above information will be stored as part of TIMS and will be available for future
programming, design, and management purposes. The Consultant retains a complete duplicate copy of the “Project Records Package” which
is described in Appendix K of this document. The “Project Records Package” includes the Final Details as well as design information, correspondence, and other pertinent records.
APPENDIX A
November 2011 A-6
24. Upon request from the Contractor, the Consultant releases electronic files for earthwork quantities to the Contractor once the files have been edited and verified.
25. The Project Sponsor completes an evaluation of the Consultant. The evaluation form is
signed by the Consultant and Project Sponsor. F. Warranty Inspection 26. As required, a Warranty Inspection is done 30 to 60 days before the expiration of the
warranty period. The warranty period is generally 12 months for roads and 24 months for major bridges. Some aspects of the workmanship or materials require longer warranties (e.g. bridge joints and bridge bearings – typically a 5 year warranty period is specified.) The warranty inspection is undertaken by a Regional Warranty Inspection Consultant if required.
If deficiencies are found, the Consultant informs the Contractor in writing prior to the expiry
of the warranty period advising him of the defects and specifying a completion date for the repairs. A copy of the letter is sent to the Project Sponsor, PMB, and the bonding company.
APPENDIX A
November 2011 A-7
APPENDIX A
November 2011 A-8
PROCESS OF NOTIFICATION OF PROVINCIAL HIGHWAY CONSTRUCTION PROJECTS TO MUNICIPALTIES
Recommended Steps to Follow Responsible Party
1. As part of the TOR development, contact the municipality
to advise them of the upcoming work and that the Consultants may be requesting information from the municipality as part of RFP development.
Project Sponsor
2. Include in the RFP a statement to the effect that the successful consultant will contact the municipality after they are awarded the project engineering work and gather input from them.
Project Sponsor
3. Invite municipality representative to the project initialization meeting and conceptual design meeting (as required)
Project Sponsor
4. Include municipality representative in the value engineering sessions. Invitation is at the discretion of the Department.
Project Sponsor/Consultant
5. Provide notice of the project tender to the municipality. PSS will forward a copy of the “Approval for Advertising” sheet to the project sponsor to forward to the municipality
Project Sponsor
6. Advise the municipality which contractor is awarded the
construction contract and anticipated start date.
Consultant
7. Invite municipality to the Pre-Construction meeting (if warranted). Copy the municipality on the notes of meeting.
Consultant
8. Involve municipality representative in the interim inspection if there is an anticipated significant impact to their network or local issues identified
Consultant
9. Elevate recommended changes to this process to the Divisional Executive Managers
CPMG Executive Sponsor
APPENDIX B
November 2011
APPENDIX B
TYPICAL AGENDA FOR CONSULTANT INITIALIZATION MEETING
APPENDIX B
November 2011
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX B
November 2011 B-1
Consultant Initialization Meeting - Provincial Highway Project’s Agenda 1) Safety (separate meeting for Pre-Engineering activities) 2) Details of Aggregate Source - Status of Pit Update - Pit Operations Plan and Conditions - Pit Reclamation if necessary - Contract and Design Packages - Status of reporting to Department 3) Description and Scope of Work 4) Review of Consultant Proposal/Terms of Agreement - Items to clarify 5) Review Administrative Items - Consultant Personnel - Project Communications - Project Schedule (Milestone dates) - Project Reporting
i) Review Department Reporting, Structure, i.e., Weeklies, etc. ii) Control Cost Sheet for Invoices (sample) iii) Forms, i.e., Expenditure Reports, Change of Scope
- Outline Consultant Performance Evaluation Criteria, i.e., Milestone Dates,
Quality, Safety Administration, Weighting Factors, Expectations, Timeliness of Reporting, etc.
- “B” Estimate at conceptual design stage. Provide explanation for differences. - “C” Estimate at design completion (One based on previous year Provincial
average cost, and one based on site specific conditions). 6) Details supplied to the Consultant - Contract Number - Program “A” Estimates for review. Provide PR’s, Scope of Work, Cost
Breakdown - Unit Price Schedule (if necessary) - Any pertinent Background
7) Other Items
- Add-ons - Bridge Files, Bridge Permit Information
- Special Provisions in Tender package (i.e. Liquidated Damages, Site Occupancy)
- Coordination of Utility Agreements
APPENDIX B
November 2011 B-2
8) Finals
- Copies of Finals Documents Package to be included as follows:
i) Summary Report (2 copies) ii) Final Estimate (1 copy) iii) Grand Summary (3 copies) iv) Final Details Checklist (3 copies) v) Widths and Thickness Diagram (3 copies) vi) E.P.S. Bonus payment Backup (3 copies) vii) Aggregate Removal Report (Dept. Source only) (3 copies)
APPENDIX C
November 2011
APPENDIX C
SUMMARY TABLES OF COMMONLY USED FORMS
APPENDIX C
November 2011
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX C
November 2011 C-1
ACCIDENT NOTIFICATION INCIDENT REPORT INVOLVING
THIRD PARTY AND/OR CONTRACTOR’S EQUIPMENT DATE OF ACCIDENT:_____________________________TIME:_______________J am J pm HWY. NO._________LOCATION____________________________________________________
YES NO YES NO
CONSTRUCTION ZONE J J MAINTENANCE ZONE J J OTHER:___________________ YES NO YES NO
IS HIGHWAY CLOSED J J TRAFFIC RESTRICTED J J OTHER:___________________ WEATHER CONDITIONS:_____________________ROAD CONDITIONS___________________
YES NO YES NO YES NO
ACCIDENT CAUSE: REARENDJ J SIDESWIPE J J HEAD-ON J J OTHER_______________
YES NO
POLICE CONTACTED J J DETACHMENT ___________________FILE # ________________ CONTRACTOR’S NAME:______________________________CONTRACT # _________________ THIRD PARTY:__________________________________________________________________ INJURIES (PLEASE CIRCLE ONE): CONTRACTOR: NONE - MINOR - SERIOUS - FATAL THIRD PARTY: NONE - MINOR - SERIOUS - FATAL BRIEF DESCRIPTION:_____________________________________________________________ ________________________________________________________________________________ ________________________________________________________________________________ ________________________________________________________________________________ INFORMATION REPORTED BY:____________________________DATE:___________________ FORM COMPLETED BY:__________________________________PHONE NO._______________
YES NO
IS FOLLOW UP REQUIRED BY THE DEPARTMENT? J J IF SO BY WHOM: CONTACT NAME____________________________PHONE NO.__________________ EMAIL TO: Regional Safety Officer J REGIONAL SAFETY OFFICER EMAIL TO: ADM Office J
APPENDIX C
November 2011 C-2
UTILITY ACCIDENT REPORT
To: From: Project Sponsor, Consultant: _______________________________ Region: Telephone No: _______________________________
Fax No: _______________________________ Contract No: _______________________________
Date of Accident Time � For your information and records
D M Y (Use 24:00 Hr) � For claims investigation ____________ � Others (Explain) ________________________ Project: ______________________ Description: _________________________ Station: _____________ Offset: _____ _________________________ Legal Description: 1/4 Sec. ________ TWP. ________ RGE. ________W. _______M. Contractor Name: __________________________ Phone No: ___________________ Equipment Used During Accident: _______________________________________________ Government or Hired Equipment: _____________ Unit No: ___________________ Operator Name: ___________________________ Phone No: ___________________ Utility Company: ___________________________ Contact: ______________________ Type of Utility: � Pipeline Size:___________ Commodity:_______________________ � Powerline � Tel. Cable � TV Cable � Others (Explain) ______________________________________________ Was utility locate requested? � Yes � No If “Yes” � Requested through Alberta 1st. call Reg. No: ___________________ � Requested through utility owner Date (d,m,y): ________________ If “No” (Explain) _________________________________________________________________ Severity of Accident: � Fatal � Injury � Property Damage
Brief Description of Injury
Name: _____________________________ Name: ___________________________________ Employer: __________________________ Employer: ________________________________ Injury: _____________________________ Injury: ____________________________________
APPENDIX C
November 2011 C-3
Description of Accident: ________________________________ ___________________________________________________ ___________________________________________________ ___________________________________________________ ___________________________________________________ ____________________________________________________________________________ ____________________________________________________________________________ ____________________________________________________________________________ Remarks: _____________________________________________________________________ _____________________________________________________________________________ _____________________________________________________________________________ _____________________________________________________________________________ Witness 1: Witness 2: Witness 3:
Name: _________________ _________________ __________________ Address: _________________ _________________ __________________ Phone: _________________ _________________ __________________ Position: _________________ _________________ __________________ Employer: _________________ _________________ __________________
Sketch area if required NOTE: For all pipeline hits & major cable cuts, photographs to accompany report within 48 hours.
_____________________________ Signature c.c ____________________________________________ _____________________________
Insurance Services, General Services Branch Title (Address) _____________________________
Date
APPENDIX C
November 2011 C-4
Office of the Regional Director
__________________________, 20__
NAME OF FIRM
RE: ATVS USE FOR FIELD SURVEYS
Thank you for your letter dated , 20__, requesting approval for your firm to use ATVs to conduct Field
Surveys for Engineering purposes.
Enclosed is the Order authorizing your firm to use the highway right-of-way (off highway surface) during the
daylight hours only.
Please contact the appropriate RCMP Detachments along the route regarding your activities.
While permission is granted, it must be understood that neither this department nor the government will accept any
responsibility or liability for anything that may occur as a result. Please be sure to remind the firm employees to obey
all applicable traffic laws and urge them to use the utmost caution at all times. As well, the ATV operator must have
a valid Operator’s License.
Sincerely,
Regional Director
Attachment (Order and Guidelines)
APPENDIX C
November 2011 C-5
GOVER�ME�T OF ALBERTA
DEPARTME�T OF TRA�SPORTATIO�
ALL - TERRAI� VEHICLES ORDER
I, _____________________________, Regional Director of Transportation, pursuant to Section 18(2) of the Off-
Highway Vehicle Act, make the following Order, being the ______________________________ Order.
_________________________ are authorized to permit ATVs between ___________________ within the highway
right-of-way, but not on the travelled portion of Highway during the period from __________________ to
___________________. This use is restricted to undertake engineering work and the attached Guidelines form a
condition of this permit.
DATED at _________________, Alberta this _________ day of ________________, 20___
____________________________
Regional Director of
Transportation
Request for Corporate Bridge Information Instructions
Viewing Location
4999 – 98th Avenue SE side of Twin Atria Main Floor Corporate Records Centre Phone: (780) 427-0039
Hours of Operation:
8:30 – 4:15 (Closed during lunch hour 12:00 – 1:00 daily)
*Minimum of 72 hours of notice must be given prior to viewing*
The following steps must be completed before access is permitted:
Consultant/Contractor Complete the Following:
• Name of representative and phone number• Company name (indicate if you are the prime consultant or a sub; if you are a sub consultant/contractor
indicate who is the prime consultant)• Who engaged by• Date requested and date required• Bridge site numbers, bridge site description, date range (eg: bridge site 74458 from 1945 to 1998)• Select the file types being requested• Project description• Obtain project sponsor signature• Email completed form to Corporate Records Centre (CRC) at [email protected]
Department Project Sponsor Complete the Following:
Name, signature and phone number
For Municipality Projects:
Include a signed and dated letter of authorization from the municipality project sponsor including a phone number.
Note: the request will not be processed without a signature)
Please Note the Following Guidelines:
• Minimum of 72 hours of notice must be given prior to viewing• Bookings will be done at a first come first serve basis• Maximum of four (4) individuals in the room at the same time• One consultant firm only in the room when doing a Request for Proposal (RFP)• No drop in requests will be accepted• Requestor must sign for records at CRC prior to viewing• Upon completion of review leave all records in the room so CRC staff can verify that all files have been
returned
APPENDIX C
June 2016 C-6
Request For Corporate Bridge Information
Representative Information
Name ____________________________ Phone Number ____________________________ Email Address ____________________________
Company Name, Phone Number, Email Address)
Prime Consultant: _____________________________ Sub Consultant: _____________________________ Email Address: _____________________________
___________________ RFP for Transportation ___________________ Engaged by MD/County ___________________ Other (Explain)
Date Requested: ______________________ Date Required AM/PM: ______________________ Date Reviewed ______________________
Bridge Site Number (Date Range Required)
Project Description
AP – Agreement Plans FD - Final Details RA - Rating Design BI - Bearing Inspection / Repair
FL - Flood SFR - Steel Fabrication Report
BO – Board Orders General Correspondence SGI - Steel Girder Inspection
CN – Construction GT - Geotechnical TI - Truss Inspection DK – Deck IR - Inspection Report DN – Design Notes MIR - Misc Inspection
Reports Drawings (Design) Obtain from Project Sponsor
PCG - Precast Concrete Girders
Drawings (Shop) Obtain from Project Sponsor
PI - Paint Inspection
Project Sponsor (Print Name) Signature Phone Number ___________________________ ___________________________ ___________________________
Email completed form to Corporate Records Centre (CRC) at [email protected]
You will be contacted only if the request cannot be filled by the requested time period.
APPENDIX C
June 2016 C-7
C-8
Municipality Request For Corporate Bridge Information
Authorization to Proceed and View Alberta Transportation Bridge Files
We authorize ____________________(Consultant Name) to view Alberta Transportation Bridge Files for these bridge sites as well as any sites upstream, downstream or on adjacent roadways or watercourse’s which would be required to obtain local site history for the completion of the current assignment.
Signed: (Municipality Project Sponsor)
Date: _____________________________
Phone: ____________________________
The information provided by Alberta Transportation is provided in confidence and shall not be used or disclosed either directly or indirectly except for
• purposes necessary for the performance of services under contract• the preparation of proposals to Alberta Transportation• The following information is being collected under the authority of the Government Organization
Act and will be used to track the access of corporate information. It is protected by the privacyprovisions of the Freedom of Information and Protection of Privacy Act.
APPENDIX C
June 2016
APPENDIX C
November 2011 C-9
PAYMENT VOUCHERS - DIRECTIONS ON USE
The Payment Voucher has been prepared in such a manner that certain fields remain the same, or constant. These fields have been identified in red.
The Payment Voucher is a Word document that is utilized by the Department to identify various types of coding and provides our accounting department a means to enter information into an electronic format.
The Payment Voucher identifies the “vendor” or “payee” by using a 10-digit number, which represents the vendor’s address and other payment criteria.
The consultant will be required to fill in the following fields (using the “tab” key to move to the next available space):
Prepared By – please enter the person’s name that is filling in the form.Date – enter date the form is being prepared.Amount Payable – enter total amount payable, less GST (see GST Exemption Clause).Invoice Date – enter date in MMDDYY formatInvoice ID – enter invoice numberLine 01 Amount – enter amount that will be charged to Engineering Fees1.Line 02 Amount – enter amount that will be charged to Engineering Disbursements2.Note – Lines 01 and 02 will add up to total Amount Payable.
Please forward the completed Payment Voucher along with your invoice and other supporting documents to Attn: Project Sponsor or, should you choose, the completed form can be forwarded by e-mail to projectsponsor’sfirstname.projectsponsor’[email protected].
For any questions regarding the completion of this form and account status please contact the Project Sponsor’s Administrative Assistant.
1 Engineering Fees – Includes payments to architects, engineers, draftsmen, testing, and related costs.
2 Engineering Disbursements – Includes payments for services that involve a combination of people, materials, and business services not identified in Engineering Fees.
APPENDIX C
November 2011 C-10
Payment Voucher Completion Guide for Consultants
1) Complete the “Payment Voucher” as follows:
• (A) Business Unit: Hard Coded 169A• (B) Voucher ID: Leave Blank• (C) Prepared by: Name of the person who prepared payment voucher• (D) Date: the date you prepared the voucher
2) Complete the “Invoice Header Information” as follows:
• (E) Vendor #: Department Supplied• (F) Terms: as directed• (G) Amount Payable: Actual Amount Payable• (H) Accounting Rule: N/A• (I) Invoice Date: Enter the invoice date in the standard format of “mm-dd-yy”.• (J) Factor to Vendor Number: N/A• (K) Invoice ID: Enter the invoice number (Please Note: for “Contracts” use contract number
and estimate number) example: 1234/00Est1• (L) Expenditure Officer Approval: Department Use• (M) Date: Date Expenditure Officers signs• (N) Payment Message: Enter additional information that will be printed on the remittance
advice (limited to 30 characters). example: Hwy No. and CON No
3) Chart Fields
• (O) Amount: Dollar amount• (P) Account – Defines the expenditure – will be supplied by Project Sponsor
example: 543060 (for CON agreements) 535030 (for construction contract payments) 215031 (for holdback)
• (Q) Fund –Defines operating or capital – will be supplied by Project Sponsorexample: 01 or 02
• (R) Org – Defines the departmental office where request was originated.• (S) Program – Defines the program(s) where the payment is to be charged– will be supplied by
Project Sponsor• (T) Project – Refer to the Job Number for which the expenditure is to be applied – will be
supplied by Project Sponsor• (U) Task – Defines the task performed – will be supplied by Project Sponsor as well as
additional Task and Activity Coding Information• (V) Activity – Defines the action performed – will be supplied by Project Sponsor as well as
additional Task and Activity Coding• (W) KMs – N/A• (X) KM Code – Department use• (Y) Tax Code – Department use• (Z) 1099 Code – N/A• (AA) Contract – Enter the CON number example: CON00100101• (BB) Employee No. – Department use
APPENDIX C
November 2011 C-11
PAYME�T VOUCHER Page __1___ of _____
BUSINESS UNIT VOUCHER ID PREPARED BY: DATE:
169A (A)
(B)
(C) (D) VENDOR #
(E)
TERMS
AMOUNT PAYABLE
ACCOUNTING RULE
(F) (G)
(H) INVOICE DATE ( M M - D D - Y Y )
FACTOR TO VENDOR NUMBER
EXPENDITURE OFFICER APPROVAL: DATE:
(I) (J)
INVOICE ID
(K)
(L) (M) PAYMENT MESSAGE
DUE DATE
HANDLING CODE
(�)
Line Amount Account
Fund Org Program
01 (O)
(P)
(Q)
(R)
(S)
Project
More… Task
Activity
(T)
(U)
(V)
KMs KM Code Tax Code 1099 Code Contract
Employee
(W)
(X)
(Y)
(Z)
(AA)
00E(BB)
Line Amount Account
Fund Org Program
02
Project More... Task Activity
KMs KM Code Tax Code 1099 Code Contract Employee
00E
Line Amount Account
Fund Org Program
03
Project More... Task Activity
KMs KM Code Tax Code 1099 Code Contract Employee
00E
Line Amount Account
Fund Org Program
04
Project More... Task Activity
KMs KM Code Tax Code 1099 Code Contract
Employee
00E
Voucher Form Payment with Alpha Codes July 27, 2010 2.2.1
APPENDIX C
November 2011 C-12
DESIGN STANDARDS/ PRACTICE EXCEPTION
REQUEST FORM Date: Project: Region: Project Sponsor: Consultant: NOTE: complete, modify and/or provide additional information as required. Project Stage ( ) Functional Planning ( ) Preliminary Design ( ) Detailed Design ( ) Construction ( ) Traffic Impact Assessment (development) ( ) Access Management ( ) Other ______________Please specify
Project Type ( ) Functional Planning ( ) New Construction ( ) Reconstruction ( ) Paving/Surfacing ( ) Bridge ( ) Operations ( ) Geotechnical ( ) Environmental ( ) Other ______________Please specify
Project Data (typically required for all projects) Project Description Highway No. Control Section Km Posts From: To: Length of Project Chainage (if applicable) From: To: Chain Direction � South to North � West to East
Design Designation Service Classification Basic or Existing Right-of-Way
Existing Traffic Vol. AADT ASDT Projected Traffic Vol. (___ years)
AADT ASDT
Design Vehicles Vehicle Distribution
Design Speed Posted Speed
Example of information required for geometric design: Cross-Section: Existing Width Width after Overlay 3R/4R (Suggested
Min. Width) Current Standards
Back slope Side slope
Ditch Width
Level of Service: Existing Projected Horz. Alignment Min. Radii Proposed Radii
Vert. Alignment Min. K Crest Curve Proposed K Crest Curve
Min. K Sag Curve Proposed K Sag Curve
Max Grade: Proposed Grade:
Existing Passing/Climbing Lanes
APPENDIX C
November 2011 C-13
Collision History (if applicable): (Period Year to Year) ( ) Segment ( ) Interchange ( ) Intersection ( ) Bridge ( ) Other _________Please specify
Collision Data Non Animal Animal Total Collison Rate Collision Frequency Collision Severity Breakdown
# Fatal # Injury # PDO
Other (Type): Please specify
Other Criteria - Please Specify
Details and Supporting Documentation of Design Exception Provide drawings, analysis, evaluations, cost estimates, rationale, justification, etc. and supporting documentation as required. Recommended: Recommended: ----------------------------------- --------------------------------- Project Sponsor/Date Regional Director/Date Recommended : Recommended (if applicable): ----------------------------------- ----------------------------------- Technical Standards Branch/Date Executive Director of Planning/Date Approved: ------------------------------------- Executive Director of Technical Standards Branch/Date
APPENDIX C
November 2011 C-14
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX D
November 2011
APPENDIX D
PLANNING REQUIREMENTS
APPENDIX D
November 2011
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-1
PLANNING STUDY TYPES 1. CORRIDOR STUDY A corridor is defined as a strip of land approximately 1 to 3 kilometres wide. This type of study is used to identify and analyze general routings for new alignments over a wide area usually through undeveloped lands. It is generally completed with the use of large scale mapping, air photo interpretation, and a field reconnaissance. A corridor study can be considered as rough work or approximations where one would consider the constructability of a roadway corridor in general terms such as acceptable grades; construction material constraints (e.g. muskeg crossings); general location of bridge crossings; and general cultural impacts such as communities, utilities, other roads, or any other man made things. A corridor study leads to a more detailed location study along the selected corridor.
2. LOCATION STUDY A Location Study is a detailed study that:
• Determines the precise location for a roadway in a rural setting • Defines the future roadway standards and considers improvements to the horizontal and
vertical alignment • Defines approximate earthwork quantities based on a tentative grade line • Reviews environmental concerns • Reviews historical resources • Reviews wildlife issues • Involves a detailed bridge planning component • Looks at geotechnical concerns • Looks at avoiding or mitigating utility conflicts • Looks at access control/considerations • Defines right-of-way requirements and property impacts • Considers First Nations issues • Provides an approximate cost estimate for construction • Defines future traffic projections and identifies possible future traffic generators, as well
as existing and future traffic patterns • May identify possible construction staging/timing • Considers local community development plans and needs
3. INTERCHANGE STUDY An Interchange Study reviews alternate configurations of interchanges, recommends the most appropriate and cost effective configuration, and looks at staging the construction of the interchanges
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-2
4. ACCESS MANAGEMENT STUDIES Access Management Studies are conducted to:
• Review existing access locations along a roadway • Review need for interchanges • Reviews need to upgrade intersections to higher standards • Review need for service roads • Looks at access consolidation • Looks at access spacing consistent with the highway service classification
There are many factors involved for choosing an intersection type, including:
• Highway traffic volumes • Intersecting road traffic volumes • Intersection road classification • Traffic type • Turning movements • Sight distance • Gradient on highway and intersecting road • Vehicle turning radii (large trucks) • Acceleration rates for large trucks
5. TRAFFIC IMPACT ASSESSMENTS
A Traffic Impact Assessment defines the standards that an intersection should be designed and constructed to base upon developments occurring on lands outside the highway right-of-way. It takes into consideration existing, background, and/or projected traffic based upon specific development types or ITE traffic generation numbers for specific land uses. In addition, it determines proposed development traffic, intersection needs, and a future (15 to 20 years) projection of intersection improvements required. Traffic Impact Assessments may include items such as signals, illumination and pedestrian crossing warrants, and will typically review the geometric requirements for the intersection based upon traffic type and volumes (note that the traffic type and volumes will depend on the type of development being proposed). 6. BRIDGE PLANNING STUDY Bridge Planning Studies focus mainly on the bridge crossing site: the objective is to find the most cost effective method for bridge replacement either at the existing location or at a new location. These studies also deal with investigating the need for upgrading the bridge approaches, and in some instances, an alignment study may dictate that a particular crossing be made to work. 7. FUNCTIONAL PLANNING STUDY A Functional Planning Study is similar to a location study as far as data collection and considerations are concerned. They differ only in complexity and usually deal with multi-lane highways, upgrading (twinning) highways, intersections and interchanges. These studies are usually in and near urban areas and can involve traffic modeling and complex traffic movements.
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-3
MOSAIC PRODUCTION
The Department has moved towards the use of ortho-rectified mosaics. This is the Departments preference unless otherwise indicated that scale-corrected mosaics are acceptable. Mosaics are to be produced digitally using the appropriate software. For ortho-mosaics, the raster is to be corrected to a base map consisting of parcel mapping and the Provincial Digital Elevation Model (DEM). For improved accuracy, particularly projects that have a lot of terrain relief, contour mapping may also be supplied or requested to aid in scale correction of the raster. If only scale-corrected mosaics are requested, then the raster is corrected to a base map consisting of parcel mapping. In either case the base map is to be based on the 3-TM, NAD 83 coordinate system and the appropriate base longitude. Phone Highway Geomatics to confirm the base longitude for the project. The scale and date of the aerial photography used is to be determined by the Department. The aerial photography that is used for scanning can be in either print or diapositive format. The photography is to be scanned at a minimum resolution of 600 dpi. Tone matching between aerial photographs is required when more than one aerial photograph is needed for a mosaic sheet. The flight line number, aerial print number, and the date of the aerial photography is to be recorded on each mosaic sheet. The typical standard mosaic sheet format to be used will be supplied by the Department. The mosaic sheets are to be positioned on the base map so that the highway alignment is approximately centred within the sheet. Additionally, the mosaic sheets are to be positioned to allow for approximately 300 metres of overlap on each side of each sheet for adjacent sheets. Extra overlap between sheets may be required to compensate for additional length in the profile as the result of horizontal curves. The design files are to be rotated about the origin point to an angle of 0 degrees. The design files supplied to the Department are to be compatible to MicroStation. The scale corrected rasters are to be rotated to an angle of 0 degrees and clipped to fit within the reference points on the mosaic sheet. The raster files supplied to the Department are to be in a format that is compatible with 'Intergraph I/RAS C'. The design files and clipped rasters are to be plotted at an angle of 0 degrees and at a minimum resolution of 400 dpi. Plotting is to be done on a dimensionally stable Mylar that is between 0.03mm and 0.04mm in thickness. The plotting device is to be able to produce a permanent non-smearable plot. The maximum allowable scale error of the plotted mosaic sheet measuring between the corner origin points is 2mm. The maximum allowable error in the accuracy of the raster to base map within the clipped area is 1mm. The maximum allowable error between adjacent mosaic sheets in the overlapping areas is 1mm. The mosaic/raster files are to be supplied to the Department at the completion of the project. The Departments preference is to receive this information on CD-ROM.
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-4
Following is a list of file extension naming conventions that are to be used:
• .OS1, .OS2 for mosaic sheets from number one to nine • .010, .011 for mosaic sheets from number ten and greater • i.e. HWY2.OS1, HWY2.010
• .EXT for raster files (i.e. H2SHTO1.EXT) • .DET for mapping detail design files • .LGL for base map design files • .PRO for profile design files • .CON for contour design files • .ALI for alignment design files
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-5
BASIC RIGHT-OF-WAY REQUEST For the purpose of purchasing the basic highway right-of-way, the Engineering Consultant will provide right-of-way information on 1:5000 scale digital photo mosaics. These mosaics are in addition to the mosaics prepared for the functional planning study and are to be constructed to the standards as outlined in Mosaic Production on the previous pages. The mosaics should show clearly and concisely all right-of-way requirements. Prior to submission of the final Right-of-Way Request package, two (2) coloured copies marked “DRAFT” are to be provided to the Property Manager for review and approval. Once the Right-of-Way Request has been approved by the Property Manager and the Project Sponsor, the Consultant is to provide:
• Seven (7) sets of colour paper mosaic prints • One (1) transparent version with no colour • Three (3) coloured mosaics schematic plan showing an overview of the entire project on
one sheet. It may be necessary to use two sheets for larger projects. The size of these project overview plans shall not exceed 11”x 17” in size.
• Individual Ownership Plan’s (IOP’s) showing the proposed right-of-way information for each titled property affected by the project (excepting thereout titled crown land). The IOP shall not exceed 8.5”x14” in size. The contents of the IOP’s shall be consistent with the requirements for the mosaic information required except that only the required right-of-way is to be shaded in red.
• Plans required by Sustainable Resource Development for the submission of the Provisional Roadway Application on untitled crown lands
• One (1) electronic copy in .PDF format of all required plans listed above A thorough and current title search is required on all lands affected by the project. All encumbrances must be reviewed. All encumbrances in the name of Her Majesty the Queen (Minister of Transportation) must be reviewed through the Regional Property Manager for clarification of the nature and extent of the encumbrances/caveats. The date of the title search should be clearly labelled on the mosaics under the title block. In addition, the following information is to be shown clearly on the mosaics:
• Land ownership, which is to include the landowner’s name and current address, the amount of right-of-way required from each parcel or land affected in both acres and hectares (right-of-way area calculations to be indicated to the nearest 0.1 acres / 0.01 hectares), land title certificate number, legal description, and/or plan number all labelled within the owner’s property. In the case where the parcel of land is too small to record the information within the property boundaries, the information may be shown outside the property with an indicator arrow.
• Show all Certificate of Title boundaries, surveyed rights-of-way, easements, service road
dedications, etc. • Any changes or relocation of existing accesses must be shown including alternate
means of access (e.g. service road, local road, private drive). • Indicate the area of all cut-off parcels or severed land that should be considered for
optional purchase by the Department or consolidation with adjacent properties.
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-6
• Show all dimensions of the proposed and existing right-of-way as well as the additional right-of-way requirements, showing the difference between the two.
• In areas such as subdivisions, towns, etc. where there are properties too numerous to
show the required information clearly at the 1:5000 scale, a more detailed plan at a suitable scale may be required. Details on these plans will follow the same requirements as stated in Mosaic Production on the previous pages and this document.
• In areas through untitled crown lands, the Consultant is to conduct a Land Status
Automated System (LSAS) search for all existing land use interests (i.e. Leases, license of occupation, pipelines, etc.) affected by the required right–of-way. The consultant is to obtain any and all plans or sketches that are within the proposed highway right-of-way including ownership of the interests (if available) and record this information on the mosaics to the aforementioned standards.
• In areas through Special Areas Board land, a Special Areas Board search must be
conducted to identify occupants. • Identify potential contaminated sites. • All mosaic updates and revisions must be consecutively numbered, beginning with
Right-of-way request #1. • It is required that all right-of-way requirements are to be shown on the mosaic prints
highlighted with shading in the appropriate colour to the following format. A colour legend indicating the following must be shown adjacent to the title block, on each mosaic sheet.
• Right-of-way required ..................................................................................... RED
• Previously requested right-of-way ............................................................. GREEN
• Cancellation of previously requested right-of-way .................................. YELLOW
• Requested easements ........................................................................... ORANGE
• Optional purchases ....................................................... CROSSHATCHED (RED)
• Possible borrow locations..............................................10cm diam. RED CIRCLE • Each mosaic sheet title block must indicate “Preliminary Design”, the date of mosaic
preparation, and “Right-of-Way Request Number”.
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-7
Required information Sample of preferred format Legal Description C. of T. number Landowner name/s Landowners address R/W required (Provide separate areas for highway r/w and Service road r/w) (Red) Previously requested r/w (Green) Cancellation of previously requested r/w (Yellow) Requested Easement (Orange) Optional purchase (Cross Hatched Red) Possible borrow locations (Red Circle 10 cm dia.)
NE 27-73-4-W6M or Plan /Block/Lot 962 305 963 Bob Smith and Cathy Smith Box 1234, Worsley, AB T0H 3P0 Required Highway R/W - 5.9 ac (2.38 ha) Required Service Road R/W - ac ( ha) Previously requested R/W – 5.2 ac (2.10 ha) Cancelled R/W – 2.5 ac (1.01 ha) Easement – 1.3 ac (0.5 ha) Optional purchase / cut-off –29.6ac (11.98 ha) Total R/W required - ac ( ha) Possible borrow location – 10 cm diam. Red circle
Note: Use only the headings that are applicable.
- Information to be indicated in the upper right corner (Title Block)
- A Right-of-Way request form is required for
each revision to the r/w requirements
Right-of-way Request # 3 - June 21, 1999 Preliminary Design, For Discussion Purposes Only
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-8
Sample format
Insert Consultants Logo RIGHT-OF-WAY REQUEST
To: Insert name of Property Manager
Project Description:
Insert description of project and bridge file number if applicable
FILE: DATE: R/W REQUEST NO.:
INDICATE (X) IF APPLICABLE
TYPE OF REQUEST
COLOUR ON PLAN
RIGHT-OF-WAY REQUESTED
RED
PREVIOUSLY REQUESTED RIGHT-OF-WAY
GREEN
CANCELLATION OF PREVIOUSLY REQUESTED RIGHT-OF-WAY
YELLOW
EASEMENT BEING REQUESTED
ORANGE
OPTIONAL PURCHASED
CROSS-HATCHED (RED)
POSSIBLE BORROW LOCATIONS
10 CM DIAM. RED CIRCLE
JUSTIFICAITON:
ADDITIONAL REMARKS:
REQUESTED BY:
NAME DATE SIGNATURE
APPROVED AS TO FORM & CONTENT BY PROPERTY MANAGER:
APPROVED FOR ACQUISITION BY PROJECT SPONSOR:
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-9
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-10
HISTORICAL RESOURCES OVERVIEW SCOPE OF WORK
The Historical Resources Overview shall be designed to review current historical resources location data, topography, disturbances, and sedimentary regimes to develop a model of historical resources potential of the proposed development area. The objective of this study is to identify those areas, if any, for which a Historical Resources Impact Assessment is needed. The Overview shall include:
• Examination of site data files maintained by Alberta Community Development for archaeological and historic sites and sensitivity maps for paleontological concerns;
• Summary description and evaluation of known sites within the development zone with a
particular focus on site location and function variables; • Making full use of ancillary data such as ethno graphic, ethno historic, environmental
and paleo-environmental studies; • Developing a model of historical resources potential for the impact area based on known
data, topographical potential, models of land use and site distribution; • Ground truthing to consist of evaluating terrain potential for historical resources,
assessing the degree of previous disturbance and evaluating sedimentation and its effect on field methods such as the need for deep testing. The discovery of historical resources per se is not the objective of the ground truthing stage; and
• Formulating detailed recommendations regarding the need for a Historical Resources
Impact Assessment, and the locations, scope, and methods necessary.
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-11
ENVIRONMENTAL ASSESSMENT REQUIREMENTS Information on the following Valued Ecosystem Components (VEC) must be collected in order to ensure that the effect(s) of the proposed roadway alignment or improvements on the environment can be determined. The significance of the impact of the roadway on the environment shall be determined and the mitigation measures recommended to decrease the roadway impact on the VEC. I. Surface/Groundwater
A review of surface water patterns throughout the study area shall be conducted. Areas suspected to have groundwater concerns should be identified. Any unusual areas where surface/groundwater problems may occur should also be identified. Proximity to water wells, dugouts?
II. Vegetation An inventory of vegetation communities in the study area or along the alignment(s) shall be conducted. Rare, threatened, or endangered species and communities should be identified.
III. Wildlife The study area or alignment(s) shall be reviewed for the presence of any wildlife. Rare, threatened, or endangered species should be identified along with any habitat utilized for any portion of their life stage.
IV. Fisheries The study area or alignment(s) shall be reviewed for the presence of fish and fish habitat in all watercourses. Where no information is available, then a fisheries inventory and a fish habitat assessment shall be undertaken. Rare, threatened, or endangered fish species or habitat should be identified.
V. Historical Resources Refer to Historical Resources Overview Scope of Work on previous page.
VI. Soil/Landforms Soils shall be classified according to the Canadian System of Soil Classification or other common systems recognized in Alberta. Representative topsoil depths should be identified and any special concerns with soil handling procedures should also be identified. Landforms within the study area or along the alignment(s) should be identified and any special properties regarding the landforms should also be identified.
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-12
LOCATION SURVEY REQUIREMENTS Location surveys may be required on zone planning project, in which case this need will be identified in the project Terms of Reference. The purpose of the Location Survey is to accurately establish the recommended alignment on the ground to ensure that it fits to the surrounding terrain and to confirm that there are no additional impacts that will affect the highway location. The alignment as established on the ground will be used to establish the alignment for a preliminary survey at a later date. Note that a Locations Survey is not a preliminary survey and may require that the horizontal alignment be revised and resurveyed a number of times to achieve optimum placement. Required Tasks
• The recommended alignment is to be tied to the Alberta Survey Network (3TM, NAD 83 coordinate system) and based on the appropriate base longitude so the alignment can be plotted graphically and accuracy of the survey can be confirmed.
• Obtain written permission of landowners/leaseholders for access to land where
applicable. • Establish tangents and points of intersection (PI's), points on tangent (POT's), and ends
of curves along the recommended alignment. The POT's and ends of curve's are to be referenced with offsets at 90 degrees to the centre line tangents a distance that is outside the proposed right-of-way width so that the alignment can be easily re-established at a later date for a preliminary survey. A metal rod approximately 30 centimetres in length should be used, where appropriate, and countersunk a minimum of 30 centimetres below the ground especially in cultivated areas.
• All centre-line points, offset points and ends of curves are to be clearly marked with
1"x2" marker stakes and a marker lathe bearing the appropriate centre-line chainage. For offsets the offset distance and direction from centre-line should be clearly marked on the reverse side of the marker stakes.
• Where applicable the recommended alignment is to be tied to all legal survey pins in the
immediate vicinity. • All curves and tangents are to be staked at 20 metre intervals. • A centre-line profile is required using geodetic datum. All natural breaks in the terrain
that do not fall within the 20 metre staking are to be recorded. • Spot cross-sections in critical areas along the alignment are required to ensure the
alignment fits to the surrounding terrain. • Additional profiling to geodetic datum is required along all public access roads to a
minimum distance of 300 metres. Some access roads may require longer profiles depending on the terrain.
• Chainages are to increase from south to north and from west to east.
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-13
• Transit notes are required detailing all existing features in the vicinity of the recommended alignment. In forested areas the type and general size of the trees are to be recorded.
• All original curve/transit notes, centre-line profile notes and bench mark level notes are
to be recorded in appropriate note books and supplied to the Department upon completion of the survey.
• The recommended alignment is to be plotted on the mosaics using the field co-ordinates
and chainages obtained from the survey. All PI coordinates are to be recorded on the mosaics in table form on their respective sheets.
• At the request of the Technical Standards Branch, a standard bridge survey may be
required for selected water course crossings. If required this issue will be covered in a separate Schedule included with the Terms of Reference.
• Safety procedures for survey crews are to be adhered to at all times (adequate warning
signs and flag people if necessary, etc.)
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-14
TYPICAL PLANNING STUDY PROCESS FOR MAJOR FUNCTIONAL PLANNING STUDIES PUBLIC PARTICIPATION AND PROJECT APPROVAL (Under the direction of the Technical Review Committee) (NOTE: This process may vary depending on the type of project) Send letter from Minister to MLA informing of upcoming study. Send letter from Consultant to Local Authority informing of study initiation
Notify, by letter, all adjacent landowners of project initiation (Consultant) **
Meet with Local Authorities and/or major stakeholders to identify issues
(Consultant and the Department if meeting with council members) Develop conceptual plans for presentation at first public open house meeting Meet with MLA’s (if required), Consultant and the Department.
First open house (complete the following tasks as part of “open house procedure”)
- Review the consultants advertisement, coverage, and strategy (Department) - Notify by letter, the MLA’s local authorities, adjacent landowners and
stakeholders of public meeting data (Consultant) ** - Advertise in local media of upcoming open house (Consultant)** - Hold first open house to present broad concepts for discussion purposes
(Consultant, right-of-way agent, and the Department)
Hold individual discussion with concerned landowners (Consultant and right-of- way agent, or other Department representative)
Develop more detailed plans based on input from first open house and
discussion with landowners and stakeholders (Consultant)
Hold second open house and repeat all tasks in “open house procedure” to present findings from first open house and revised plans (Consultant, right-of-way agent, and the Department).
Prepare draft report for review by technical review committee (consultant)
Present recommendation and obtain acceptance from the Department Divisional Executive Committee (Consultant)
Prepare necessary documentation for briefing outlining recommendations and
public feedback for the Deputy Minister and the Minister (Consultant)
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-15
Send letter from the Minister to the MLA’s advising the results of the study and the date of the third open house (Consultant to prepare draft letter)
Hold third (final) open house to present final recommended plan and repeat all tasks required in “open house procedure” (Consultant right-of-way agent, and the Department)
Send letter to MLA’s informing of completion of study and future actions
Prepare a letter for the signature of the Regional Director (Consultant). Send this letter and plan to landowners indicating:
- Status of recommended plan - General data of construction - Right-of-way requirements - Timing of right-of-way purchase (Department right-of-way Contact Person) - Department’s contact person and telephone number (Regional Director)
** A statement is provided in all letters to the public, newspaper advertisements,
and an open house questionnaire’s indicating a specific contact person and collect telephone number for the consultant.
Indicates enhancements to the public participation process Note: There could still be some stakeholders who may not be satisfied with the
recommended plan. Every effort will be made to mitigate the individual’s concerns/issues through on going discussions.
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-16
COMMUNICATIONS PROCEDURES FOR OPEN HOUSES Advertising It is the Consultant’s responsibility to ensure that all stakeholders are aware of any open house or public meeting(s). The Consultant will work within newspaper(s) deadlines to ensure ads are placed in the appropriate newspaper(s). The Consultant will: • Develop ad copy using the template provided by the Department (Consultant’s and
Department’s logos to appear on the bottom of the ad – Department logo to appear on the right hand side)
• Provide a list of newspapers where the ad will be inserted and list insertion dates, and book space in newspaper(s) for insertion at least one week before the event
• Submit draft copy for approval to Communications at least two weeks in advance • Provide Transportation’s approved ad copy to newspaper(s) • Provide Communications with a tear sheet (or photocopy of ad) from newspaper(s)
Correspondence to Landowners Using the template provided, the Consultant will draft correspondence to the land-owner and stakeholders in plain language. Correspondence to include: • an explanation that the consultant was hired by the Department to manage the project • a plain language description of the project • mention that the open house(s) will take place and list the location, date, and time • mention that their participation is important and valued • a request to landowners to advise anyone else who has an interest in this project about the
open house • a contact name and telephone number
Approval: Draft correspondence must be submitted to Communications for approval at least two weeks in advance.
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-17
Fact Sheet The Consultant will develop a fact sheet for distribution at the open house. Information should: • be in plain language • provide background details • provide current status • state proposed plans • provide a contact name for further information • have both the Consultant’s and the Department’s logo on bottom right hand side of fact
sheet Approval: Submit draft fact sheet to Communications for approval at least two weeks in advance of open house Display The Consultant will develop a display with maps and alternate plans or proposals if applicable. Information should: • be in plain language • be point form • be in large type • use lots of white space • include maps if applicable • include charts if applicable • have the Consultant’s and the Department’s (bottom right hand side) logos on display panel Approval: Submit draft display copy to Communications for approval at least two weeks in advance Survey If the Consultant and the Department decide that a survey should be developed for an open house or public meeting, the Consultant will: • develop one using plain language • encourage participation by having a statement of how important stakeholders’ comments
are • at a table near the exit, provide a cardboard box or other container so that participants can
return completed surveys anonymously • give a fax number and mailing addresses where questionnaires can be returned • state a deadline for receipt of the questionnaires • follow up with Communications on survey results/analysis If the stakeholder can be identified by any information on the completed questionnaire, the following statement must be added to the survey:
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-18
Personal information that you provide on this form is protected under the Freedom of Information and Protection of Privacy Act of Alberta. The personal information that is collected on this form relates directly to programs being undertaken by Alberta Transportation and will be used to reply to your questions and concerns supplied on this form. No other use will be made of this information and it will not be released without your written consent. Approval: Submit draft survey to Communications for approval at least two weeks in advance. Communications for those with Special Needs Consultants should be aware of any special needs of their stakeholders and anticipate the need for alternative formats for communications such as larger print handouts and interpreters. Where practical, meeting venues should be accessible to persons with disabilities. This would include wheelchair access, washroom access, and adequate lighting. Issues Management The Consultant is to identify any potential issues and must advise the Department project manager and Communications of these. The Consultant and Communications will work together to manage all issues. Media Relations The Consultant will deal with the media on general project questions. The Consultant will: • always respond in a timely manner • stick to the facts • not give their own opinion • not comment on policy decisions • speak only on behalf of the Department • not speculate if they do not know the answer to a question (advise the reporter you will get
the information and call them back) • telephone Communications and discuss media questions and responses if known ahead of
time • complete a media request form and fax immediately to Communications
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-19
OPEN HOUSE
HIGHWAY XXX Planning Study
Alberta Transportation has retained ZZZ Engineering Ltd. to complete a --- etc.
You are invited to view plans and provide input on the planning study at
an open house on: September 23, 2011
6 p.m. XXX Community Centre
ZZZ Engineering Ltd. representatives will be in attendance to outline the project and answer questions. For more information on the planning study, please contact _______ collect at (xxx) xxx-xxxx or e-mail ___________.
ZZZ Engineering Ltd.
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-20
Sample Correspondence to Stakeholder Date Dear Property Owner: Alberta Transportation has retained the XYZ Company, an engineering firm, to determine (description of what company XYZ is doing). Please plan to attend the scheduled open house/public information session as your participation in this process is important. Location: Date: Time: We have attempted to contact all landowners who may be affected by this project. Should you be aware of other individuals or groups, who may have an interest in this subject, please advise them of the open house/public information session, or contact us directly. If you have any questions, or would like more information, please call my office at (area code) xxx-xxxx. (Please include a toll-free number if you have one.) We look forward to seeing you at the open house/public information session. Sincerely, John Smith Consultant
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-21
Sample Survey Topic: Highway 14X Access Relocation In order to understand your transportation requirements, concerns, and community-related issues, your assistance, by completing this survey, is appreciated. Please take this time to review and discuss the plans with staff before completing the survey. 1. How did you hear about this session? ___________________________________________________________________ ___________________________________________________________________ ___________________________________________________________________ 2. Were the information displays helpful? ______Yes ______ No 3. Were the hosts helpful in explaining the xx? ______ Yes ______ No 4. Did the open house help you to better understand the requirements for xxxxxxxxxx? ______ Yes ______No 5. Do you have any comments or suggestions that you feel may be useful in the xxxxx? ________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________ Thank-you for your participation. Please deposit your questionnaire in the box at the door when leaving. You may also fax or mail the completed survey to: consultant’s name, address, etc., fax number. DEADLINE date (one week from time of open house) Note: If you ask for the following information as part of the survey you must include the statement pertaining to Freedom of Information and Protection of Privacy Act.
APPENDIX D
November 2011 D-22
Contact Information: ____________________________________________________________ Name ____________________________________________________________ Street/Avenue/RR#/Box # ____________________________________________________________ Town/City Province Postal Code Personal information that you provide on this form is protected under the Freedom of Information and Protection of Privacy Act of Alberta. The personal information that is collected on this form relates directly to programs being undertaken by Alberta Transportation and will be used to reply to your questions and concerns supplied on this form. No other use will be made of this information and it will not be released without your written consent.
Consultant Logo Transportation Logo
APPENDIX E
November 2011
APPENDIX E
HIGHWAY GRADING/SURFACING DESIGN COORDINATION FLOW
CHART
APPENDIX E
November 2011
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX E
November 2011 E-1
CO�SULTA�T HIGHWAY GRADI�G / SURFACI�G DESIG� COORDI�ATIO� FLOW DIAGRAM
THIS CHART IS O�LY A GE�ERAL GUIDE AS PROJECTS WILL HAVE U�IQUE DIFFERE�CES THAT THE DESIG�ER SHOULD ADJUST FOR
CONSULTANT
CONSULTANT
CONSULTANT
CONSULTANT
CONSULTANT
Right-Of-Way Prepare Intersection Request Contact property
review ‘B’ estimate analysis final agent about
and forward and Right-Of-Way special conditions
to project requirements and borrow in land
sponsor sources agreements
DEPARTMENT
DEPARTMENT
CONSULTANT
CONSULTANT
CONCERNED
PARTIES
DEPARTMENT /
CONSULTANT
CONSULTANT
CONSULTANT
CONCERNED
PARTIES
CONSULTANT
(DESIGNER /
ENGINEER
CONSULTANT
CONSULTANT
Consultant Project Preliminary Commence Discussion Basic Obtain Modify design Final design Prepare and Submit tender Forward Department
selection sponsor calls engineering design of design design environmental based on review meeting check grading package to survey and accepts
and project of project exceptions, review permits, licenses, recommendations (as requested) design package project sponsor design data design and
tender
packages
assignment initialization alternatives, and approval from others including cost to the
of projects meeting etc. estimate project sponsor
LIASE WITH TECHNICAL STANDARDS BRANCH ON ROADWAY DESIGN, SURFACING STRUCTURE, 100 %
AGGREGATES, GEOTECHNICAL, UTILITIES, RAILWAY NATIONAL TRANSPORTATION AGENCY, COMPLETE
PAVEMENT MARKINGS, SIGNING, TRAFFIC SIGNALS, ILLUMINATION, TRAFFIC ACCOMODATION, ETC. EXPECTED DATE
ACTUAL DATE
LIASE WITH REGION AND / OR TECHNICAL STANDARDS BRANCH
(STRUCTURAL & HYDROTECHNICAL DESIGN SECTION) ON BRIDGE STRUCTURES
DESIGN
50 %
75 % Infrastructure & Transportation
START COMPLETE COMPLETE
Date: Date: Date: PROJECT: _______________________
FROM: __________________________
TO: _____________________________
CONSULTANT: __________________
APPENDIX E
November 2011 E-2
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX F
November 2011
APPENDIX F
SURFACING CRITERIA
APPENDIX F
November 2011
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX F
November 2011 F-1
SURFACING DESIGN ESTIMATE
PREAMBLE A. WORK SHEET
The work sheet shall contain complete project descriptions and limits for all of the work proposed, and a work-up of the spread rates and application rates per km for each typical section, for each type and layer of material. Extra material required for levelling and minor intersections or approaches are indicated here. These rates are used in the calculation of quantities in the project estimates. This is also a valuable aid to the Consultant’s Representative in terms of material distribution management. Major intersection and roadside turnout quantities shall be calculated separately.
B. SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM
Prepare a graphic logistic layout of all of the major contract work components. It shows the limits of work segments and project limits for each project, expressed in kilometres. Show locations of all of the typical sections and respective limits where they occur. Special notes and details or conditions regarding bridges, curb and gutter, railway crossings, intersections, climbing lanes, and other special peculiarities are also shown here.
C. TYPICAL SECTIONS AND DETAILS
Show all of the typical sections. Each typical section shows the layers and thicknesses expressed in mm, widths expressed in m, as well as the ACP mix type, and asphalt binder grade to be used in the construction of each material layer. It also indicates the requirements of tack coat and/or spray coats where required. Cross-fall and side-slope gradients should be shown when necessary.
D. PROJECT ESTIMATES
Each project in the contract requires a separate complete comprehensive estimate of quantities and costs. Each estimate shall include the contract costs, contingency, and engineering.
E. BID ITEM SUMMARY
Prepare a summary of the total quantities from all of the project estimates for all of the bid items in the contract.
F. COST SUMMARY
Prepare a summary of all of the total costs from all of the projects for all of the bid items as well as the total estimated costs including contract costs, contingencies, and engineering.
G. SURFACING ESTIMATE SUMMARY
Compile a combined summary of quantities and costs used in the preparation of the “Unit Price Schedule” for the final tender documents.
APPENDIX F
November 2011 F-2
H. CONTRACT LOCATION MAP (KEY PLAN)
Prepare a map showing the geographic location, limits, townships, and ranges, plus the locations of all major intersections, bridge structures, vehicle turnouts, and passing/climbing lanes within the contract.
I. MATERIALS DISTRIBUTION SUMMARY
Prepare a distribution chart for the major haul related materials.
APPENDIX F
November 2011 F-3
SPREAD RATE GUIDELINES FOR FIRST COURSE GRAVEL SURFACING DESIGN The following chart has been developed to assist in the design of first course gravel surfacing quantities:
SUBGRADE WIDTH SPREAD RATE (m) (m3/km) 7.0 300
8.0 350
9.0 400
10.0 450
11.0 500
12.0 550
13.0 600
14.0 650
15.0 700
16.0 750
17.0 800
18.0 850
The spread rates provided apply to general application only. The condition of the subgrade may affect the actual gravel requirements. Alberta Transportation Technical Standards Branch Surface Engineering and Aggregates Section
APPENDIX F
November 2011 F-4
GUIDELINES FOR SELECTING TYPE OF SEAL COAT ON A PAVED SURFACE
Once a project has been selected and approved for seal coat application on a paved surface the traffic volume determines the seal coat type and aggregate materials as shown in the following table:
Traffic Volume
Seal Coat
Specification for Aggregate (see Specification 3.2 Table 3.2.3.1)
A.A.D.T. Type Designation Class
> 10,000 Chip Seal 3 12.5 AW 800 – 10,000 Chip Seal 3 12.5 BW
< 800 Graded Aggregate Seal
3 12.5 C
< 500 Double Seal Coat ¹ 3 16 (both applications)
Note ¹: Not regularly used by the Department. Double Seal Coat is applied on a granular base
in lieu of an asphalt pavement. Applications to be determined after consultation with Technical Standards Branch
APPENDIX F
November 2011 F-5
ALBERTA Transportation Technical Standards Branch
Date: Aug 31, 2011
SURFACING ESTIMATE WORKSHEET File: Hwy. 41:08 Designed by: D.C. Hwy. 545:02 Reviewed by: M.J. A.R. 154
ASPHALT CONCRETE PAVEMENT - EPS
“Contractor’s Supply With Option”
Hwy. 41:08 From N. of Hilda Access to N. of Hwy 545 km 21.850 - km 39.229 = 17.379 km Hwy. 545:02 From Jct. Hwy 41:08 to Saskatchewan Border km 0.000 - km 6.511 = 6.511 km A.R. 154 From Jct. Hwy 41:08 to E. of Hilda km 0.000 - km 5.124 = 5.124 km
SUBGRADE EXCAVATION 500 m3 Total
GRANULAR FILL Backfill: Pit - Run Des. 6 - 125 650 t Total Backfill: Crushed Des. 2 - 25 650 t Total
ASPHALT CONCRETE PAVEMENT - EPS Typ. ‘A’ Mix type M1/200-300A Roadway 1,300 Minor Ints. 50 Extras 50 Total (t/km) 1,400
ASPHALT CONCRETE PAVEMENT - EPS Typ. ‘B’ Typ. ‘C’
Mix Type L1/200-300A Roadway 1,650 850 Minor Ints. 100 50 Extras 200 150 Total (t/km) 1,950 1,050
ASPHALT CONCRETE PAVEMENT - EPS Typ. ‘A’ Mix Type S1/200-300A Roadway 550 Preliminary levelling 200 Total (t/km) 750
SCHEDULE, NOTE OR SPECIAL PROVISIONS (See Attached)
APPENDIX F
November 2011 F-6
ALBERTA Transportation Technical Standards Branch
Date: Aug 31, 2011
SURFACING ESTIMATE WORKSHEET File: Hwy. 41:08 Designed by: D.C. Hwy. 545:02 Reviewed by: M.J. A.R. 154
SCHEMATIC
TYP 'B'
TYP 'C'
SH 545:02
AR 154
HWY 41:08
21.850 N OF HILDA ACCESS
39.229km 37.602 (HWY 41:08)
Truck Turn-out Lt.
km 18.155 (HWY 41:08)
km 0.000 (AR 154)
ACP BY CONTRACT
22.220
NO WORK REQUIRED
INT 378
INT 381
Saskatchew
anBorder
HILDA
5.124
HWY. 41
TYP “A”
CB6-2.3M34B
km 0.000 (SH 545:02)
N OF JCT SH 545
6.511
APPENDIX F
November 2011 F-7
ALBERTA Transportation Technical Standards Branch
Date: Aug 31, 2011
SURFACING ESTIMATE WORKSHEET File: Hwy. 41:08 Designed by: D.C. Hwy. 545:02 Reviewed by: M.J. A.R. 154
TYPICALS
APPENDIX F
November 2011 F-8
ALBERTA Transportation Technical Standards Branch
Date: Aug 31, 2011
SURFACING ESTIMATE WORKSHEET File: Hwy. 41:08 Designed by: D.C. Hwy. 545:02 Reviewed by: M.J. A.R. 154
ASPHALT CONCRETE PAVEMENT - EPS
“Contractor’s Supply With Option”
PROJECT: Hwy. 41:08 LOCATION N. of Hilda Access - N. of Jct Hwy. 545 km 21.850 - km 39.229 = 17.379 km
SUBGRADE EXCAVATION allow 400 m3 Subgrade Excavation : 400 m3 X 16.80 $/m3 = $6,720 GRANULAR FILL (Pit- Run) Des. 6 - 125 Backfill : 200 m3 X 2.33 t/m3= 470 t
470 t Granular Fill Des. 6: 500 t X 20.00 $/t = $10,000 GRANULAR FILL Des. 2-25 Backfill : 200 m3 X 2.33 t/m3= 470 t
470 t Granular Fill Des. 2 : 500 t X 33.00 $/t = $16,500
ASPHALT CONCRETE PAVEMENT End Product Spec. Mix Type M1/200-300A ‘A’ km 21.850 to km 39.229 = 17.379 km X 1,400 t/km = 24,330 t CB6-2.3M34B : [ 1600 m2 + ( 350 m X 0.125 m ) ] X 0.050 m X 2.33 t/m3 + 10% = 210 t Int. 381 : [ 2200 m2 + ( 500 m X 0.125 m ) ] X 0.050 m X 2.33 t/m3 + 10% = 290 t 24,830 t
Asphalt Concrete Pavement - E.P.S. Mix Type M1/200-300A: 24,900 t X 65.00 $/t = $1,618,500 ASPHALT CONCRETE PAVEMENT End Product Spec. Mix Type S1/200-300A ‘A’ km 21.850 to km 39.229 = 17.379 km X 750 t/km = 13,040 t CB6-2.3M34B : [ 1600 m2 + ( 350 m X 0.300 m ) ] X 0.020 m X 2.33 t/m3 + 10% = 90 t Int. 381 : [ 2200 m2 + ( 500 m X 0.300 m ) ] X 0.020 m X 2.33 t/m3 + 10% = 120 t 13,250 t
Asphalt Concrete Pavement - E.P.S. Mix Type S1/200-300A: 13,300 t X 70.00 $/t = $931,000 ROADWAY LINES - Supplying Paint & Painting Directional Dividing + 2 Edge ‘A’ km 21.850 to km 39.229 = 17.379 km 17.379 km Roadway Lines - Supplying Paint & Painting Directional Dividing + 2 Edge : 17.38 km X 715.00 $/km = $12,427 ROADWAY LINES - Supplying Paint & Painting Lane Dividing Lines – Turnout km 22.060 to km 22.380 = 0.320 km 0.320 km Roadway Lines - Supplying Paint & Painting Lane Dividing Lines - Turnout : 0.32 km X 501.00 $/km = $161
APPENDIX F
November 2011 F-9
INTERSECTION LINES - Supplying Paint & Painting All Lines Int # 381 Intersection Lines – Supplying Paint & Painting All Lines : 1 unit X 251.00 $/unit = $251 SUPPLY OF AGGREGATE - WITH OPTION Granular Fill : 1,000 t ACP : 38,200 t
TOTAL : 39,200 t Supply of Aggregate - With Option : 39,200 t X 2.50 $/t = $98,000 MOBILIZATION (10 %) $269,356
SUB-TOTAL $2,962,915
CONSTRUCTION COST $2,963,000
CONTINGENCY (5 %) $148,150
ENGINEERING (10%) $311,115
TOTAL ESTIMATED COST $3,422,000
(to nearest $1000)
APPENDIX F
November 2011 F-10
ALBERTA Transportation Technical Standards Branch
Date: Aug 31, 2011
SURFACING ESTIMATE WORKSHEET File: Hwy. 41:08 Designed by: D.C. Hwy. 545:02 Reviewed by: M.J. A.R. 154
ASPHALT CONCRETE PAVEMENT – EPS
“Contractor’s Supply With Option”
PROJECT: Hwy. 545:02 LOCATION: From Jct. Hwy. 41:08 to Saskatchewan Border km 0.000 - km 6.511 = 6.511
SUBGRADE EXCAVATION
allow 100 m3
Subgrade Excavation : 100 m3 X 16.80 $/m
3 = ---------- $1,680
GRANULAR FILL (Pit-Run) Des. 6 - 125 Backfill : 50 m
3 X 2.33 t/m
3 = 120 t
120 t Gran. Fill Des. 6: 150 t X 20.00 $/t = ------------------------ $3,000 GRANULAR FILL Des. 2 - 25 Backfill : 50 m
3 X 2.33 t/m
3 = 120 t
120 t Gran. Fill Des. 2: 150 t X33.00 $/t = ------------------------ $4,950 ASPHALT CONCRETE PAVEMENT End Product Spec. Mix Type L1/200-300A ‘B’ km 0.000 to km 6.511 = 6.511 X 1,950 t/km = 12,700 t 12,700 t Asphalt Concrete Pavement - E.P.S. Mix Type L1/200-300A : 12,700 t X 68.00 $/t = ----------------------- $863,600 ROADWAY LINES - Supplying Paint & Painting Directional Dividing + 2 Edge ‘B’ km 0.000 to km 6.511 = 6.511 km 6.511 km Roadway Lines - Supplying Paint & Painting Directional Dividing + 2 Edge 6.51 km X 715.00 $/km = $4,655 SUPPLY OF AGGREGATE - WITH OPTION Granular Fill : 300 t ACP : 12,700 t TOTAL : 13,000 t Supply of Aggregate - With Option : 13,000 t X 2.50 $/t = ------------------------------------------------------------- $32,500 MOBILIZATION (10 %) $91,039 SUB-TOTAL $1,001,424 CONSTRUCTION COST $1,002,000 CONTINGENCY (5 %) $50,100 ENGINEERING (10 %) $105,210 TOTAL ESTIMATED COST $1,157,000 (to nearest $1000)
APPENDIX F
November 2011 F-11
ALBERTA Transportation Technical Standards Branch
Date: Aug 31, 2011
SURFACING ESTIMATE WORKSHEET File: Hwy. 41:08 Designed by: D.C. Hwy. 545:02 Reviewed by: M.J. A.R. 154
ASPHALT CONCRETE PAVEMENT – EPS
“Contractor’s Supply With Option”
PROJECT: A.R. 154 LOCATION: From Jct. Hwy. 41:08 to E. of Hilda km 0.000 - km 5.124 = 5.124 km
ASPHALT CONCRETE PAVEMENT End Product Spec. Mix Type L1/200-300A ‘C’ km 0.000 to km 5.124 = 5.124 km X 1,050 t/km = 5,380 t 5,380 t Asphalt Concrete Pavement - E.P.S. Mix Type L1/200-300A: 5,400 t X 68.00 $/t = ------- $367,200 ROADWAY LINES - Supplying Paint & Painting Directional Dividing + 2 Edge ‘C’ km 0.030 to km 5.124 = 5.09
km
5.09 km Roadway Lines – Supplying Paint & Painting Directional Dividing + 2 Edge: 5.09 km X 715.00 $/km = ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- $3,640 SUPPLY OF AGGREGATE - WITH OPTION ACP : 5,400 t TOTAL : 5,400 t Supply of Aggregate - With Option : 5,400 t X 2.50 $/t = --------------------------------------------- $13,500 MOBILIZATION (10%) $38,434 SUB-TOTAL $422,774 CONSTRUCTION COST $423,000 CONTINGENCY (5%) $21,150 ENGINEERING (10%) $44,415 TOTAL ESTIMATED COST $489,000 (to nearest $1000)
APPENDIX F
November 2011 F-12
ALBERTA Transportation Technical Standards Branch
Date: Aug 31, 2011
SURFACING ESTIMATE WORKSHEET File: Hwy. 41:08 Designed by: D.C. Hwy. 545:02 Reviewed by: M.J. A.R. 154
BID ITEM SUMMARY
DESCRIPTION Hwy. 41:08 Hwy. 545:02 A.R. 154 TOTAL UNITS
Mobilization $269,356 $91,039 $38,434 $398,829 Lump Sum $
Supply of Aggregate - With Option 39,200 13,000 5,400 57,600 t
Subgrade Excavation 400 100 500 m
3
Granular Fill (Pit-Run) Des. 6 - 125 500 150 650 t
Granular Fill Des. 2 - 25 500 150 650 t
Asphalt Concrete Pavement - E.P.S.
Mix Type L1/200-300A 12,700 5,400 18,100 t
Asphalt Concrete Pavement - E.P.S.
Mix Type M1/200-300A 24,900 24,900 t
Asphalt Concrete Pavement - E.P.S.
Mix Type S1/200-300A 13,300 13,300 t
Roadway Lines - Supplying Paint & Painting Directional Dividing +
2 Edge
17.38
6.51
5.09
28.98
km
Roadway Lines - Supplying Paint & Painting Lane Dividing Lines -
Turnout
0.32
0.32
km
Intersection Lines - Supplying Paint & Painting All Lines
1 1 unit
MATERIAL SUMMARY
DESCRIPTION Hwy. 41:08 Hwy. 545:02 A.R. 154 TOTAL UNITS
UNIT PRICE TO BE PROVIDED BY THE REGIONAL AGGREGATE COORDINATOR FOR ALL OPTION SOURCES AND TO BE INSERTED INTO THE UNIT PRICE SCHEDULE BY THE PRIME CONSULTANT
i.e. 57,600t @ $2.50/t = $144,000
APPENDIX F
November 2011 F-13
ALBERTA Transportation Technical Standards Branch
Date: Aug 31, 2011
SURFACING ESTIMATE WORKSHEET File: Hwy. 41:08 Designed by: D.C. Hwy. 545:02 Reviewed by: M.J. A.R. 154
COST SUMMARY
DESCRIPTION Hwy. 41:08 Hwy. 545:02 A.R. 154 TOTAL
Mobilization $269,356 $91,039 $38,434 $398,829 Supply of Aggregate - With Option $98,000 $32,500 $13,500 $144,000 Subgrade Excavation $6,720 $1,680 $8,400 Granular Fill (Pit-Run) Des. 6 - 125 $10,000 $3,000 $13,000 Granular Fill Des. 2 - 25 $16,500 $4,950 $21,450 Asphalt Concrete Pavement - E.P.S. Mix Type L1/200-300A
$863,600 $367,200 $1,230,800
Asphalt Concrete Pavement - E.P.S. Mix Type M1/200-300A
$1,618,500 $1,618,500
Asphalt Concrete Pavement - E.P.S. Mix Type S1/200-300A
$931,000 $931,000
Roadway Lines - Supplying Paint & Painting Directional Dividing + 2 Edge
$12,427 $4,655 $3,640 $20,722
Roadway Lines - Supplying Paint & Painting Lane Dividing Lines - Turnout
$161 $161
Intersection Lines - Supplying Paint & Painting All Lines
$251 $251
SUB-TOTAL $2,962,915 $1,001,424 $422,774 $4,387,113 CONSTRUCTION COST (rounded) $2,963,000 $1,002,000 $423,000 $4,388,000 CONTINGENCY (5%) $148,150 $50,100 $21,150 $219,400 ENGINEERING (10%) $311,115 $105,210 $44,415 $460,740
TOTAL ESTIMATED COST (rounded) $3,422,000 $1,157,000 $489,000 $5,068,000
APPENDIX F
November 2011 F-14
ALBERTA Transportation Technical Standards Branch
SURFACING ESTIMATE SUMMARY
Project: Hwy. 41:08 From km: 21.850 To km: 39.229 Project: Hwy. 545:02 From km: 0.000 To km: 6.511 Project: A.R. 154 From km: 0.000 To km: 5.124
PMB Bid Item Unit Estimated Unit Estimated Spec Remarks Code
# Decription Quantity Price Cost Nos. (Plan No.)
X100 Mobilization Lump 1 Lump $398,829 1.2 A800 Supply of Aggregrate – With
Option t 57,600 $2.50 $144,000 3.2 &
S.P.
B100 Subgrade Excavation m3 500 $16.80 $8,400 3.1
B152 Granular Fill (Pit-Run) Des. 6 - 125
t 650 $20.00 $13,000 3.8
B153 Granular Fill Des. 2 - 25 t 650 $33.00 $21,450 3.8 Q992 Asphalt Concrete Pavement -
EPS (Mix Type M1/200-300A) t 24,900 $65.00 $1,618,500 3.50
Q993 Asphalt Concrete Pavement - EPS (Mix Type L1/200-300A)
t 18,100 $68.00 $1,230,800 3.50
Q994 Asphalt Concrete Pavement - EPS (Mix Type S1/200-300A)
t 13,300 $70.00 $931,000 3.50
S350 Roadway Lines – Directional and 2 Edge Lines
km 28.98 $715.00 $20,722 7.2
S355 Roadway Lines - Lane Dividing Line - Turnout
km 0.32 $501.00 $161 7.2
S360 Roadway Lines – Intersection Lines
Unit 1 $251.00 $251 7.2 Int. 381
Total $4,387,113
Total Estimated Contract Cost (rounded) $4,388,000 Contingencies @ 5% $219,400 Total Estimated Contract Cost +
Contingencies $4,607,400
Engineering @ 10% $460,740 Total Estimated Cost (rounded) $5,068,000
Prepared By: R.G. Date: Aug/31/11 Checked By: M.J. Date: Aug/31/11
APPENDIX F
November 2011 F-15
Note: New logo needed. Who is responsible for this?
APPENDIX F
November 2011 F-16
Materials Distribution Summary
ACP ACP ACP PROJECT DESCRIPTION Type M1/200-300A Type L1/150-200A Type S1/200-300A (tonnes) (tonnes) (tonnes)
HWY. 41:08 N. of Hilda Access to 24,900 13,300 N. of Jct Hwy 545
HWY. 545:02 Jct Hwy. 41 to 12,700 Saskatchewan Border
A.R. 154 Jct Hwy. 41 to 5,400 Hilda
TOTALS 24,900 18,100 13,300
ALBERTA Transportation
Region Dwn. By: Checked By: Contract Plan for Contract No. xxxx/xx
Technical Standards Branch Southern
MATERIALS DISTRIBUTION SUMMARY
Surface Engineering & Aggregates Section
x Plan No. xxx:xx-xx (x of x)
APPENDIX G
November 2011
APPENDIX G
SUPPLY OF AGGREGATE
APPENDIX G
November 2011
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX G
November 2011 G-1
The following is a brief description of the forms and their purpose. Examples follow in the same order as listed. AGGREGATE DATA SUMMARY REQUEST Use this form to formally request an aggregate source for all projects. It will be returned with the information necessary to complete the special provisions for the contract. This new form replaces both the Aggregate Data Summary (MT-2-12/90) and Aggregate Source Data Sheet (MAT2-11/90). PIT PLAN Use this plan to show the proposed pit operations such as areas to be cleared and mined, stockpile and plant sites, areas to be backfilled or reclaimed. It may not be necessary to repeat in the special provisions what is clearly shown on the plan. The plan may require a draft update prior to including it in the tender document. AGGREGATE TESTING PLAN This plan shows the test holes, open pit and other surface features. The proposed pit operations should not be shown here. An additional plan, sufficiently enlarged to ensure the text is legible, shall be included for the portion of the plan where mining is to occur. The plan may require updating before it can be included in the tender document. SIEVE ANALYSIS These correspond to the test holes on the Aggregate Testing Plan. These sheets will be included in the tender documents.
APPENDIX G
November 2011 G-2
APPENDIX G
November 2011 G-3
APPENDIX G
November 2011 G-4
APPENDIX G
November 2011 G-5
ENLARGED AGGREGATE TESTING PLAN (AREA TO BE MINED)
APPENDIX G
November 2011 G-6
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX H
November 2011
APPENDIX H UTILITY ADJUSTMENT AGREEMENTS
(SAMPLES)
APPENDIX H
November 2011
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-1
This appendix contains sample agreements that have been used by Alberta Transportation (AT) to arrange for adjustments to utilities which are generally required due to highway upgrading or new construction. A letter format is normally used for agreements with utility companies. All agreements should be sent under AT letterhead except letter of Notification, Requesting for Cost Estimate and Confirmation of Commencement of Construction which can be sent out under the Consultant’s company letterhead. For pipeline, one of three standard "pipeline crossing agreements" is used. The first type (sample 5 or sample 6) is used for upgrading of existing roadways or twinning. The second type (sample 7) is used for "new construction" projects. Samples of each type of agreement follow:
Sample 1 Letter of Notification Sample 2 Letter Requesting for Cost Estimate Sample 3 Letter of Confirmation of Cost Estimate and Signing Agreements
(Telecommunication and Power company) Sample 4 Letter of Confirmation of Cost Estimate and Signing Agreements
(Pipeline Company) Sample 5 Roadway Upgrading Pipeline Crossing Agreement (Pipeline
Adjustment is required) Sample 6 Roadway Upgrading Pipeline Crossing Agreement (Pipeline
Adjustment is not required) Sample 7 New Roadway over Existing Pipeline Crossing Agreement Sample 8 Letter of Confirmation of Cost Estimate (New Railway Crossing) Sample 9 Letter of Confirmation of Cost Estimate (Existing Railway Crossing
Upgrading) Sample 10 Letter of Confirmation of Commencement of Construction Sample 11 Utility agreement with ATCO Electric Ltd. Sample 12 Roadway Upgrading Pipeline Crossing Agreement with ATCO
Pipeline Ltd. or ATCO Gas Ltd. (with or without Pipeline Adjustment is required)
Note:
1. Agreements for payment of utility adjustment costs are sometimes documented separately from the "Utility Adjustment Agreement".
2. In the case of sample 5 is used, sample 4 should also be used and included to form part of the agreement to address the issue of pipeline adjustment costs.
3. In the case of sample 11 is used, the copy of the letter for the Master Agreement in regarding prime contractor obligations signed by ATCO Electric and AT on May 11, 2006 should be appended to form as part of the agreement document.
4. In the case of Sample 12 is used, sample 4 should be used and included as part
of the agreement to address the issue of pipeline adjustment costs.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-2
In addition, the copy of the letter for the Master Agreement regarding prime contractor obligations signed by ATCO Pipeline Ltd or ATCO Gas Ltd and AT signed on June 8, 2006 and May 23, 2006 respectively should be appended to form as part of the agreement document.
5. Sample letters 3 and 11 must not be used as they stand to accept utility proposals for the installation of power supply services. These services must be quoted by the utility as fixed price contributions. The noted sample letters may be used if they are re-formatted to exclude all references to cost adjustments and adjustment mechanisms and if approved fixed-cost is stated as such in the first paragraph.
6. The Operations Manager needs to be informed or provided a written notice when there are implications on the operating/maintenance costs.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-3
SAMPLE 1
Our File: Hwy. XX:XX Utility Agreement No. XXXX
Phone: (403) XXX-XXXX Fax: (403) XXX-XXXX
Month XX, 20XX Attention: Mr. Name Utility Company Ltd. Address City, Alberta X2X 3X5 Dear: RE: Hwy. XX:XX, Jct. Hwy. XX to South of Town Grade Widening, Selective Gradeline Revision, Granular Base Course Asphalt Concrete Pavement & Other Work We are working as Engineering Consultants on behalf of Alberta Transportation for the above noted project. The project involves highway widening for 16.7 kilometres, commencing at the Junction of Hwy. XX to South of Town. The existing right-of-way width is presently xx metres and it is proposed to widen by an additional xx metres on each side. We have identified five (5) pipeline crossings by your company within the limits of this project, as highlighted on the enclosed plans. Your facilities may be impacted by the proposed construction. Please confirm the location of all facilities owned by your company that are within the project limits and provide us with a copy of your as-built records. We request that you forward the names of the contact persons from your company for utility exposures and design coordination at this time. Alberta Transportation has tentatively scheduled a September xxxx tender for this project. Construction is anticipated to commence in the spring of xxxx. If you require any further information or have any questions or concerns, please contact this office directly. Yours truly, Name, Consultant’s Title Company Name Encl. cc: Alberta Transportation - Project Sponsor
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-4
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-5
SAMPLE 2
Our File: X:XX Utility Agreement No. XXXX
Phone: (403) XXX-XXXX Fax: (403) XXX-XXXX
Month XX, 20XX Canadian Western Natural Gas Company Ltd. c/o Mr. John Jones Supervisor Pipelines 909 - 11th Avenue N.E. Calgary, Alberta T5R 1L8 Dear: RE: HWY. X:XX; W. OF JCT. S.H. XXX - JCT. HWY. X
Pipeline Plans; 1:02-61 & 1:02-62 The enclosed four prints each of the above noted plans showing the affect our construction will have on your Company's pipelines. The impacted locations and suggestions are listed below: Station 306+554.969 Plan No. 1:02-62 No adjustments proposed S.E. Ramp Station 201+113.867 Plan No. 1:02-61 Lower pipeline to provide
1.4 minimum earth cover at the lowest design ditch elevation
Benchlands Connectors & Install pipeline warning signs as required Station 300+393.008 on Ramp Your concurrence or alternate suggestion will be appreciated. Please submit a detailed estimate and breakdown of all costs (labour, materials, equipment, administration, etc.) for alternate suggestions, to the Consultant’s office for approval. Should you require any information please contact the Consultant’s Representative, Mr. John Smith of ABC Engineering Ltd. at (403) XXX-XXXX in Calgary. Please acknowledge receipt of the above information by signing both letters and also returning one for our file.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-6
Sincerely,
______________________________ Name, Consultant’s Title Company Name ______________________________ Authorized Representative of CWNG ______________________________ Date cc: Signed Copy to: Alberta Transportation – Project Sponsor
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-7
SAMPLE 3
Our File: Hwy. XX:X Utility Agreement No. XXXX
Phone: (403) XXX-XXXX Fax: (403) XXX-XXXX
Month XX, 20XX Fortis Alberta Ltd. Deerfoot Atrium, Box 1900 Calgary, Alberta T6B 2X3 ATTENTION: Mr. John Jones
X & X Projects - Calgary Region
Dear: RE: HWY. XX:XX, W. OF JCT. S.H. XXX - JCT. HWY X
UTILITY ADJUSTMENT COST ESTIMATE ($11,111.00) Please be advised that Alberta Transportation (AT) acknowledges receipt of your cost estimate of $11,111.00 for the above noted project. AT agrees to reimburse Fortis Alberta Ltd. based on actual close-out costs. This letter constitutes AT approval for Fortis Alberta Ltd. to proceed with the proposed powerline adjustments. If there is a variation of more than 5% or $10,000 whichever is greater from the original cost estimate, Fortis Alberta Ltd. must contact the Consultant immediately and obtain Department approval for the additional cost BEFORE proceeding with the work. OCCUPATIONAL HEALTH AND SAFETY ACT Alberta Transportation (the Department) assigns prime contractor responsibilities, as specified in the Occupational Health and Safety Act, to all parties with which it enters into contracts and agreements. On highway and bridge construction or maintenance projects this would typically include a Contractor, a Consultant (the Department employs an engineering consultant on construction projects only) and various Utility Companies. During the course of the project, the work sites of the Contractor, Consultant and Utility Company may be separated by time and/or space or, may be in the same general vicinity or may be adjacent, depending on the circumstances on the project at any given point in time. It is a requirement of all Department contracts and agreements that the Contractor, Consultant and Utility Companies working within the project limits, coordinate their respective activities, as outlined herein, to ensure a safe project. However, it is not the Department's intent that any of these parties be responsible to ensure that the other parties, or the other parties' subcontractors, have adequate health and safety process for their respective activities.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-8
Designation of Prime Contractor The Utility Company shall familiarize itself, it’s staff and it’s subcontractors with the terms of the Occupational Health and Safety Act and Regulations there under to ensure complete understanding respecting the responsibilities given and compliance required. The Utility Company acknowledges that it is and assumes all of the responsibilities and duties of the Prime Contractor, as defined by the Occupational Health and Safety Act, and that it shall as a condition of this Agreement, comply with the Occupational Health and Safety Act and the regulations there under.
Coordinating Activities The Utility Company shall coordinate its activities on the project with those of the Consultant and the Contractor. When the Consultant and/or Contractor are conducting activities within the project limits the Utility Company shall liaise with Consultant and/or Contractor as the case may be, and jointly develop a health and safety system or process for the affected worksites. The health and safety system or process agreed to by the parties must be in writing. Any changes required to the health and safety system must be agreed to by all affected parties and must also be in writing. Documenting the written health and safety system or process, including any required changes shall be the responsibility of the Contractor.
(i) Coordinating activities on Highway and Bridge Construction Projects For the purposes of coordinating activities on highway/bridge construction projects, the contact persons for the Contractor, Consultant and Utility Company shall be identified at the pre-construction meeting for the project. The responsibility to initiate "contact" for coordinating activities shall reside with the party entering a project or site on which work has commenced. This responsibility to initiate contact shall apply regardless of whether or not the worksites are separated by time and/or space, are in the same general vicinity or are adjacent. (ii) Coordinating activities not associated with a Highway or Bridge Construction Project
When the activities of the Utility Company are not being performed on a highway/bridge construction project, the Utility Company shall contact the local Albertan Transportation office prior to commencing work, to obtain the name of the contact person for the Department’s highway maintenance contractor. The responsibility to initiate "contact" for coordinating activities shall reside with the party entering a project or site on which work has commenced. This responsibility to initiate contact shall apply regardless of whether or not the worksites are separated by time and/or space, are in the same general vicinity or are adjacent.
Resolving Disputes Related to Coordination of Activities If the parties cannot agree on a process or system that addresses the safety concerns of all parties, work at the affected worksites shall cease and this matter shall be referred to the Consultant. However, if the Consultant is one of the parties involved in the dispute, or the Department has not employed a Consultant for the project, the matter shall be referred to the Department. The Consultant or Department as applicable, after review, will decide which party shall be responsible for resolving the disputed safety issue. Such decision shall be final and binding upon all parties.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-9
Responsibility for Subcontractors/Owner operators
The Prime Contractor shall, to the extent required by the Occupational Health and Safety Act, establish and maintain a Health and Safety system or process to ensure compliance to the Act by his subcontractors/owner operators. Fortis Alberta Ltd (or their Contractor) shall comply with the following:
• Contact John Smith of ABC Engineering Corp., Consultant’s Representative, at telephone number (403) XXX-XXXX in Calgary to co-ordinate work within the project limits.
• Provide the Consultant’s representative with the name and contact information of the utility person responsible for the work.
• Submit a traffic control plan and a written Traffic Accommodation Strategy to address for the safe accommodation of traffic as outlined in the current Traffic Accommodation in Work Zones Manual for Alberta Transportation’s review and comment.
• Desist from starting work until the TAS has been reviewed. • Notify the Consultant and Contractor(s) a minimum of 72 hours in advance of the proposed commencement or cessation of utility construction work.
• Maintain a copy of the TAS on site for the inspection by Alberta Transportation or their designated representative(s).
The final invoice for your work must be accompanied by back-up documentation and detailed cost breakdown sufficient and reasonable to support the actual close-out costs claimed. The breakdown of the estimate for the project should include the following:
• Direct labour costs • Contractor chargers • Materials • Salvage costs / credits • Subsidiary costs if any (e.g. easements, etc.) • Direct engineering • Overheads
Please forward the invoice and associated documentation to the Consultant’s office for reimbursement. Please sign all three letters; return one copy for our file and forward one copy to the Consultant. Sincerely, Name, Construction Manager Region Telephone Number ______________________________ _______________________________ Fortis Alberta Ltd. Authorized Representative Witness
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-10
______________________________ _______________________________ Date Date cc: Signed Copy to: Consultant Company’s Name Company’s Address
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-11
SAMPLE 4
Our File: Hwy. XX:XX Utility Agreement No. XXXX
Phone: (403) XXX-XXXX Fax: (403) XXX-XXXX
Month XX, 20XX XX Pipeline Ltd. Address Calgary, Alberta T6B 2X3 ATTENTION: Mr. Bob Jones
X & X Projects – Calgary Region Dear: RE: HWY. XX:XX, W. OF JCT. S.H. XXX – JCT. HWY X CONFIRMATION OF PIPELINE ADJUSTMENT COST ESTIMATE ($300,000) AND SIGNING
PIPELINE CROSSING AGREEMENT Please be advised that Alberta Transportation (AT) acknowledges receipt of your cost estimate of $300,000 for the above noted project. AT agrees to reimburse XX Pipeline Ltd. based on actual close-out costs. This letter constitutes AT approval for XX Pipeline Ltd. to proceed with the proposed pipeline adjustments. However, if there is a variation of more than 5% or $10,000 whichever is greater from the original cost estimate, XX Pipeline Ltd. must contact the Consultant immediately and obtain Department approval for additional costs before proceeding with the work. Three copies of our standard Pipeline Crossing Agreement are enclosed. Please indicate your acceptance by signing and returning one copy for our file and one to the Consultant’s office. You should forward your final invoice to the Consultant’s office with the necessary back-up documentation and detailed breakdown for reimbursement. Contact with John Smith of ABC Engineering Corp., Consultant’s Representative, at telephone number (403) XXX-XXXX in Calgary is recommended in order to co-ordinate work within the project limits. Sincerely, Name, Construction Manager Region Telephone Number Encl. Three cc: Signed Copy to: Consultant Company’s Name Company’s Address
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-12
SAMPLE 5
Our File: Hwy. X:XX Utility Agreement No. XXXX
ROADWAY UPGRADING PIPELINE CROSSING AGREEMENT
PIPELINE ADJUSTMENT IS REQUIRED
This agreement is made as of the XXth day of Month, A.D. 20XX
BETWEEN
Her Majesty the Queen in right of the Province of Alberta as represented by the Minister of Alberta Transportation
(hereinafter called the "Minister")
- and -
____________________________________________ a body corporate registered and existing under the laws of
the Province of Alberta (hereinafter called the "Operator")
WHEREAS the Minister intends to make improvements to a roadway known as Hwy. XXX:XX which may result in a ground disturbance within the controlled area (Alberta Pipeline Act) or Safety Zone (National Energy Board Act) of the Operator's pipelines in the land legally described as:
as shown on the attached Plan No.: ___________________, and adjustment costs as negotiated in a letter dated (sample 4 )_____________________ which form as part of this agreement. AND WHEREAS the Operator obtained a permit from the Minister for placement of a pipeline under Hwy. _______. NOW THEREFORE, pursuant to the applicable section of the Alberta Public Highways Development Act, the National Energy Board Act, Alberta Pipeline Act and Regulation the Water Gas and Electrical Companies Act, and the Gas Distribution Act (hereinafter called the "Acts"), the Minister and the Operator agree as follows: 1) The Operator's representative shall be:
(Name): _______________________________
Telephone Number): _______________________________
(Address): _______________________________
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-13
2) The Minister's representative shall be:
(Name): , Construction Manager
(Telephone Number): ( ) -
(Address): Alberta Transportation, ___________________ Region
3) The Minister (or his delegate) shall contact the Operator at least seventy-two (72) hours
(excluding Saturdays, Sundays and Statutory Holidays) prior to undertaking any excavation or construction within the controlled area as defined in the Pipeline Act, or Safety Zone as defined in the National Energy Board Act, as the case may be. The Operator, upon receiving such notice, shall make arrangements to have a representative present during the period machinery is to be used within the controlled area or safety zone, as the case may be, and to witness the exposure of the Operator's pipeline(s). No excavation or construction of any sort shall be carried out within the controlled area or safety zone, as the case may be, until the Operator's representative is present at the site and has authorized same, unless the Operator has advised otherwise by written notice to the Minister.
4) The Operator shall locate and mark the Operator's pipeline(s), perform inspections and
supervise a ground disturbance as required under Part 67 (Alberta Pipeline Regulation 91/2005) without charging any fee to the Minister undertaking the ground disturbances.
5) The Operator's pipeline shall be exposed under the direction of the Operator by hand
digging or other acceptable method such as excavation by water or air jets to determine the exact location and depth of cover (for the purpose of highway design) before construction is undertaken. The cost of this exposure shall be borne by the Minister.
6) In the event pipeline work is required and the Operator is authorized by the Minister to
carry out the work, the Operator shall carry out all necessary and permanent protection, adjustment or relocation of their pipeline(s) as required to accommodate the roadway construction.
OCCUPATIONAL HEALTH AND SAFETY ACT Alberta Transportation (the Department) assigns prime contractor responsibilities, as specified in the Occupational Health and Safety Act, to all parties with which it enters into contracts and agreements. On highway and bridge construction or maintenance projects this would typically include a Contractor, a Consultant (the Department employs an engineering consultant on construction projects only), various Utility Companies and the Operator (Pipeline Company). During the course of the project, the work sites of the Contractor, Consultant, Utility Companies and the Operator may be separated by time and/or space or, may be in the same general vicinity or may be adjacent, depending on the circumstances on the project at any given point in time. It is a requirement of all Department contracts and agreements that the Contractor, Consultant, Utility Companies and the Operator working within the project limits, coordinate their respective activities, as outlined herein, to ensure a safe project. However, it is not the Department's intent that any of these parties be responsible to ensure that the other parties, or the other parties' subcontractors, have adequate health and safety process for their respective activities.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-14
Designation of Prime Contractor
The Operator shall familiarize itself, it’s staff and it’s subcontractors with the terms of the Occupational Health and Safety Act and Regulations there under to ensure complete understanding respecting the responsibilities given and compliance required. The Operator acknowledges that it is and assumes all of the responsibilities and duties of the Prime Contractor, as defined by the Occupational Health and Safety Act, and that it shall as a condition of this Agreement, comply with the Occupational Health and Safety Act and the regulations there under.
Coordinating Activities The Operator shall coordinate its activities on the project with those of the Consultant and the Contractor. When the Consultant and/or Contractor and/or Utility Companies are conducting activities within the project limits the Operator shall liaise with the Consultant and/or Contractor and/or Utility Companies as the case may be, and jointly develop a health and safety system or process for the affected worksites. The health and safety system or process agreed to by the parties must be in writing. Any changes required to the health and safety system must be agreed to by all affected parties and must also be in writing. Documenting the written health and safety system or process, including any required changes shall be the responsibility of the Contractor.
(i) Coordinating activities on Highway and Bridge Construction Projects
For the purposes of coordinating activities on highway/bridge construction projects, the contact persons for the Contractor, Consultant, Utility Companies and the Operator shall be identified at the pre-construction meeting for the project. The responsibility to initiate "contact" for coordinating activities shall reside with the party entering a project or site on which work has commenced. This responsibility to initiate contact shall apply regardless of whether or not the worksites are separated by time and/or space, are in the same general vicinity or are adjacent.
(ii) Coordinating activities not associated with a Highway or Bridge Construction Project
When the activities of the Operator are not being performed on a highway/bridge construction project, the Operator shall contact the local Alberta Transportation office prior to commencing work, to obtain the name of the contact person for the Department’s highway maintenance contractor. The responsibility to initiate "contact" for coordinating activities shall reside with the party entering a project or site on which work has commenced. This responsibility to initiate contact shall apply regardless of whether or not the worksites are separated by time and/or space, are in the same general vicinity or are adjacent.
Resolving Disputes Related to Coordination of Activities If the parties cannot agree on a process or system that addresses the safety concerns of all parties, work at the affected worksites shall cease and this matter shall be referred to the Consultant. However, if the Consultant is one of the parties involved in the dispute, or the Department has not employed a Consultant for the project, the matter shall be referred to the Department.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-15
The Consultant or Department as applicable, after review, will decide which party shall be responsible for resolving the disputed safety issue. Such decision shall be final and binding upon all parties.
Responsibility for Subcontractors/Owner operators
The Prime Contractor shall, to the extent required by the Occupational Health and Safety Act, establish and maintain a Health and Safety system or process to ensure compliance to the Act by his subcontractors/owner operators.
7) If the pipeline work is of such a kind as to fall within the purview of the National Energy
Board Act and National Energy Board Pipeline Crossing Regulations, the Operator agrees to carry out the work in accord with the Canada Labour Code R.S.C. (as amended) and the Oil and Gas Occupational Safety and Health Regulations SOR/86-304 (as amended).
8) In the event that the Minister authorizes the pipeline work to be done by a person, either
legal or natural, other than the Operator, the Minister agrees to require that person to fulfill the responsibilities and duties of the Prime Contractor as that term is used in the Occupational Health and Safety Act, R.S.A 2000, as amended, and any regulations made pursuant to that Act. However, if the pipeline work is of such a kind as to fall within the purview of the National Energy Board Act, and the National Energy Board Pipeline Crossing Regulations, the Minister agrees to require the person to carry out the work in accordance with the Canada Labour Code R.S.C. (as amended) and the Oil and Gas Occupational Safety and Health Regulations SOR/86-304 (as amended).
9) The Minister shall carry out all work within the controlled area or safety zone, as the
case may be, in accordance with good engineering and construction practices, and in accordance with the relevant Acts.
10) The Minister shall ensure that no equipment, material or vehicles will be stored, parked
or driven over or along the controlled area or safety zone, as the case may be, except as reasonably necessary in the actual construction of the roadway.
11) If any excavation or construction equipment is to be moved across the controlled area or
safety zone, as the case may be, prior to excavation or construction, and as a temporary protective measure, the Operator may require direct protective measures in accordance with good engineering and construction practices, and in accordance with the relevant Acts, to be placed across the Operator's pipeline(s) at the point of crossing, the cost of which shall be borne by the Minister.
12) The Minister shall be liable for and shall indemnify and save harmless the Operator from
all manner of actions, causes of action, proceedings, claims, demands, costs, damages and expenses whatsoever including damage to the Operator's pipeline(s), which the Operator may sustain, pay or incur as a result of or in connection with any breach of the obligations assumed under this document by, or the negligence of, the Minister, his employees, servants or agents.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-16
13) The Operator shall be liable for and shall indemnify and save harmless the Minister from all manner of actions, causes of action, proceedings, claims, demands, costs, damages and expenses whatsoever including damage to the Minister's facilities which the Minister may sustain, pay or incur as a result of or in connection with any breach of the obligations assumed under this document by, or the negligence of, the Operator or any person for whom the Operator is responsible at law or in equity.
14) In the event the Operator is performing any work on its pipeline, the Operator (or their Contractor) shall comply with the following:
• Contact John Smith of ABC Engineering Corp., Consultant’s Representative, at telephone number (403) XXX-XXXX in Calgary to co-ordinate work within the project limits.
• Provide the Consultant’s representative with the name and contact information of the person responsible for the work.
• Submit a traffic control plan and a written Traffic Accommodation Strategy to address for the safe accommodation of traffic for Alberta Transportation's review and comment.
• Desist from starting work until the TAS has been reviewed. • Notify the Consultant and Contractor(s) a minimum of 72 hours in advance of the proposed commencement or cessation of utility construction work.
• Maintain a copy of the TAS on site for inspection by Alberta Transportation or their designated representative(s).
15) In the event the Minister is responsible for the whole/portion of the relocation/upgrade
cost, the Operator shall provide the following:
The final invoice for your work must be accompanied by back-up documentation and detailed cost breakdown sufficient and reasonable to support the actual close-out costs claimed. The breakdown of the estimate for the project should include the followings:
• Direct labour costs • Contractor charges • Materials • Salvage costs / credits • Subsidiary costs if any (e.g. easements, etc.) • Direct engineering • Overheads
Please forward the invoice and associated documentation to the Consultant’s office for reimbursement. Please sign all three copies; return one copy for our file and forward one copy to the Consultant.
16) Any written notice required or permitted hereunder shall be directed to the party to
whom it will be given (hand delivered, sent by prepaid mail, or sent by telecommunication), addressed as follows:
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-17
(a) To the Minister:
Alberta Transportation _____________________Region ________________________ ________________________
________________________
___________
ATTENTION: Name Construction Manager Region
(b) To the Operator:
________________________ ________________________
________________________
________________________
ATTENTION:
And in the event of mail service disruption, such notice shall be delivered by hand. 17) Where the terms and conditions in this document contradict any portion of the Acts, the
latter shall prevail. 18) The terms and conditions of this agreement shall be effective from the date shown at
the beginning of this agreement. Executed on behalf of the Executed on behalf of the Operator by: Minister by: ______________________________ ______________________________ Name Name Title Construction Manager Region
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-18
SAMPLE 6 Our File: Hwy. X:XX
Utility Agreement No. XXXX
ROADWAY UPGRADING PIPELINE CROSSING AGREEMENT
NO PIPELINE ADJUSTMENT IS REQUIRED
This agreement is made as of the XXth day of Month, A.D. 20XX
BETWEEN
Her Majesty the Queen in right of the Province of Alberta as represented by the Minister of Alberta Transportation
(hereinafter called the "Minister")
- and -
____________________________________________ a body corporate registered and existing under the laws of
the Province of Alberta (hereinafter called the "Operator")
WHEREAS the Minister intends to make improvements to a roadway known as Hwy. XXX:XX which may result in a ground disturbance within the controlled area (Alberta Pipeline Act) or Safety Zone (National Energy Board Act) of the Operator's pipelines in the land legally described as:
as shown on the attached Plan shown in schedule A. There is no pipeline adjustment is required. AND WHEREAS the Operator obtained a permit from the Minister for placement of a pipeline under Hwy. _______. NOW THEREFORE, pursuant to the applicable section of the Alberta Public Highways Development Act, the National Energy Board Act, Alberta Pipeline Act and Regulation the Water Gas and Electrical Companies Act, and the Gas Distribution Act (hereinafter called the "Acts"), the Minister and the Operator agree as follows: 1) The Operator's representative shall be:
(Name): _______________________________
Telephone Number): _______________________________
(Address): _______________________________
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-19
2) The Minister's representative shall be:
(Name): , Construction Manager
(Telephone Number): ( ) -
(Address): Alberta Transportation, ___________________ Region
3) The Minister (or his delegate) shall contact the Operator at least seventy-two (72) hours
(excluding Saturdays, Sundays and Statutory Holidays) prior to undertaking any excavation or construction within the controlled area as defined in the Pipeline Act, or Safety Zone as defined in the National Energy Board Act, as the case may be. The Operator, upon receiving such notice, shall make arrangements to have a representative present during the period machinery is to be used within the controlled area or safety zone, as the case may be, and to witness the exposure of the Operator's pipeline(s). No excavation or construction of any sort shall be carried out within the controlled area or safety zone, as the case may be, until the Operator's representative is present at the site and has authorized same, unless the Operator has advised otherwise by written notice to the Minister.
4) The Operator shall locate and mark the Operator's pipeline(s), perform inspections and
supervise a ground disturbance as required under Part 67 (Alberta Pipeline Regulation 91/2005) without charging any fee to the Minister undertaking the ground disturbances.
5) The Operator's pipeline shall be exposed under the direction of the Operator by hand
digging or other acceptable method such as excavation by water or air jets to determine the exact location and depth of cover (for the purpose of highway design) before construction is undertaken. The cost of this exposure shall be borne by the Minister.
6) In the event that the Minister authorizes the pipeline exposure work to be done by a
person, either legal or natural, other than the Operator, the Minister agrees to require that person to fulfill the responsibilities and duties of the Prime Contractor as that term is used in the Occupational Health and Safety Act, R.S.A 2000, as amended, and any regulations made pursuant to that Act. However, if the pipeline work is of such a kind as to fall within the purview of the National Energy Board Act, and the National Energy Board Pipeline Crossing Regulations, the Minister agrees to require the person to carry out the work in accordance with the Canada Labour Code R.S.C. (as amended) and the Oil and Gas Occupational Safety and Health Regulations SOR/86-304 (as amended).
7) The Minister shall carry out all work within the controlled area or safety zone, as the
case may be, in accordance with good engineering and construction practices, and in accordance with the relevant Acts.
8) The Minister shall ensure that no equipment, material or vehicles will be stored, parked
or driven over or along the controlled area or safety zone, as the case may be, except as reasonably necessary in the actual construction of the roadway.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-20
9) If any excavation or construction equipment is to be moved across the controlled area or safety zone, as the case may be, prior to excavation or construction, and as a temporary protective measure, the Operator may require direct protective measures in accordance with good engineering and construction practices, and in accordance with the relevant Acts, to be placed across the Operator's pipeline(s) at the point of crossing, the cost of which shall be borne by the Minister.
10) The Minister shall be liable for and shall indemnify and save harmless the Operator from
all manner of actions, causes of action, proceedings, claims, demands, costs, damages and expenses whatsoever including damage to the Operator's pipeline(s), which the Operator may sustain, pay or incur as a result of or in connection with any breach of the obligations assumed under this document by, or the negligence of, the Minister, his employees, servants or agents.
11) The Operator shall be liable for and shall indemnify and save harmless the Minister from
all manner of actions, causes of action, proceedings, claims, demands, costs, damages and expenses whatsoever including damage to the Minister's facilities which the Minister may sustain, pay or incur as a result of or in connection with any breach of the obligations assumed under this document by, or the negligence of, the Operator or any person for whom the Operator is responsible at law or in equity.
12) Any written notice required or permitted hereunder shall be directed to the party to whom it will be given (hand delivered, sent by prepaid mail, or sent by telecommunication), addressed as follows:
(a) To the Minister:
Alberta Transportation _____________________Region ________________________ ________________________
________________________
___________
ATTENTION: Name Construction Manager Region
(b) To the Operator:
________________________ ________________________
________________________
________________________
ATTENTION:
And in the event of mail service disruption, such notice shall be delivered by hand.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-21
13) Where the terms and conditions in this document contradict any portion of the Acts, the
latter shall prevail. 14) The terms and conditions of this agreement shall be effective from the date shown at
the beginning of this agreement.
Executed on behalf of the Executed on behalf of the Operator by: Minister by: ______________________________ ______________________________ Name Name Title Construction Manager Region
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-22
SAMPLE 7 Our File: Hwy. X:XX
Utility Agreement No. XXXX
New Roadway Over Existing Pipeline Crossing Agreement THIS AGREEMENT is made and effective as of the day of, 20 .
BETWEEN (”Grantor”) (hereinafter and in Schedules A, B & C referred to as the Grantor)
and Her Majesty the Queen in right of the Province of Alberta as represented by the
Minister of Alberta Transportation ("the Minister”) (hereinafter and in Schedules A, B & C referred to as the Minister)
WHEREAS Grantor operates under the jurisdiction of the National Energy Board, Alberta Energy and Utilities Board, or Alberta Energy, and holds permits, approvals, or authorizations for a pipeline across the said lands and has constructed a pipeline therein, hereinafter referred to as ”Grantor’s Facility”; and
WHEREAS the Minister desires to construct the Minister's Facility across the "Grantor's Facility" and has acquired an interest in the said lands and proposes to install therein a roadway (Hwy.__________) hereinafter referred to as "the Minister's Facility"; and
WHEREAS the lands and/or Facilities of the respective parties intersect in the Crossing Area; and
WHEREAS the parties wish to define their respective rights and liabilities with respect to the Crossing Area under certain terms and conditions defined in Schedule "A".
NOW THEREFORE THIS AGREEMENT WITNESSES that in consideration of the premises, mutual covenants and agreements herein contained, the parties agree that their respective
Work in the Crossing Area shall be governed by this Agreement together with the Schedules as
herein described.
1. Terms and Conditions
This Agreement including the recitals and the following Schedules, which are attached hereto and made part hereof, shall be the terms and conditions as agreed to by Grantor and the Minister:
Schedule ”A” - Mutually Agreed to Terms and Conditions.
Schedule ”B” - Location Plan and Profile.
Schedule ”C” - Specific Terms and Conditions. (the "Schedules")
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-23
2. LOCATION AND NOTICES
(a) Location of Crossing Area (Legal Description):
(b) Notices:
Grantor's Corporate Office Minister's Office
Name:
Address:
Dept.:
Phone
fax
(c) Field Representative:
Grantor's Minister's Representative
Name:
Position::
Address:
Phone:
Fax:
email:
Alternate:
Phone
Fax:
email:
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-24
IN WITNESS WHEREOF the parties hereto have caused this Agreement to be duly executed.
"Grantor" Executed on behalf of the Minister
Per: Name: Per: Title:
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-25
Schedule “A” Mutually Agreed to Terms and Conditions
This Schedule ”A” to Form Part of the New Roadway Over Existing Pipeline Crossing Agreement.
Between (Grantor)
and Her Majesty the Queen in right of the Province of Alberta as represented by the Minister of Alberta Transportation (the Minister)
and dated the day of , 20 .
1. Interpretation
1.01 In this Agreement, including the recitals, the words and terms used shall have the following meanings:
(a) "Crossing Area" means the area of intersection of Grantor’s rights of way and the Minister’s interest in the said lands and/or Facilities as outlined in Schedule ”B”;
(b) "Minister" means the Minister of Alberta Transportation or his delegate;
(c) ”Minister’s Facility” means the facility or facilities to be constructed by the Minister and to be located within, across, along, upon, over or under the Crossing Area;
(d) ”Grantor’s Facility” means the facility or facilities of Grantor located within, across, along, upon or under the Crossing Area;
(e) ”Facility” means:
i) any structure that is constructed or placed on or in the right-of-way within the Crossing Area (including but not limited to concrete slab, concrete conduit, retaining wall, and special fences such as chain link); and
ii) any highway, public or private road, railway, irrigation ditch, drain, drainage system, sewer, dike, cable line, telecommunication line, telephone line or line for the transmission of hydrocarbons, power or any other substance that is or is to be carried across, along, upon, over or under the Crossing Area;
(f) ”said lands” means the lands described in Schedule ”B”;
(g) ”the Body of this Agreement” means the Agreement to which this Schedule is attached and which has been executed by the parties;
(h) ”this Agreement” means the Body of this Agreement and the Schedules attached to it; and
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-26
(i) ”Work” means, with respect to a Facility, the carrying, laying, installing, constructing, maintaining, operating, repairing, inspecting, replacing, altering, removing, abandoning and such other operations as may be required from time to time.
1.02 Unless a term or provision contained in the Body of this Agreement, if acted upon, would result in violation of any code, statute, law, regulation, permit, license, or governmental order, the following shall apply:
(a) If any term or provision conflicts with a term or provision contained in any Schedule, the term or provision in the Schedule shall prevail.
(b) If any terms or provisions of the Schedules conflict, the following shall apply: Schedule ”C”, if present, shall prevail over Schedules ”A” and ”B”, Schedule ”B” shall prevail over Schedule ”A”.
2. Consent
Grantor hereby agrees, insofar as it has the right to do so, that the Minister may perform the Work on the Minister’s Facility in the Crossing Area in accordance with the terms and conditions of this Agreement.
3. Compliance with Statutes and Regulations
(a) The Minister shall at all times comply with any and all applicable codes, statutes, laws, regulations, permits, licenses, orders and directions of any Federal or Provincial governmental authority from time to time in force. The minimum applicable technical standards therein shall apply to both parties unless more stringent standards are provided for in this Agreement. If compliance with any provision of this Agreement would result in violation of any applicable codes, statutes, laws, regulations, permits, licenses, orders and directions of any Federal or Provincial governmental authority, such code, statute, law, regulation, permit, license, order and direction of any Federal or Provincial governmental authority shall prevail and this Agreement shall be deemed to be amended accordingly.
The Minister agrees to require any agent or contractor who performs work, as defined by this agreement, on behalf of the Minister to comply with the applicable provincial or federal legislation and regulations governing occupational health and safety.
(b) During the course of the project, the work sites of the Contractor, Consultant (the Department employs an engineering consultant on construction projects only), Utility Companies and the Grantor may be separated by time and/or space or, may be in the same general vicinity or may be adjacent, depending on the circumstances on the project at any given point in time. It is a requirement of all Department contracts and agreements that the Contractor, Consultant and Utility Companies working within the project limits, coordinate their respective activities, as outlined herein, to ensure a safe project. However, it is not the Department's intent that any of these parties be responsible to ensure that the other parties, or the other parties' subcontractors, have adequate health and safety process for their respective activities.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-27
Designation of Prime Contractor
The Grantor shall familiarize itself, it’s staff and it’s subcontractors with the terms of the Occupational Health and Safety Act and Regulations there under to ensure complete understanding respecting the responsibilities given and compliance required. The Grantor acknowledges that it is and assumes all of the responsibilities and duties of the Prime Contractor, as defined by the Occupational Health and Safety Act, and that it shall as a condition of this Agreement, comply with the Occupational Health and Safety Act and the regulations there under.
Coordinating Activities The Grantor shall coordinate its activities on the project with those of the Consultant and the Contractor. When the Consultant and/or Contractor and/or Utility Companies are conducting activities within the project limits the Grantor shall liaise with the Consultant and/or Contractor and/or Utility Companies as the case may be, and jointly develop a health and safety system or process for the affected worksites. The health and safety system or process agreed to by the parties must be in writing. Any changes required to the health and safety system must be agreed to by all affected parties and must also be in writing. Documenting the written health and safety system or process, including any required changes shall be the responsibility of the Contractor.
For the purposes of coordinating activities on highway/bridge construction projects, the contact persons for the Contractor, Consultant, Utilities Companies and the Grantor shall be identified at the pre-construction meeting for the project. The responsibility to initiate "contact" for coordinating activities shall reside with the party entering a project or site on which work has commenced. This responsibility to initiate contact shall apply regardless of whether or not the worksites are separated by time and/or space, are in the same general vicinity or are adjacent.
Resolving Disputes Related to Coordination of Activities If the parties cannot agree on a process or system that addresses the safety concerns of all parties, work at the affected worksites shall cease and this matter shall be resolved by all parties at the site.
Responsibility for Subcontractors/Owner operators The Prime Contractor shall, to the extent required by the Occupational Health and Safety Act, establish and maintain a Health and Safety system or process to ensure compliance to the Act by his subcontractors/owner operators.
4. Position of Facility
Unless otherwise indicated in any of the Schedules, or ordered by a Federal or Provincial governmental authority or regulations the Grantor’s Facility shall have the lower physical position in the Crossing Area;
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-28
5. Conditions
When the Minister performs work on the Minister’s Facility in the Crossing Area, the following terms and conditions shall apply:
(a) The Minister’s Field Representative shall contact Grantor’s Field Representative directly, either in person or by telephone, a minimum of 72 hours (excluding Saturdays, Sundays and Statutory Holidays) before commencement of the Minister’s Work within 30 meters of the Crossing Area and, if unable to contact that person, the Minister shall serve a minimum of 72 hours written notice pursuant to Clause 8 hereof before commencement of the Minister’s Work.
(b) Grantor has the right to have a representative present to inspect the Work of the Minister in the Crossing Area.
(c) During installation pursuant to this Agreement, the Minister's Representative shall have available at the Crossing Area a copy of this Agreement.
(d) (i) Before proceeding to excavate within 5 metres of the Crossing Area, the Minister shall require the Grantor to expose its Facility by hand digging or other acceptable method such as excavation by water or air jets. The Minister shall not use or permit the use of an excavating machine within 1.5 metres of either side of any existing Grantor’s Facility, or 3.0 metres of either side of any existing Grantor’s Facility as required under the National Energy Board Act and Regulation, as the case may be, unless otherwise agreed to in Schedule “C”.
(ii) The cost of the exposure referred to in (d)(i) above shall be borne by the Minister.
(e) Notwithstanding clause 5(d) above, the Grantor shall carry out any necessary
and permanent protection, adjustment, or relocation of the Grantor's facility that is made necessary by the construction of the Minister's Facility.
(f) The Minister shall, where applicable, install and maintain during performance of the Work suitable markers indicating the location of Grantor’s Facility in the Crossing Area.
(g) The Minister shall lay down and construct its Facility in accordance with the Schedules to this Agreement.
(h) The Minister shall carry out all Work in the Crossing Area in a proper and diligent manner and in accordance with good engineering and construction practices.
(i) The Minister shall ensure no damage occurs to existing Facilities while the Work is being performed in the Crossing Area including damage which may result from the use of heavy work equipment outside the Crossing Area while performing the Work in the Crossing Area.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-29
(j) In the event that Grantor’s Facility suffers contact damage or other damage as a result of the Minister’s Work, Grantor shall be notified forthwith and its repair shall be carried out as directed by Grantor at the Minister’s cost.
(k) Where cathodic protection is required to be modified by Grantor as a result of the Minister’s installation, the Grantor at its cost shall, at the time of the construction of the Minister's Facility, modify and thereafter maintain a cathodic protection system for Grantor’s Facility at the crossing. The Grantor shall provide a cost estimate of the installation of the cathodic protection system prior to construction of the Minister's Facility, and upon approval of all or a part of the costs of the installation of the cathodic protection system by the Minister, the Minister shall reimburse the Grantor in accordance with the attached Schedule ”C”.
(l) At least 24 hours (excluding Saturdays, Sundays and Statutory Holidays) prior to covering Grantor’s exposed Facility, the Minister’s Field Representative shall contact Grantor’s Field Representative directly, either in person or by telephone for inspection.
(m) (i) Where backfilling the excavation in the Crossing Area is required as a result of the Minister’s installation, the Grantor may elect to backfill in accordance with Standard Specifications for Highway Construction (Alberta Transportation, current edition). Upon such election, the Grantor at its cost shall, at the time of the construction of the Minister's Facility, backfill the Crossing Area. The Grantor shall provide a cost estimate to backfill the Crossing Area, and upon approval of all or a part of the costs to backfill the Crossing Area by the Minister, the Minister shall reimburse the Grantor in accordance with the attached Schedule ”C” .
(ii) In the event the Grantor elects not to backfill the Crossing Area, and unless otherwise directed by the Grantor, the Minister shall cover Grantor’s Facility with at least 30 centimetres of select backfill material as specified in Schedule "C" prior to commencing backfilling operations. The Minister shall, in backfilling the excavation in the Crossing Area, compact the fill material in 15 centimetre layers, or such greater depth specified by Grantor’s Field Representative.
(n) The Minister shall, as soon as it is reasonably practical after the completion of the Minister’s Work in the Crossing Area, restore the surface of the Crossing Area as closely as is practical to the condition in which it existed immediately prior to the Work being commenced.
(o) The Minister shall maintain the Crossing Area in good order and condition and carry out expeditiously all Work hereunder.
(p) The cost associated with the location, identification or supervision of the Grantor's facility shall not be charged to or borne by the Minister unless specified in Schedule "C".
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-30
6. Remedy on Default
In the case of default by the Minister in carrying out any of the provisions of this Agreement, Grantor may give notice thereof to the Minister. If the Minister fails to commence to remedy such default within 15 days after receipt of such notice and diligently complete such remedy thereafter, Grantor may take such steps as are appropriate to remedy such default and the Minister shall be liable for and shall pay all reasonable costs and expenses incurred by Grantor in remedying the default.
7. Further Work
(a) If, subsequent to the initial Work undertaken by the Minister for its Facility, the Minister desires to undertake any Work in the Crossing Area in respect of its Facility, this Agreement shall be deemed to grant consent to the Minister, and the provisions of this Agreement shall apply as the context requires to all subsequent Work undertaken by the Minister under this Clause 7.
(b) Notwithstanding the foregoing, installation of any Facility by the Minister other than those shown on attached Schedule ”B” shall require a separate New Roadway Over Existing Pipeline Crossing Agreement.
(c) Notwithstanding the foregoing, if emergency Work in the Crossing Area is required with respect to a party’s Facility, that party shall commence the necessary Work and shall forthwith give the other party’s Field Representative verbal notice of the emergency and necessary Work, and shall forthwith give notice pursuant to Clause 8 hereof.
8. Notices
Notices shall be in writing and shall be sent to the parties at the addresses for notice shown in the Body of this Agreement. The following shall govern notices:
(a) Either party may from time to time change its address for service by giving notice to the other party.
(b) All notices required to be given hereunder may be delivered by hand, mailed by registered or prepaid mail, or sent by telecommunication. If mailed, the notice shall be deemed to have been received seven days (Saturdays Sundays and Statutory Holidays excluded) after the mailing thereof. If delivered by hand, the notice shall be deemed to have been received on the day on which it was delivered, or if delivered after regular business hours, it shall be deemed to have been received on the following business day. If sent by telecommunication, the notice shall be deemed to have been received on the first business day following the day it was dispatched.
(c) No notice shall be effective if mailed during any period in which Canadian postal workers are on strike or if a strike of postal workers is imminent and may be anticipated to affect normal delivery thereof.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-31
(d) Notwithstanding the foregoing, to the extent described in this Agreement, Grantor’s and the Minister’s Field Representatives or designated alternates shall have the right and authority to make, give, receive any notice, information, direction or decision required in conducting Work hereunder.
9. Liability and Indemnity
(a) Liability:
(i) The Minister shall be liable to Grantor for all loss, damages and expenses which Grantor may suffer, sustain, pay or incur by reason of any matter or thing arising out of or attributable to any act or omission of the Minister, his servants, agents or employees in respect of the Minister’s use of the Crossing Area or by reason of this Agreement.
(ii) Grantor shall be liable to the Minister for all loss, damages, and expenses which the Minister may suffer, sustain, pay or incur by reason of any matter or thing arising out of or attributable to any act or omission by Grantor, its servants, agents or employees in respect of Grantor’s use of the Crossing Area or by reason of this Agreement.
(b) Indemnity:
(i) The Minister shall indemnify and save harmless the Grantor against all actions, proceedings, claims, demands, and costs which may be brought against or suffered by Grantor or which it may sustain, pay or incur, by reason of any matter or thing arising out of or attributable to any act or omission of the Minister, its servants, agents or employees in respect of the Minister’s use of the Crossing Area or by reason of this Agreement.
(ii) Grantor shall indemnify and save harmless the Minister against all actions, proceedings, claims, demands, and costs which may be brought against or suffered by the Minister or which it may sustain, pay or incur, by reason of any matter or thing arising out of or attributable to any act or omission of Grantor, its servants, agents or employees in respect of Grantor’s use of the Crossing Area or by reason of this Agreement.
10. Insurance
(a) Without in any way limiting the liability of either party under this Agreement, each party shall obtain and keep in force during the term of this Agreement comprehensive general liability insurance covering liability for bodily injury and property damage arising from Work contemplated by this Agreement. The limit of this insurance shall not be less than five million dollars, inclusive, for any one occurrence unless otherwise agreed by the parties in writing. This policy shall provide coverage for liability assumed under this Agreement.
(b) A party, upon request of the other party, shall furnish written documentation, satisfactory to the requesting party, evidencing the required coverage.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-32
(c) As an alternative to the five million dollar policy of comprehensive general liability insurance referred to in Sub-clause 10 (a), if acceptable to the other party, a party may self-insure against the risks normally covered by such a policy.
11. Changes to Agreement
No change, modification or alteration of this Agreement shall be valid unless it be in writing and signed by the parties hereto, and no course of dealing between the parties shall be construed to alter the terms hereof.
12. Assignment
(a) Neither party to this Agreement shall assign or transfer this Agreement or the rights and privileges hereby granted without the written consent of the other party, and such consent shall not be unreasonably withheld. The party intending to assign or transfer this Agreement shall give to the non- assigning party to this Agreement notice of its intent by registered mail.
(b) The non-assigning party to this Agreement may require the assignor and assignee to execute a novation agreement in a form acceptable to the non- assigning party.
This Agreement shall endure to the benefit of and be binding upon the parties, their successors and assigns.
13. Governing Law
This Agreement and the rights and obligations of the parties herein shall be governed and construed according to the laws of the province of Alberta.
14. Term
The rights and obligations of the parties under this Agreement shall terminate:
(a) two years from the date hereof if construction of the Minister’s Facility has not commenced, or
(b) upon proper abandonment or removal of all of Grantor’s or the Minister’s Facilities from the Crossing Area and the completion of any reclamation Work required by applicable laws, except for those rights acquired and obligations incurred prior to such events.
15. Miscellaneous
(a) In this Agreement, words importing the singular include the plural and vice versa; words importing the masculine gender include the feminine and vice versa; and words importing persons include firms or corporations and vice versa.
(b) Words such as ”hereto”, ”thereto”, ”hereof”, and ”herein”, when used in this Agreement, shall be construed to refer to provisions of this Agreement.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-33
(c) The headings of all clauses of this Agreement, and the Schedules, are inserted for convenience of reference only and shall not affect the meaning or construction thereof.
(d) Time is of the essence of this Agreement.
(e) No waiver of any breach of a covenant or provision of this Agreement shall take effect or be binding upon a party unless it is expressed in writing. A waiver by a party of any breach shall not limit or affect that party’s rights with respect to any other or future breach.
16. Entire Agreement
This Agreement, including the recitals and schedules, sets forth the entire agreement between the parties hereto and shall be deemed to have superseded any and all previous agreements and understandings, whether written or oral, between the parties dealing with the Facilities and the Crossing Area, and all rights and obligations as herein described.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-34
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-35
Schedule “B”
Location Plan and Profile
This Schedule ”B” to Form Part of the New Roadway Over Existing Pipeline Crossing Agreement. Between (Grantor)
and (the Minister)
and dated the day of , 20 .
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-36
This page left blank intentionally
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-37
Schedule “C” Specific Terms and Conditions
This Schedule "C" to Form Part of the New Roadway Over Existing Pipeline Crossing Agreement.
Between (Grantor)
and (the Minister)
and dated the day of , 20 .
NOTE: All invoices for the items listed below (if applicable) shall be directed to the Minister's Representative.
NOTE: Attach a copy of any existing permit, approval or authorization held by the Grantor as part of Schedule "C" here ((as per clause 1.02(b)).
NOTE: Permission to use an excavating machine within 1.5 metres of either side of any existing Grantor’s Facility as required under the Pipeline Act and Regulation, or 3.0 metres of either side of any existing Grantor’s Facility as required under the National Energy Board Act and Regulation, as the case may (if applicable) here ((as per clause 5(d)(i)).
NOTE: Attach a copy of the Grantor's cost estimate of the installation of the cathodic protection system (if any) here ((as per clause 5(k)).
NOTE: Attach a copy of the Grantor's cost estimate for backfilling the excavation in the Crossing Area (if any) here ((as per clause 5(m)(i))).
NOTE: Attach a copy of the Grantor's specification for backfill (if any) here ((as per clause 5(m)(ii)).
NOTE: Attach a copy of the cost associated with the location, identification or supervision of the Grantor's facility to be borne by the Minister (if applicable) here ((as per clause 5(p)).
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-38
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-39
SAMPLE 8 Our File: Hwy. XX:XX
Utility Agreement No. XXXX
Phone: (403)XXX-XXXX Fax: (403)XXX-XXXX
Month XX , 20XX Central Western Railway 1407 Scotland Street SW Calgary, Alberta T3C 3W3 ATTENTION: Technical Support Engineer Dear: RE: INTERSECTION HWY XX:XX NEW RAILWAY CROSSING AGREEMENT Please be advised that Alberta Transportation (AT) acknowledges receipt of your cost estimate of $163,400.00 for the above noted project. AT agrees to reimburse Central Western Railway based on actual close-out costs. This letter constitutes AT approval for Central Western Railway to proceed with the construction of the proposed new railway crossing. If there is a variation of more than 5% or $10,000 whichever is greater from the original cost estimate, Central Western Railway must contact the Consultant immediately and obtain approval for the additional cost before proceeding with the work. OCCUPATIONAL HEALTH AND SAFETY ACT Alberta Transportation (the Department) assigns prime contractor responsibilities, as specified in the Occupational Health and Safety Act, to all parties with which it enters into contracts and agreements. On highway and bridge construction or maintenance projects this would typically include a Contractor, a Consultant (the Department employs an engineering consultant on construction projects only), various Utility Companies and the Railway Company. During the course of the project, the work sites of the Contractor, Consultant, the Utility Companies and Railway Company may be separated by time and/or space or, may be in the same general vicinity or may be adjacent, depending on the circumstances on the project at any given point in time. It is a requirement of all Department contracts and agreements that the Contractor, Consultant, Utility Companies and Railway Company working within the project limits, coordinate their respective activities, as outlined herein, to ensure a safe project. However, it is not the Department's intent that any of these parties be responsible to ensure that the other parties, or the other parties' subcontractors, have adequate health and safety process for their respective activities.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-40
Designation of Prime Contractor The Railway Company shall familiarize itself, it’s staff and it’s subcontractors with the terms of the Occupational Health and Safety Act and Regulations there under to ensure complete understanding respecting the responsibilities given and compliance required. The Railway Company acknowledges that it is and assumes all of the responsibilities and duties of the Prime Contractor, as defined by the Occupational Health and Safety Act, and that it shall as a condition of this Agreement, comply with the Occupational Health and Safety Act and the regulations there under.
Coordinating Activities The Railway Company shall coordinate its activities on the project with those of the Consultant, the Contractor and the Utility Companies. When the Consultant and/or Contractor and/or Utility Companies are conducting activities within the project limits the Railway Company shall liaise with the Consultant and/or Contractor as the case may be, and jointly develop a health and safety system or process for the affected worksites. The health and safety system or process agreed to by the parties must be in writing. Any changes required to the health and safety system must be agreed to by all affected parties and must also be in writing. Documenting the written health and safety system or process, including any required changes shall be the responsibility of the Contractor.
(I) Coordinating activities on Highway and Bridge Construction Projects
For the purposes of coordinating activities on highway/bridge construction projects, the contact persons for the Contractor, Consultant, the Utility Companies and the Railway Company shall be identified at the pre-construction meeting for the project. The responsibility to initiate "contact" for coordinating activities shall reside with the party entering a project or site on which work has commenced. This responsibility to initiate contact shall apply regardless of whether or not the worksites are separated by time and/or space, are in the same general vicinity or are adjacent.
(ii) Coordinating activities not associated with a Highway or Bridge Construction Project
When the activities of the Railway Company are not being performed on a highway/bridge construction project, the Railway Company shall contact the local Alberta Transportation office prior to commencing work, to obtain the name of the contact person for the Department’s highway maintenance contractor. The responsibility to initiate "contact" for coordinating activities shall reside with the party entering a project or site on which work has commenced. This responsibility to initiate contact shall apply regardless of whether or not the worksites are separated by time and/or space, are in the same general vicinity or are adjacent.
Resolving Disputes Related to Coordination of Activities
If the parties cannot agree on a process or system that addresses the safety concerns of all parties, work at the affected worksites shall cease and this matter shall be referred to the Consultant. However, if the Consultant is one of the parties involved in the dispute, or the Department has not employed a Consultant for the project, the matter shall be referred to the Department. The Consultant or Department as applicable, after review, will decide which party shall be responsible for resolving the disputed safety issue. Such decision shall be final and binding upon all parties.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-41
Responsibility for Subcontractors/Owner operators The Prime Contractor shall, to the extent required by the Occupational Health and Safety Act, establish and maintain a Health and Safety system or process to ensure compliance to the Act by his subcontractors/owner operators. A transfer of ownership of land from the existing road allowance will be made from the Crown to the Central Western Railway in exchange for a transfer of ownership of land required for the new crossing (as shown on the attached plan). All survey and associated land registration costs would be to the account of Alberta Transportation. The cost of maintenance and operation of the signal protection shall be paid according to the current agreement which states that fifty percent of the above mentioned cost is paid by Alberta Transportation and fifty percent by the Central Western Railway Company. Other maintenance costs shall be apportioned based on seniority. According to current guidelines the road authority being the junior party at the new location shall be wholly responsible for the maintenance or the rubber planking. The final invoice for your work must be accompanied by back-up documentation and detailed breakdown sufficient and reasonable to support the actual close-out costs claimed. The breakdown of the estimate for the project should include the following:
• Direct labour costs • Contractor charges • Materials • Salvage costs / credits • Subsidiary costs if any (e.g. easements, etc.) • Direct engineering • Overheads
Please forward the invoice and associated documentation to the Consultant’s office for reimbursement. Please sign all three copies; return one copy for our file and forward one copy to the Consultant.
Sincerely,
Name, Construction Manager Region Telephone Number
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-42
_______________________________ ____________________________ Authorized Representative of Witness Central Western Railway Title
_______________________________ _______________________________
Date Date
c.c. Signed Copy to: Consultant Company’s Name Company’s Address
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-43
SAMPLE 9
Our File: Hwy. XX:XX Utility Agreement No. XXXX
Phone: (403) XXX-XXXX Fax: (403) XXX-XXXX
Month XX, 20XX Canadian National, Great Plains District Floor 26, CN Building 10004 - 104 Avenue Edmonton, Alberta T5J 0K2 ATTENTION: Technical Support Engineer
Great Plains District Dear: RE: HWY. XX:XX, CN RAILWAY CROSSING (NORTH OF XXXXX) FULL DEPTH RUBBER MATERIAL
COST ESTIMATE ($17,490.00) Please be advised that Alberta Transportation (AT) acknowledges receipt of your cost estimate of $17,490.00 for the above noted project. AT agrees to reimburse Canadian National (CN) based on actual close-out costs. This letter constitutes AT approval for CN to proceed with the proposed Highway XX:XX Railway Crossing adjustments. If there is a variation of more than 5% or $10,000 whichever is greater from the original cost estimate, CN must contact the Consultant immediately and obtain approval for the additional cost before proceeding with the work. OCCUPATIONAL HEALTH AND SAFETY ACT Alberta Transportation (the Department) assigns prime contractor responsibilities, as specified in the Occupational Health and Safety Act, to all parties with which it enters into contracts and agreements. On highway and bridge construction or maintenance projects this would typically include a Contractor, a Consultant (the Department employs an engineering consultant on construction projects only), various Utility Companies and the Railway Company. During the course of the project, the work sites of the Contractor, Consultant, the Utility Companies and Railway Company may be separated by time and/or space or, may be in the same general vicinity or may be adjacent, depending on the circumstances on the project at any given point in time. It is a requirement of all Department contracts and agreements that the Contractor, Consultant, Utility Companies and Railway Company working within the project limits, coordinate their respective activities, as outlined herein, to ensure a safe project. However, it is not the Department's intent that any of these parties be responsible to ensure that the other parties, or the other parties' subcontractors, have adequate health and safety process for their respective activities.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-44
Designation of Prime Contractor The Railway Company shall familiarize itself, it’s staff and it’s subcontractors with the terms of the Occupational Health and Safety Act and Regulations there under to ensure complete understanding respecting the responsibilities given and compliance required. The Railway Company acknowledges that it is and assumes all of the responsibilities and duties of the Prime Contractor, as defined by the Occupational Health and Safety Act, and that it shall as a condition of this Agreement, comply with the Occupational Health and Safety Act and the regulations there under.
Coordinating Activities The Railway Company shall coordinate its activities on the project with those of the Consultant, the Contractor and the Utility Companies. When the Consultant and/or Contractor and/or Utility Companies are conducting activities within the project limits the Railway Company shall liaise with the Consultant and/or Contractor as the case may be, and jointly develop a health and safety system or process for the affected worksites. The health and safety system or process agreed to by the parties must be in writing. Any changes required to the health and safety system must be agreed to by all affected parties and must also be in writing. Documenting the written health and safety system or process, including any required changes shall be the responsibility of the Contractor.
(i) Coordinating activities on Highway and Bridge Construction Projects
For the purposes of coordinating activities on highway/bridge construction projects, the contact persons for the Contractor, Consultant, the Utility Companies and the Railway Company shall be identified at the pre-construction meeting for the project. The responsibility to initiate "contact" for coordinating activities shall reside with the party entering a project or site on which work has commenced. This responsibility to initiate contact shall apply regardless of whether or not the worksites are separated by time and/or space, are in the same general vicinity or are adjacent.
(ii) Coordinating activities not associated with a Highway or Bridge Construction Project
When the activities of the Railway Company are not being performed on a highway/bridge construction project, the Railway Company shall contact the local Alberta Transportation office prior to commencing work, to obtain the name of the contact person for the Department’s highway maintenance contractor. The responsibility to initiate "contact" for coordinating activities shall reside with the party entering a project or site on which work has commenced. This responsibility to initiate contact shall apply regardless of whether or not the worksites are separated by time and/or space, are in the same general vicinity or are adjacent.
Resolving Disputes Related to Coordination of Activities If the parties cannot agree on a process or system that addresses the safety concerns of all parties, work at the affected worksites shall cease and this matter shall be referred to the Consultant. However, if the Consultant is one of the parties involved in the dispute, or the Department has not employed a Consultant for the project, the matter shall be referred to the Department.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-45
The Consultant or Department as applicable, after review, will decide which party shall be responsible for resolving the disputed safety issue. Such decision shall be final and binding upon all parties.
Responsibility for Subcontractors/Owner operators The Prime Contractor shall, to the extent required by the Occupational Health and Safety Act, establish and maintain a Health and Safety system or process to ensure compliance to the Act by his subcontractors/owner operators. CN Railway (or their Contractor) shall comply with the following: • Contact John Smith of ABC Engineering Corp., Consultant’s Representative, at telephone
number (403) XXX-XXXX in Calgary to co-ordinate work within the project limits. • Provide the Consultant’s representative with the name and contact information of the
utility person responsible for the work. • Submit a traffic control plan and a written Traffic Accommodation Strategy to address for
the safe accommodation of traffic as outlined in the current Traffic Accommodation in Work Zones Manual for Alberta Transportation’s review and comment.
• Desist from starting work until the TAS has been reviewed. • Notify the Consultant and Contractor(s) a minimum of 72 hours in advance of the
proposed commencement or cessation of utility construction work. • Maintain a copy of the TAS on site for the inspection by Alberta Transportation or their
designated representative(s). The final invoice for your work must be accompanied by back-up documentation and detailed breakdown sufficient and reasonable to support the actual close-out costs claimed. The breakdown of the estimate for the project should include the following:
• Direct labour costs • Contractor charges • Materials • Salvage costs / credits • Subsidiary costs if any (e.g. easements, etc.) • Direct engineering • Overheads
Please forward the invoice and associated documentation to the Consultant’s office for reimbursement. Please sign all three copies; return one copy for our file and forward one copy to the Consultant. Sincerely, Name, Construction Manager Region Telephone Number
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-46
______________________________ ______________________________ Authorized Representative of Canadian Witness National Great Plain District ______________________________ ______________________________ Date Date cc: Signed Copy to: Consultant Company’s Name Company’s Address
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-47
SAMPLE 10
Our File: Hwy. XX:XX Utility Agreement No. XXXX
Phone: (780) XXX-XXXX Fax: (780) XXX-XXXX
Month XX, 20XX Attention: Mr. Name Utility Company Ltd. Address City, Alberta X2X 3X5 Dear: RE: Hwy. XX:XX, Jct. Hwy. X to South of Town
Date for Commencement of Construction By way of this letter and on behalf of Alberta Transportation, Consultant’s Name is informing you that the tentative date for commencement of construction for the above noted project is April 01, 2002. The Prime Contractor is: Name: ATTN: Name: Address: Phone: Fax: The grading sub-contractor is: Name: ATTN: Name: Address: Phone: Fax: According to the contract specifications between Alberta Transportation and the Prime Contractor, the Prime Contractor is required to coordinate and schedule their field operations with the applicable utilities companies. If you have any questions please contact the undersigned at phone no. Yours truly,
Name, Consultant’s Title Company Name cc: Signed Copy to: Prime Contractor Alberta Transportation – Project Sponsor
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-48
(To be used for ATCO Electric Ltd. only) SAMPLE 11
Our File: Hwy. XX:XX
Utility Agreement No. XXXX Phone: (780) XXX-XXXX Fax: (780) XXX-XXXX
Month XX, 20XX ATCO Electric Ltd. 10035 – 105 Street, Box 2426 Edmonton, Alberta T5J 2V6 ATTENTION: X X X
X & X Projects
Dear X: RE: HWY. XX:XX, W. OF JCT. S.H. XXX - JCT. HWY X
UTILITY ADJUSTMENT COST ESTIMATE ($XXX) Please be advised that Alberta Transportation (AT) acknowledges receipt of your cost estimate of $XXX for the above noted project. AT agrees to reimburse ATCO Electric Ltd. based on actual close-out costs. This letter constitutes Department’s approval for ATCO Electric Ltd. to proceed with the proposed powerline adjustments. However, if there is a variation of more than 5% or $10,000 whichever is greater from the original cost estimate, ATCO Electric Ltd. must contact the Consultant immediately and obtain approval for additional cost before proceeding with the work. AT would assign Prime Contractor responsibilities, as specified on the Occupational Health and Safety Act, to ATCO Electric Ltd. as per the Master Agreement regarding prime contractor obligations with the Department dated on May 4, 2006. This Master Agreement regarding Prime Contractor shall be appended herewith to form as part of the agreement document. ATCO Electric Ltd. (or their Contractor) shall comply with the following: • Contact John Smith of ABC Engineering Corp., Consultant’s Representative, at telephone
number (403) XXX-XXXX in Calgary to co-ordinate work within the project limits. • Provide the Consultant’s representative with the name and contact information of the
utility person responsible for the work. • Submit a traffic control plan and a written Traffic Accommodation Strategy to address for
the safe accommodation of traffic as outlined in the current Traffic Accommodation in Work Zones Manual for Alberta Transportation’s review and comment.
• Desist from starting work until the TAS has been reviewed. • Notify the Consultant and Contractor(s) a minimum of 72 hours in advance of the
proposed commencement or cessation of utility construction work. • Maintain a copy of the TAS on site for the inspection by Alberta Transportation or their
designated representative(s).
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-49
The final invoice for your work must be accompanied by back-up documentation and detailed breakdown sufficient and reasonable to support the actual close-out costs claimed. The breakdown of the estimate for the project should include the following:
• Direct labour costs • Contractor charges • Materials • Salvage costs / credits • Subsidiary costs if any (e.g. easements, etc.) • Direct engineering • Overheads
Please forward the invoice and associated documentation to the Consultant’s office for reimbursement. Please sign all three copies; return one copy for our file and forward one copy to the Consultant. Sincerely, Name, Construction Manager Region Telephone Number ______________________________ _______________________________ Authorized Representative of ATCO Electric Ltd. Witness ______________________________ _______________________________ Date Date cc: Signed Copy to: Consultant Company’s Name Company’s Address
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-50
(To be used for ATCO Gas Ltd. and ATCO Pipeline Ltd. only) SAMPLE 12
Our File: Hwy. X:XX
Utility Agreement No. XXXX
ROADWAY UPGRADING PIPELINE CROSSING AGREEMENT
PIPELINE ADJUSTMENT IS REQUIRED
This agreement is made as of the XXth day of Month, A.D. 20XX
BETWEEN
Her Majesty the Queen in right of the Province of Alberta as represented by the Minister of Alberta Transportation
(hereinafter called the "Minister")
- and -
____________________________________________ a body corporate registered and existing under the laws of
the Province of Alberta (hereinafter called the "Operator")
WHEREAS the Minister intends to make improvements to a roadway known as Hwy. XXX:XX which may result in a ground disturbance within the controlled area (Alberta Pipeline Act) or Safety Zone (National Energy Board Act) of the Operator's pipelines in the land legally described as:
as shown on the attached Plan No.: ___________________, and adjustment costs as negotiated in a letter dated (sample 4)_____________________ which form as part of this agreement. AND WHEREAS the Operator obtained a permit from the Minister for placement of a pipeline under Hwy. _______. NOW THEREFORE, pursuant to the applicable section of the Alberta Public Highways Development Act, the National Energy Board Act, Alberta Pipeline Act and Regulation the Water Gas and Electrical Companies Act, and the Gas Distribution Act (hereinafter called the "Acts"), the Minister and the Operator agree as follows: 1) The Operator's representative shall be:
(Name): _______________________________
Telephone Number): _______________________________
(Address): _______________________________
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-51
2) The Minister's representative shall be:
(Name): , Construction Manager
(Telephone Number): ( ) -
(Address): Alberta Transportation, ___________________ Region
3) The Minister (or his delegate) shall contact the Operator at least seventy-two (72) hours
(excluding Saturdays, Sundays and Statutory Holidays) prior to undertaking any excavation or construction within the controlled area as defined in the Pipeline Act, or Safety Zone as defined in the National Energy Board Act, as the case may be. The Operator, upon receiving such notice, shall make arrangements to have a representative present during the period machinery is to be used within the controlled area or safety zone, as the case may be, and to witness the exposure of the Operator's pipeline(s). No excavation or construction of any sort shall be carried out within the controlled area or safety zone, as the case may be, until the Operator's representative is present at the site and has authorized same, unless the Operator has advised otherwise by written notice to the Minister.
4) The Operator shall locate and mark the Operator's pipeline(s), perform inspections and
supervise a ground disturbance as required under Part 67 (Alberta Pipeline Regulation 91/2005) without charging any fee to the Minister undertaking the ground disturbances.
5) The Operator's pipeline shall be exposed under the direction of the Operator by hand
digging or other acceptable method such as excavation by water or air jets to determine the exact location and depth of cover (for the purpose of highway design) before construction is undertaken. The cost of this exposure shall be borne by the Minister.
6) If the pipeline work is of such a kind as to fall within the purview of the National Energy
Board Act and National Energy Board Pipeline Crossing Regulations, the Operator agrees to carry out the work in accord with the Canada Labour Code R.S.C. (as amended) and the Oil and Gas Occupational Safety and Health Regulations SOR/86-304 (as amended).
7) In the event that the Minister authorizes the pipeline work to be done by a person, either
legal or natural, other than the Operator, the Minister agrees to require that person to fulfill the responsibilities and duties of the Prime Contractor as that term is used in the Occupational Health and Safety Act, R.S.A 2000, as amended, and any regulations made pursuant to that Act. However, if the pipeline work is of such a kind as to fall within the purview of the National Energy Board Act, and the National Energy Board Pipeline Crossing Regulations, the Minister agrees to require the person to carry out the work in accordance with the Canada Labour Code R.S.C. (as amended) and the Oil and Gas Occupational Safety and Health Regulations SOR/86-304 (as amended).
8) The Minister shall carry out all work within the controlled area or safety zone, as the
case may be, in accordance with good engineering and construction practices, and in accordance with the relevant Acts.
9) The Minister shall ensure that no equipment, material or vehicles will be stored, parked
or driven over or along the controlled area or safety zone, as the case may be, except as reasonably necessary in the actual construction of the roadway.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-52
10) If any excavation or construction equipment is to be moved across the controlled area or
safety zone, as the case may be, prior to excavation or construction, and as a temporary protective measure, the Operator may require direct protective measures in accordance with good engineering and construction practices, and in accordance with the relevant Acts, to be placed across the Operator's pipeline(s) at the point of crossing, the cost of which shall be borne by the Minister.
11) The Minister shall be liable for and shall indemnify and save harmless the Operator from
all manner of actions, causes of action, proceedings, claims, demands, costs, damages and expenses whatsoever including damage to the Operator's pipeline(s), which the Operator may sustain, pay or incur as a result of or in connection with any breach of the obligations assumed under this document by, or the negligence of, the Minister, his employees, servants or agents.
12) The Operator shall be liable for and shall indemnify and save harmless the Minister from
all manner of actions, causes of action, proceedings, claims, demands, costs, damages and expenses whatsoever including damage to the Minister's facilities which the Minister may sustain, pay or incur as a result of or in connection with any breach of the obligations assumed under this document by, or the negligence of, the Operator or any person for whom the Operator is responsible at law or in equity.
13) In the event the Operator is performing any work on its pipeline, the Operator (or their Contractor) shall comply with the following:
• Contact John Smith of ABC Engineering Corp., Consultant’s Representative, at
telephone number (403) XXX-XXXX in Calgary to co-ordinate work within the project limits.
• Provide the Consultant’s representative with the name and contact information of the person responsible for the work.
• Submit a traffic control plan and a written Traffic Accommodation Strategy to address for the safe accommodation of traffic for Alberta Transportation's review and comment.
• Desist from starting work until the TAS has been reviewed. • Notify the Consultant and Contractor(s) a minimum of 72 hours in advance of the
proposed commencement or cessation of utility construction work. • Maintain a copy of the TAS on site for inspection by Alberta Transportation or their
designated representative(s). 14) In the event the Minister is responsible for the whole/portion of the relocation/upgrade
cost, the Operator shall provide the following:
The final invoice for your work must be accompanied by back-up documentation and detailed cost breakdown sufficient and reasonable to support the actual close-out costs claimed. The breakdown of the estimate for the project should include the followings:
• Direct labour costs • Contractor charges • Materials • Salvage costs / credits • Subsidiary costs if any (e.g. easements, etc.)
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-53
• Direct engineering • Overheads
Please forward the invoice and associated documentation to the Consultant’s office for reimbursement. Please sign all three copies; return one copy for our file and forward one copy to the Consultant.
15) Any written notice required or permitted hereunder shall be directed to the party to
whom it will be given (hand delivered, sent by prepaid mail, or sent by telecommunication), addressed as follows:
(a) To the Minister:
Alberta Transportation _____________________Region ________________________ ________________________
________________________
___________
ATTENTION: Name Construction Manager Region
(b) To the Operator:
________________________ ________________________
________________________
________________________
ATTENTION:
And in the event of mail service disruption, such notice shall be delivered by hand.
16) Where the terms and conditions in this document contradict any portion of the Acts, the
latter shall prevail. 17) The terms and conditions of this agreement shall be effective from the date shown at
the beginning of this agreement.
APPENDIX H
November 2011 H-54
Executed on behalf of the Executed on behalf of the Operator by: Minister by: ______________________________ ______________________________ Name Name Title Construction Manager Region
Alberta Transportation – Project Sponsor
APPENDIX I
November 2011
APPENDIX I
SAMPLE COST ESTIMATES AND SUMMARY
APPENDIX I
November 2011
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX I
November 2011 I-1
Preliminary Cost Estimate Summary ABC
Consulting
ESTIMATE TYPE “A”
Hwy 99:06 ABC Project No. 1234-01-56789 North/South Limits Sta 0+123 to Sta 14+123 Total Length N/S (km): 14.000 Design Designation: RAU-211.8 std Ultimate
Grading, Base Paving and Bridge Construction
GRADING ILLUM. BASE/PAVE BRIDGES TOTAL
(ref Engr) (remaining) ($10k) (7%) (12%) (12%)
CONTRACT COST $4,900,000 $90,000 $3,300,000 $4,880,000* $13,170,000 (14km x $329,000/km) (14km x $242,000/km) * based on bridge planning
Contingencies (10%) $490,000 $9,000 $330,000 $488,000 $1,317,000
ENGINEERING (ass. 12% total) $753,400 $10,000 $231,000 $585,600 $1,580,000 RIGHT OF WAY $0 $0
TOTALS $6,143,400 $109,000 $3,861,000 $5,953,600 $16,067,000
TOTAL $ 16,067,000
* based on bridge planning REMARKS:
1. Engineering Costs are assumed at 12%
2. Estimate based on 2002 Dollars. 3. R/W for project is presently in place. R/W estimate $s awaiting Regional input. 4. No detailed information available for Utilities estimate. 5. Proposed Hwy 99 Access Management improvements are not included at this time
but could greatly impact the wetland Replacement costs (frontage service roads). Work in Wetlands may also have timing constraints (migratory birds).
Prepared by: Date: October 5, 2011 Copy to:
APPENDIX I
November 2011 I-2
GRADING DESIGN ESTIMATE FORM
ESTIMATE TYPE: “ B “ PROJECT: SH 999:00
FROM: West of TO: East of
Km 12.345 To Km 28.345 LENGTH: 16.000 Km
DESIGN DESIGNATION: RAU 209-110 SUBGRADE WIDTH: 12.6 m
INITIATED BY: NATURE OF PRIORITY:
DATE:
ITEM UNIT QUANITY UNIT PRICE ESTIMATED COST
Common Exc. m3 113,000 $1.90/m3 $214,700.00
Borrow Exc. m3 390,000 $2.00/m3 $780,000.00
B.T.S. Exc. m3 40,000 $1.00/m3 $40,000.00
Channel Exc. m3 40,000 $3.00/m3 $120,000.00
Rock Exc. m3
Com/Bor Truck Haul m3
Total Excavation: 583,000
Clearing ha 38 $2500.00/ha $95,000.00
Fencing km
Overhaul m3 km 150,000 $0.75/m3km $112,500.00
Water m3
TOTAL ESTIMATED COST: $1,362,200.00
x 1.25 factor = $1,702,750.00
Right-of-Way
R/W: ha @ $/ha = 10 % Contingencies $170,275.00
R/W: ha @ $/ha = 18 % Engineering $306,495.00
Damages = 4 % Materials $68,110.00
Total = Right-of-Way
Borrow Agreements
Utilities $30,000.00
TOTAL FOR “GRADING ESTIMATE”: $2,277,630.00
Borrow Agreements
Borrow Pits: ha @ $/ha =
Backslopes: ha @ $/ha =
Damages =
Total =
- Subtract Right-of-Way
+ Gravel Surfacing (Grading Only) $40,800.00
TOTAL FOR “PROGRAM ESTIMATE” $2,318,430.00
(Total CPMS Grading “B” Est.)
Estimate based on 20__ Dollars. Prepared by: Date:
REMARKS: No work on bridge structures. R/W and borrow costs already in place.
Length of project may be changed.
COPY SUBMITTED TO PROGRAM ENGINEER: 20 Copy to:
APPENDIX I
November 2011 I-3
PRIMARY HIGHWAY 99:00 SURFACING STRATEGY AND BASIC STRUCTURAL DESIGN
Type “B” Surfacing Estimate (Based on AT 2011 Regional unit prices) Rehabilitation Overlay Existing Width (m) Final Width (m) km 16.20 – km 25.135 9.0 11.8 km 25.135 – km 33.000 9.7 14.1 km 33.000 – km 34.20 9.4 14.1
Item From km
To km
Width (m)
Thickness (m)
tonnes/ km
Est. Tonnes/km
Length (km)
Est. tonnes
Unit Price ($/t)
Estimated Cost
Grade Widening Granular Base Course (Des. 2 Class 25)
km 16.20 – km 19.260 16.20 19.26 5.5 0.330 4191 4200 3.06 12852 km 19.260 – km 25.135 19.26 25.14 5.5 0.330 4191 4200 5.88 24675 km 25.135 – km 33.00 25.14 33.00 4.7 0.280 3066 3100 7.86 24366 km 33.00 – km 34.20 33.00 34.20 5.0 0.280 3262 3300 1.20 3960 Inter., ent., crossovers, etc 6585
Total tonnage (GBC – Des. 2 Cl. 25) 72438 $11.75 $851,150
Rehabilitation Overlay Asphalt Concrete Pavement (Mix Type 2 – EPS)
km 16.20 – km 19.260 16.20 19.26 13.0 0.050 1515 1550 3.06 4743 km 19.260 – km 25.135 19.26 25.14 13.0 0.100 3029 3050 5.88 17919 km 25.135 – km 33.00 25.14 33.00 4.7 0.050 548 550 7.86 4323 km 33.00 – km 34.20 33.00 34.20 5.0 0.050 583 600 1.20 720 Inter., ent., crossovers, etc 2770
Total tonnage (ACP – Type 2) 30475 $35.50 $1,081,870
Asphalt Concrete Pavement (Mix Type 8 – EPS)
km 16.20 – km 19.260 16.20 19.26 13.0 0.020 606 650 3.06 1989 Inter., ent., crossovers, etc 199
Total tonnage (ACP – Type 8) 2188 $39.00 $85,328
Mobilization (8%) $161,468
Sub-Total – Construction (contract) Costs $2,179,817
Contingency (5%) $108,991
Engineering (10%) $228.881
Estimated Total $2,517,688
“B” Estimate Total
(to nearest $1000) $2,518,000
APPENDIX I
November 2011 I-4
APPENDIX I
November 2011 I-5
Cost Estimate "C"
For Hwy 99:06
TENDER 9999/07
Prepared for Alberta Transportation
Southern Region
Prepared By ABC Consulting
Somewhere, Alberta June 4, 2011
REVISION 3
APPENDIX I
November 2011 I-6
Item Code Item Description Unit Estimated 2011 Estimated Estimated 2011 AVE No. (CEB) Quantity Weighted Unit Price Cost Cost
Average "C" "C"
1 X100 Mobilization (10 %) GRADING work lump sum 1.0 $535,298.40 $542,172.66
2 X004 Site Occupancy per day $1,500.00 $1,500.00 $0 $0
3 G100 Clearing ha 1.00 $1,750.00 $4,000.00 $4,000 $1,750
4 G225 Common Excavation m3 560000.00 $2.10 $2.13 $1,192,800 $1,176,000
5 G220 Channel Excavation m3 3500.00 $4.21 $4.50 $15,750 $14,735
6 G230 Borrow Topsoil Excavation m3 360000.00 $1.58 $1.40 $504,000 $568,800
7 G235 Borrow Excavation m3 1020000.00 $1.87 $1.75 $1,785,000 $1,907,400
8 G239 Overhaul m3.km 1720000.00 $0.56 $0.60 $1,032,000 $963,200
9 D100 Culverts - Remove and Dispose (C.S.P.) (up to 700 mm dia.) m 183.00 $30.00 $28.00 $5,124 $5,490
10 D105 Culverts - Remove and Dispose (C.S.P.) (over 700 mm dia.) m 44.00 $23.00 $35.00 $1,540 $1,012
11 D200 Granular Backfill - Culverts m3 500.00 $40.00 $14.00 $7,000 $20,000
12 D410 Culverts - Supply and Install (600 mm dia. C.S.P.) m 316.00 $100.00 $110.00 $34,760 $31,600
13 D425 Culverts - Supply and Install (800 mm dia. C.S.P.) m 656.00 $163.00 $135.00 $88,560 $106,928
14 D540 Grouting of Abandoned Culverts m3 37.00 $208.00 $250.00 $9,250 $7,696
15 E018 Plugging Abandoned Water Well lump sum 1.00 $1,000.00 $1,500.00 $1,500 $1,000
16 G452 Remove and Dispose of Existing Fence km 10.00 $772.86 $800.00 $8,000 $7,729
17 G453 Remove and Salvage of Existing Fence km 2.50 $965.00 $1,000.00 $2,500 $2,413
18 G475 New Fence - Supply and Install - Class B km 10.00 $3,646.61 $3,700.00 $37,000 $36,466
19 G480 New Fence - Supply and Install - Class C km 1.00 $5,783.33 $7,000.00 $7,000 $5,783
20 G014 New Fence - Modified Class B -(Five Strand Barbwire) km 0.20 $5,000.00 $5,000.00 $1,000 $1,000
21 G014 New Fence - Modified Class B (2.4m Post Spacing) km 2.00 $4,500.00 $5,500.00 $11,000 $9,000
22 G018 Relocate Ranch Gate lump sum 1.00 $1,500.00 $1,500.00 $1,500 $1,500
23 G300 Topsoil Placement m2 750000.00 $0.10 $0.14 $105,000 $75,000
24 E600 Seeding, Fertilizing and Harrowing ha 145.00 $416.00 $455.00 $65,975 $60,320
25 E605 Seeding, Fertilizing and Mulching ha 12.00 $2,700.00 $3,500.00 $42,000 $32,400
HIGHWAY 99:06 - Grading Estimate Summary
Highway 90 to S. of Access
APPENDIX I
November 2011 I-7
26 E500 Soil Covering (Low Flow) m2 12000.00 $5.00 $5.00 $60,000 $60,000
27 A800 Supply of Aggregate - With Option t 800.0 $0.95 $0.95 $760 $760
36 S830 Flexible Guide Post/Delineators - Round - Supply and Install posts 180.00 $30.16 $30.00 $5,400 $5,429
37 S825 Remove and Dispose of Existing Guardrail m 200.00 $6.07 $7.00 $1,400 $1,214
38 S820 Remove, Salvage and Reinstall Existing Guardrail m 840.00 $15.45 $17.50 $14,700 $12,978
39 S800 W-Beam Guardrail - Supply and Install m 2040.00 $40.25 $41.00 $83,640 $82,110
40 S257 Supply and Install Post - 100 mm x 150 mm posts 105.00 $32.45 $35.00 $3,675 $3,407
41 S258 Supply and Install Post - 150 mm x 200 mm posts 12.00 $50.00 $60.00 $720 $600
42 S272 Supply of Signs, Aluminum m2 40.00 $188.55 $200.00 $8,000 $7,542
43 S270 Supply of Signs, 3/4" Plywood m2 14.00 $213.35 $220.00 $3,080 $2,987
44 S275 Removal and Reinstallation or Disposal of Existing Signs - One Post signs 55.00 $31.80 $30.00 $1,650 $1,749
45 S277 Removal and Reinstallation Disposal of Existing Signs - Two Posts signs 15.00 $44.40 $100.00 $1,500 $666
46 S283 Concrete Base - Remove and Reinstall units 4.00 $179.00 $200.00 $800 $716
47 S291 Remove and Reinstall Breakaway Steel Posts posts 4.00 $97.33 $150.00 $600 $389
48 S288 Install Sign - Less than 1 m2 signs 100.00 $26.27 $30.00 $3,000 $2,627
49 S289 Install Sign - 1 m2 to 3 m2 signs 15.00 $88.72 $120.00 $1,800 $1,331
58 F750 Traffic Accommodation lump sum 1.00 $200,000.00 $200,000.00 $200,000 $200,000
TOTAL $5,888,282 $5,963,899
TOTAL ESTIMATED EXPENDITURE $5,888,282 $5,963,899
CONTRACT ESTIMATE (rounded to nearest 1000 dollars)* $5,888,000 $5,964,000
CONTINGENCIES @ 10%* $588,800 $596,400
ENGINEERING (Total) 7.2% $467,100 $467,100
UTILITIES $25,000 $25,000
RIGHT-OF-WAY $0 $0
GRADING ESTIMATE SUMMARY $6,968,900 $7,052,500
APPENDIX I
November 2011 I-8
Bid Code Unit Estimated 2011 Estimated Estimated 2011 AVENo. (CEB) Quantity AVE Unit Price Cost Cost
"C" "C"
1 X100 Mobilization (10 %) ACP lump sum 1.0 $212,562.50 $203,328.45
2 X004 Site Occupancy per day $1,500.00
$1,500.00 $0.00 $0
27 A800 Supply of Aggregate - With Option t 78000.0 $0.95 $0.95 $74,100.00 $74,100
28 Q185 Gravel Surfacing t 10000.0 $3.80 $5.00 $50,000.00 $38,000
33 Q487 Asphalt Concrete Pavement - EPS Mix Type 1 t 67000.0 $27.20 $28.25 $1,892,750.00 $1,822,400
34 Q510 Asphalt Mix For Others t 1000.0 $23.40 $24.00 $24,000.00 $23,400
50 S310 Pavement Message Markings - Turn Arrow (Single or Double) units 17.0 $41.24 $50.00 $850.00 $701
51 S315 Pavement Message Markings - Stop Bar units 4.0 $51.55 $75.00 $300.00 $206
53 S350 Roadway Lines - Supplying Paint and Painting (Directional Dividing and 2 Edge Lines) km 23.5 $452.11 $500.00 $11,750.00 $10,625
54 S355 Roadway Lines - Supplying Paint and Painting (Lane Dividing Lines) km 7.5 $202.11 $250.00 $1,875.00
$1,516
55 S360 Intersection Lines - Supplying Paint and Painting intersections 2.0 $168.39 $250.00 $500.00 $337
56 X510 Cutting of Pavement Edge m 10000.0 $5.00 $5.75 $57,500.00 $50,000
57 S052 Remove and Dispose Advance Warning Signs units 2.0 $6,000.00
$6,000.00 $12,000.00 $12,000
TOTAL $2,338,188 $2,236,613
TOTAL ESTIMATED EXPENDITURE $2,338,188 $2,236,613
CONTRACT ESTIMATE (rounded to nearest 1000 dollars)* $2,338,000 $2,237,000
CONTINGENCIES @ 10%* $233,800 $223,700
ENGINEERING (Total) $67,431 $67,431
UTILITIES $0 $0
RIGHT-OF-WAY $0 $0
TOTAL ESTIMATE HIGHWAY 99:06 - ACP $2,639,231 $2,528,131
HIGHWAY 99:06 ACP ESTIMATE SUMMARYHighway 90 to S. of Access
APPENDIX I
November 2011 I-9
Item Code Item Description Unit Estimated 2011 Estimated Estimated 2011 AVENo. (CEB) Quantity AVE Unit Price Cost Cost
"C" "C"
1 X100 Mobilization (10 %) GBC lump sum 1.0 $138,795 112,312.96
2 X004 Site Occupancy per day $1,500.00 $1,500.00 $0 $0
27 A800 Supply of Aggregate - With Option t 173000.0 $0.95 $0.95 $164,350 $164,350
29 B100 Subgrade Excavation m3 500.0 $3.92 $4.00 $2,000 $1,960
30 B172 Granular Fill (Pit-run) 6 - 80 t 1000.0 $13.33 $14.00 $14,000 $13,330
31 B282 Granular Base Course 2-25 t 172000.0 $5.30 $6.80 $1,169,600 $911,600
TOTAL $1,450,745 $1,171,663
TOTAL ESTIMATED EXPENDITURE $1,450,745 $1,171,663
CONTRACT ESTIMATE (rounded to nearest 1000 dollars)* $1,451,000 $1,172,000
CONTINGENCIES @ 10%* $145,100 $117,200
ENGINEERING (Total) 5.2% $84,944 $84,944
UTILITIES $0 $0
RIGHT-OF-WAY $0 $0
GBC ESTIMATE $1,684,844 $1,377,454
HIGHWAY 99:06 - GBC ESTIMATE SUMMARYHighway 90 to S. of Access
APPENDIX I
November 2011 I-10
Bid
Code Item Description Unit Estimated 2011 Estimated Estimated 2011 AVENo.
(CEB) Quantity AVE Unit Price Cost Cost"C" "C"
59
X100
Mobilization (10 %) Bridge Structures lump sum 1.0
253,468.25 250,708.37
60
X004
Site Occupancy per day $600.00 $600.00 $0 $0
61
F186 Excavation - Structural lump sum 1 $40,000.00 $40,000.00 $40,000 $40,000
62
F190 Backfill lump sum 1 $400,000.00
$400,000.00
$400,000
$400,000
63
F812 Supply of Piling - H-Pile m 466 $62.89 $65.00 $30,290 $29,307
64
F816 Pile Set-up piles 28 $1,191.24 $1,200.00 $33,600 $33,355
65
F818 Pile Driving m 466 $4.00 $4.00 $1,864 $1,864
66
F018 Mechanically Stabilized Earth Wall lump sum 1 $640,000.00
$640,000.00
$640,000
$640,000
67
F963 Supply of Girders - Precast Long Span - DBC Type (Exterior) girders 4 $25,000.00 $25,000.00 $100,000
$100,000
68
F963 Supply of Girders - Precast Long Span - DBC Type (Interior) girders 18 $25,000.00 $25,000.00 $450,000
$450,000
69
F940 Delivery of Girders lump sum 1 $25,000.00 $25,000.00 $25,000 $25,000
70
F945 Erection of Girders lump sum 1 $130,000.00
$130,000.00
$130,000
$130,000
71
F834 Concrete - Class C m3 191 $619.00 $675.00 $128,925
$118,229
72
F840 Concrete - Modified Class SF m3 382 $819.64 $850.00 $324,700
$313,102
73
F850 Plain Reinforcing Steel - Supply kg 29227 $0.83 $0.85 $24,843 $24,258
74
F852 Epoxy-coated Reinforcing Steel - Supply kg 33188 $1.32 $1.35 $44,804 $43,808
75
F854 Reinforcing Steel - Place kg 62415 $0.41 $0.45 $28,087 $25,590
76
F905 Supply of Bearings lump sum 1 $10,000.00 $10,000.00 $10,000 $10,000
77
F780 Bridge rail lump sum 1 $79,700.00 $79,700.00 $79,700 $79,700
78
F020 Tube Rail Fence m 215 $40.00 $40.00 $8,600 $8,600
79
F965 Ducts lump sum 1 $5,200.00 $5,200.00 $5,200 $5,200
80
F970 Miscellaneous Iron lump sum 1 $10,000.00 $10,000.00 $10,000 $10,000
81
F842 Sealer lump sum 1 $10,000.00 $10,000.00 $10,000 $10,000
81
F022 Ditch Lining m2 800 $2.00 $2.00 $1,600 $1,600
82
F022 Sacked Concrete Drain Troughs m 166 $45.00 $45.00 $7,470 $7,470
TOTAL $2,788,151 $2,757,792
TOTAL ESTIMATED EXPENDITURE $2,788,151 $2,757,792
CONTRACT ESTIMATE (rounded to nearest 1000 dollars)* $2,788,000 $2,758,000
CONTINGENCIES @ 10%* $278,800 $275,800
ENGINEERING $166,276 $166,276
UTILITIES $0 $0
RIGHT-OF-WAY $0 $0
TOTAL ESTIMATE HIGHWAY 99:06 CPR OVERPASS $3,233,076 $3,200,076
HIGHWAY 99:06 CPR OVERPASS BF 99999 N and BF 99999 S ESTIMATE SUMMARY
APPENDIX I
November 2011 I-11
Bid Code Item Description Unit Estimated 2011 Estimated Estimated 2011 AVENo. (CEB) Quantity AVE Unit Price Cost Cost
"C" "C"
1 X100 Mobilization (10 %) ACP lump sum 1.00 $54,169 $52,203
2 X004 Site Occupancy per day $1,500.00 $1,500.00 $0 $0
29 B100 Subgrade Excavation m3 250.00 $3.92 $4.00 $1,000 $980
30 B172 Granular Fill (Des 6-80) t 500.00 $13.33 $14.00 $7,000 $6,665
27 A800 Aggregate Supply With Option t 17500.00 $0.95 $0.95 $16,625 $16,625
33 Q487 Asphalt Concrete Pavement - EPS Mix Type H1 t 17000.00 $27.20 $28.25 $480,250 $462,400
38 S820 Remove, Salvage and Reinstall Existing Guardrail m 138.00 $15.45 $17.50 $2,415 $2,132
35 G270 Side slope Improvement km 3.00 $9,186.15 $9,200.00 $27,600 $27,558
50 S310 Pavement Message Markings - Turn Arrow (Single or Double) units 18.0 $41.24 $50.00 $900.00 $742
52 S315 Pavement Message Markings - Stop Bar units 6.00 $51.55 $75.00 $450 $309
52 S321 Pavement Messages - STOP units 6.00 $383.21 $450.00 $2,700 $2,299
53 S350Roadway Lines - Supplying Paint and Painting (DirectionalDriving and 2 Edge Lines) km 4.00 $452.11 $500.00 $2,000 $1,808
55 S360 Intersection Lines - Supplying Paint and Painting intersections 3.00 $168.39 $250.00 $750.00 $505
TOTAL $595,859 $574,228
TOTAL ESTIMATED EXPENDITURE
$595,859 $574,228
CONTRACT ESTIMATE (rounded to nearest 1000 dollars)* $596,000 $574,000
CONTINGENCIES @ 10%* $59,600 $57,400
ENGINEERING (Total)
$33,311 $33,311
UTILITIES
$0 $0
RIGHT-OF-WAY $0 $0
TOTAL ESTIMATE HIGHWAY 99:06 - ACP - Final Stage Paving $688,911 $664,711
HWY 99:06 ACP (FINAL STAGE) ESTIMATE SUMMARYS. of Access - N. of Anytown
APPENDIX I
November 2011 I-12
Estimated 2011 AVECost
Cost
"C"
TOTAL ESTIMATED EXPENDITURE* $13,099,225 $12,736,085
CONTRACT ESTIMATE (rounded to nearest 1000 dollars)* $13,099,000 $12,737,000
CONTINGENCIES @ 10%* $1,309,900 $1,273,700
ENGINEERING (Total) 6.3% $819,062 $819,062
UTILITIES $25,000 $25,000
RIGHT-OF-WAY $0 $0
TOTAL CONTRACT ESTIMATE - ALL PHASES COMBINED $15,252,962 $14,854,762
*Note: Total Estimated Expenditure values vary from individual estimate summaries due to rounding.
Prepared By: Person 1, Transportation EngineerChecked By: Person 2, Sr. Project Manager Date October 11, 2011Checked By: Person 3, RET Project Manager
Revision 3 - Final Check Revised Costs for Engineering and Combining Quantities.
TOTAL HIGHWAY 99:06 Cost Estimate "C" Summary
APPENDIX I
November 2011 I-13
CONTRACT ESTIMATED SUMMARY "C" FOR TENDER 9999/00 HWY 99:06
2012 Estimated Construction Costs
Contract (Nearest $1,000)
10% Contingencies Engineering Right of Way Utilities Totals
Grading $5,888,000 $588,800 $467,100 $0 $25,000 $6,968,900
GBC Surfacing $1,489,000 $148,900 $84,944 $0 $0 $1,722,844
ACP Surfacing $2,338,000 $233,800 $67,431 $0 $0 $2,639,231
CPR Overpass $2,788,000 $278,800 $166,276 $0 $0 $3,233,076
ACP - Final Stage - S. of Access $596,000 $59,600 $33,311 $0 $0 $688,911
Totals $13,099,000 $1,309,900 $819,062 $0 $25,000 $15,252,962
2011 Average Unit Prices Costs
Contract (Nearest $1,000)
10% Contingencies Engineering Right of Way Utilities Totals
Grading $5,964,000 $596,400 $467,100 $0 $25,000 $7,052,500
GBC Surfacing $1,204,000 $120,400 $84,944 $0 $0 $1,409,344
ACP Surfacing $2,237,000 $223,700 $67,431 $0 $0 $2,528,131
CPR Overpass $2,758,000 $275,800 $166,276 $0 $0 $3,200,076
ACP - Final Stage - S. of Access $574,000 $57,400 $33,311 $0 $0 $664,711
Totals $12,737,000 $1,273,700 $819,062 $0 $25,000 $14,854,762
Notes: 2011 Average Unit Prices obtained from UNIT PRICE REPORT DATED April 12 2011 Southern Region Prices were used when available and Provincial Average Prices were used when no price for Southern Region was available.
APPENDIX I
November 2011 I-14
COST ESTIMATE TYPE: D FILE: 12345
PROGRAM PROJECT: Hwy XX : XX
MANAGEMENT SPANS & TYPE: 10-13-10m SCC Girders DATE: 1/1/11
BRANCH LENGTH: 34.04 WIDTH: 13.63 AREA: 463.97
CONTRACT NO: 1234/00 $ Per M2 $2,065.26
First Low
Bid Second Low
Bid Third Low
Bid Average Average
DESCRIPTION QTY UNIT of Low 3 Extension
Mobilization 1 lump sum 35,407.00 47,925.00 100,000.00 61,110.67 61,110.67
Traffic Accommodation for Bridge Construction
1 lump sum 147,964.00 136,856.00 50,000.00 111,606.67 111,606.67
Site Occupancy - Bridge Structures 900 days 70.00 52.00 65.00 62.33 56,100.00
Excavation - Structural 1 lump sum 2,560.00 4,750.00 8,500.00 5,270.00 5,270.00
Backfill 1 lump sum 9,105.00 14,400.00 14,000.00 12,501.67 12,501.67
Removal of Bridge Structures 1 lump sum 43,251.00 59,650.00 37,500.00 46,800.33 46,800.33
Supply of Galvanized Piling - Pipe Pile
107 m 268.00 245.00 240.00 251.00 26,857.00
Supply of Ungalvanized Piling - Pipe Pile
96 m 140.00 115.00 125.00 126.67 12,160.00
Pile Set-up 14 piles 3,958.00 3,200.00 4,500.00 3,886.00 54,404.00
Pile Driving 203 m 4.00 45.00 4.00 17.67 3,586.33
Structural Steel 1 lump sum 15,934.00 15,750.00 30,000.00 20,561.33 20,561.33
Miscellaneous Iron 1 lump sum 4,622.00 630.00 2,000.00 2,417.33 2,417.33
Plain Reinforcing Steel - Supply 10 711 kg 1.00 1.00 0.70 0.90 9,639.90
Epoxy-coated Reinforcing Steel - Supply
13 554 kg 1.50 1.50 1.15 1.38 18,749.70
Reinforcing Steel - Place 24 265 kg 0.60 0.75 0.75 0.70 16,985.50
Pile Concrete 17 m3 380.00 826.00 500.00 568.67 9,667.33
Concrete - Class B 56 m3 722.00 878.00 1,100.00 900.00 50,400.00
Concrete - Class SF 108 m3 982.00 1,031.00 1,250.00 1,087.67 117,468.00
Supply of Girders - 10.0 m SCC Interior
20 girders 4,438.00 5,350.00 4,500.00 4,762.67 95,253.33
Supply of Girders - 10.0 m SCC Exterior
4 girders 8,764.00 7,500.00 8,500.00 8,254.67 33,018.67
Supply of Girders - 13.0 m SCC Interior
10 girders 5,690.00 7,300.00 5,500.00 6,163.33 61,633.33
Supply of Girders - 13.0 m SCC Exterior
2 girders 11,381.00 8,000.00 11,000.00 10,127.00 20,254.00
Delivery of Girders 1 lump sum 19,121.00 18,000.00 20,000.00 19,040.33 19,040.33
Erection of Girders 1 lump sum 23,901.00 19,687.00 30,000.00 24,529.33 24,529.33
Sealer 1 lump sum 3,474.00 5,510.00 5,000.00 4,661.33 4,661.33
Bridgerail 1 lump sum 38,044.00 23,723.00 38,000.00 33,255.67 33,255.67
Guardrail 1 lump sum 5,636.00 14,681.00 12,000.00 10,772.33 10,772.33
Asphalt Concrete Pavement - Mix Type 2
1 lump sum 33,821.00 34,875.00 62,000.00 43,565.33 43,565.33
Heavy Rock RipRap (Class 1) 160 m3 75.00 108.00 85.00 89.33 14,293.33
TOTALS: $958,207.00 $1,001,505.75 $1,029,975.55 $996,562.77 $996,562.77 $ Per M2 $2,065.26 $2,158.58 $2,219.94 $2,147.93 $2,147.93
APPENDIX I
November 2011 I-15
COST ESTIMATE TYPE: D FILE: 12345
PROGRAM PROJECT: Hwy XX:XX
MANAGEMENT SPANS & TYPE: 1-4610 SPCSP x 186.54m long, t=3mm
DATE: 1/1/11
BRANCH LENGTH: 186.54 WIDTH: 1.00 AREA: 186.54
CONTRACT NO.:
1234/00 $ Per Linear Metre $4,625.01
First Low Bid
Second Low Bid
Third Low Bid
Average Average
DESCRIPTION QTY UNIT of Low 3 Extension Traffic Accommodation 1.00 lump sum 55,000.00 55,000.00 250,000.00 120,000.00 120,000.00
Excavation 1.00 lump sum 144,755.00 144,755.00 170,000.00 153,170.00 153,170.00
Removal and Disposal of Existing Culvert
1.00 lump sum 12,000.00 12,000.00 20,000.00 14,666.67 14,666.67
SPCSP - Supply 1.00 lump sum 189,945.00 189,945.00 400,000.00 259,963.33 259,963.33
SPCSP Assembly 1.00 lump sum 49,500.00 49,500.00 55,000.00 51,333.33 51,333.33
Backfil l 1.00 lump sum 350,000.00 350,000.00 450,000.00 383,333.33 383,333.33
Concrete End Treatment 1.00 lump sum 22,800.00 22,800.00 26,000.00 23,866.67 23,866.67
Heavy Rock RipRap (Class 2) 310.00 m3 125.00 125.00 130.00 126.67 39,266.67
TOTALS: $862,750.00 $862,750.00 $1,411,300.00 $1,045,600.00 $1,045,600.00 $ Per Linear
Metre $4,625.01 $4,625.01 $7,565.67 $5,605.23 $5,605.23
APPENDIX I
November 2011 I-16
COST ESTIMATE TYPE: D FILE: 1234
PROGRAM PROJECT: SH XXX:XX
MANAGEMENT SPANS & TYPE: 21.03-24.99-21.03-16.66-16.66m WF Steel Girders
DATE: 1/1/11
BRANCH LENGTH: 100.38 WIDTH: 8.23 AREA: 826.13
CONTRACT NO.: 1234/00 $ Per M2 $164.17
First Low Bid
Second Low Bid
Third Low Bid
Average Average
DESCRIPTION QTY UNIT of Low 3 Extension
Mobilization 1.00 lump sum 13,914.00 30,270.00 8,950.00 17,711.33 17,711.33
Traffic Accommodation 1.00 lump sum 5,400.00 15,620.00 5,790.00 8,936.67 8,936.67
Site Occupancy 500.00 $ per day 17.00 26.00 20.00 21.00 10,500.00
Supply and Delivery of Deck Joints 1.00 lump sum 21,000.00 22,425.00 21,830.00 21,751.67 21,751.67
Installation of Deck Joint Assemblies 1.00 lump sum 25,000.00 16,210.00 17,625.00 19,611.67 19,611.67
Troug Drain and Headslope Repairs 1.00 lump sum 8,200.00 7,935.00 14,885.00 10,340.00 10,340.00
Approach Slab Repair 1.00 lump sum 2,200.00 2,910.00 5,200.00 3,436.67 3,436.67
Partial Depth Repair 10.00 m2 475.00 310.00 530.00 438.33 4,383.33
Approach Guardrail Upgrading 1.00 lump sum 14,055.00 5,626.00 7,000.00 8,893.67 8,893.67
Roadwaqy Construction 1.00 lump sum 14,455.00 26,393.00 17,450.00 19,432.67 19,432.67
Asphalt Concrete Pavement - Mix Type 2
150.00 t 121.00 164.00 255.00 180.00 27,000.00
TOTALS: $135,624.00 $168,089.00 $152,280.00 $151,997.67 $151,997.67 $ Per M2 $164.17 $203.47 $184.33 $183.99 $183.99
APPENDIX J1
November 2011
APPENDIX J1
BRIDGE DESIGN PROCESSES AND DATA REQUIREMENTS
APPENDIX J1
November 2011
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX J1
November 2011 J1-1
BRIDGE DESIGN PROCESS CHART
Project Initiation
Preliminary Assessment
Rehab or New
Prepare Draft Bridge Planning Summary
Report
Major Structure?
Prepare Final Bridge Planning Summary
Report
Prepare DD Drawings
Prepare Final Bridge Planning Summary Report
Prepare Structure Alternatives Report &
Prepare Project Design
Structural Design & Drawing Preparation
Prepare Structure Alternatives Report & Choose Design
Independent Design
Prepare Tender Package & AIT awards
Contract Design Change
Evaluate & Accept
REDESIGN REVIEW ACCEPT
Approve shop drawings & stressing calculations, submit shop drawings to the Department, etc.
Provide construction inspection services & resolve design issues from the field
Submit Documents for record keeping (design & check notes drawings, etc.) Undertake post construction BIM inspection
See Appendix J1-14
New rehab
yes
no
yes yes
no no
Notes:
� All designs require full engineering optimization. Design deviating from Department standards and best practices require formalized risk analysis and appropriate approvals from the Project Sponsor and Technical Standards.
� Value engineering may be undertaken at any phase in the process
� All culverts now require a ‘P’ drawing
APPENDIX J1
November 2011 J1-2
BRIDGE PROJECT PROCESS
No. Activity of Design Process Participants Approximate Time Frame
1 Preliminary Assessment and Site History - Collect available information and supplement as
required - Determine hydrotechnical and geometric
requirements - Review project with stakeholders (road authority,
railway, environment, navigable waters, canal authority, etc.)
Consultant 2 – 4 weeks
2 Submit Draft Bridge Planning Report for review and Department concurrence to proceed with recommended option
Region/ Technical Standards
Milestone Date (given in agreement) Allow 2 weeks for AIT review
3 Finalize bridge plan for selected option (submit draft Design Data Drawings for review*)
Consultant 2 to 4 weeks
4 Submit Final Bridge Planning Summary Report (and finalized Design Data Drawings*)
Region/ Technical Standards
Milestone Date (given in TOR) DD drawings to be submitted 2 weeks prior to this date
5 Prepare Structure Alternatives Report Consultant Provide 1 week prior to (6)
6 Review Structure Alternatives Report and Select Alternative - Region and Technical Standards review options
and recommendation - Region completes “Choose Design Completion”
form and communicates decision to consultant
Region/ Technical Standards
Milestone Date (given in TOR)
7 Obtain Required Approvals - Consultant prepares all documents and submits
to Region - Region or consultant makes formal submissions
to NTA, NWPA, Environment, etc. for approval
Consultant/ Region
As required to meet construction tender contract dates
*8 Prepare Project Design Brief Consultant 1 week and submit 1 week prior to (10)
*9 Review and Accept Project Design Brief and Communicate decision to consultant
Region/ Technical Standards
Milestone Date (given in TOR)
10 Detailed Structural Design Package - Prepare contract drawings ** - Independent check of design and drawings - Prepare special provisions - Assemble tender documents
** All culverts now require a ‘P’ drawing
Consultant 4 to 15 weeks Package to be submitted 2 weeks prior to (11)
11 Review and Accept Tender Package - Region, Technical Standards, and Contracts
review tender package - Region accepts tender package, completes
“Design Completion” form, and communicates decision to consultant
Region/ Technical Stds./Program Management Branch
Milestone Date (given in TOR)
APPENDIX J1
November 2011 J1-3
No. Activity of Design Process Participants Approximate Time Frame
12 Provide Design Services during Construction - Approve shop or fabrication drawings, erection
drawings, and stressing calculations - Respond to queries from field related to design
Consultant As specified in Terms of Reference
13 Prepare As-Constructed Drawings - Undertake post construction BIM inspection
Consultant Consultant/ Region
4 weeks after open to traffic date
14 File Documents - Record drawings, shop drawings, special
provisions, designers’ notes, checkers notes, etc. - Submit completed “Corporate Data
Requirements” forms
Technical Standards Region
8 weeks maximum after open to traffic date
15 Evaluate Consultant - Communicate Results to Technical Standards
Region/ Consultant
4 weeks after completion date
* Major Bridges Only
APPENDIX J1
November 2011 J1-4
REQUIREMENTS FOR DESIGN DATA DRAWINGS
WORK TASKS
� Undertake an initial site assessment in order to highlight significant issues. Conduct a
cost benefit or life cycle cost analysis involving any components can be reused during reconstruction. If necessary, co-ordinate preliminary design with concurrent geometric design and/or location study, and local road authority. Submit Decision for Navigability request.
� Undertake site survey and geotechnical investigation as necessary. Complete location
optimization, geometric design, and hydraulic analysis. Provide consideration of alternative structure types to allow development of alternative and ultimate finalization of optimum planning design to be shown on Design Data drawings and structural design. Complete draft Bridge Planning Summary Report and facilitate choose concept meeting.
� Prepare Design Data drawings containing sufficient detail and information to allow the
construction of the bridge head slopes and fills, any river training works and/or protection works, and temporary traffic accommodation during construction. Design Data drawings are to include but are not necessarily restricted to the items detailed in the following sections. Sample drawings will be provided upon request to the Edmonton office.
� Detailed site plan showing:
• location of the as-built bridge relative to the stream • all existing or proposed river training and/or bank protection works • all utilities, existing and required right-of-way, and any existing developments • detour alignment which meets or exceeds minimum standards
� Elevation view showing:
• existing bridge including abutments, piers, and foundation • location of the bridge head slopes • any protection works relative to the river banks • design hydraulic conditions including:
• design high water elevation • high water elevations with date of measurement • minimum freeboard (as per SAD guidelines) • design ice conditions • anticipated scour • proposed deck elevation • geotechnical information including test holes or test piles
� Bridge cross-section showing minimum proposed clear deck width, lane configurations,
and crown or super-elevation � Cross section of roadway approach fills at bridge ends.
APPENDIX J1
November 2011 J1-5
� Site mosaic showing:
• proposed bridge • stream • extent of fills • river training and/or protection works • existing roadway system including horizontal curve data and how the replacement bridge will tie in
• land ownership � Stream bed and water or ice surface profile.
• Highway profile showing station and elevation of: • vertical curves (with associated “K” values and slope) • proposed abutments
� General Summary notes including:
• survey acquisition information • hydrotechnical summary giving:
− drainage area − design discharge and return frequency − historical high flood − mean flow velocity for design discharge through the proposed bridge opening − flowing ice condition with situation and elevation − stream bed slope − anticipated backwater due to proposed bridge
• type, specification, and quantities of any bridge and/or bank protection material • all other relevant notes required to structurally design, construct, and operate the bridge
• highway geometric design standards � Prepare Navigable Waters sketches (if required). � Fish Compensation plans when required � Obtain all necessary permits, licenses, or approvals and prepare special provisions and
submissions for Water Resources Permit, Federal Fisheries, and/or Navigable Waters Protection Act approval.
� Submit Bridge Planning Summary Report.
PROCESS MILESTONES
� At an agreed upon time after proposal acceptance, attend initial meeting with
Municipality to identify alignment, location, and structure type alternatives and discuss site-specific issues.
� Prepare alternatives for advancement to Design Data drawing stage.
APPENDIX J1
November 2011 J1-6
� Submit concept alternatives and draft Bridge Planning Summary Report. � Attend meeting to review initial design including hydrotechnical and geometric aspects. � Prepare final Design Data drawings in preparation for formal Design Data drawing
review with Municipality. A complete check of the design and drawings by an engineer other than that responsible for the design is required. Copies of these drawings are to be supplied to Municipality two weeks prior to the Design Data Drawing meeting.
� Attend meeting for final review and acceptance of Design Data drawings. Obtain permits and approvals to satisfy requirements.
Bridge Choose Design
November 2011 J1-7
Bridge File:
Region: Project Description:
Highway:
Road Authority:
Dept. Sponsor: Dept. Admin: TSB Liaison:
Consultant: Project Manager: CE Agreement:
CLEAR ROADWAY WIDTH: AREA (O.T.O. fills and total bridge width) :
STRUCTURE ALTERNATIVES
Description Selected Cost Estimate NPV (50 Years, 4%)
SPECIAL CONSIDERATIONS:
Notes:
SELECTED ALTERNATIVE:
Girder Type, Size and No. of Lines:
Culvert Size (span x rise x length) and Shape:
Abutment Type: Pier Type:
Deck and Wearing Surface Type:
Deck Joints:
Curbs: Bridge Rail:
Approach Slabs: Guardrail: Notes:
DD Drawing No.’s:
Draft Submission: Review Meeting Date:
Final Submission:
Cost Estimate Type Date Milestone Schedule Date
Current: Project Design Brief:
Previous: Complete detailed design:
Includes: Engineering, Construction, Contingencies, R/W, Detour Tender ready for advertising:
Tender advertize date:
Consultant Project Manager’s Signature Dept. Administrator’s Signature Dept. Sponsor’s Signature
Copies to: Consultant, TSB, Bridge File
Bridge Design Completion
November 2011 J1-8
Bridge File:
Region:
Project Description:
Highway:
Road Authority:
Dept. Sponsor: Dept. Admin: TSB Liaison:
Consultant: Project Manager:
CE Agreement:
DESIGN INFORMATION:
Clear Roadway: Total Width:
Deck Length: Net Deck Area:
Design Loading:
Girder Type, Size and No. of Lines:
Culvert Size (span x rise x length) and shape:
Abutment Type: Pier Type:
Bearing Types:
Deck and Wearing Surface Type:
Deck Joints:
Curbs: Bridge Rail:
Approach Slabs: Deck Drainage:
Approach Surface: Guardrail:
Utility Accomm.: Traffic:
Disposal of Salvage:
NOTES:
DD Drawing No.’s:
P Drawing Numbers: Sign Date:
APPROVALS/PERMITS:
REQUIRED APPLICATION DATE DATE ISSUED NUMBER
Alberta Environment Protection (Water Act)
Coast Guard Canada (NWPA)
Fisheries and Oceans Canada
Canadian Transportation Agency
RIGHT OF WAY/EASEMENTS:
Draft Submission: Review Meeting Date:
Final Submission:
Cost Estimate Type Date Milestone Schedule Date
Current:
Tender ready for advertising:
Previous:
Tender advertize date:
Includes: Engineering, Construction, Contingencies, R/W, Detour
Completion construction:
Consultant Project Manager’s Signature Dept. Administrator’s Signature Dept. Sponsor’s Signature
Copies to: Consultant, TSB, Bridge File
File: No.: Page No.: Date: Engineer/Company:
November 2011 J1-9
DESIGN PROJECT BRIEF
PROPOSED TITLE BLOCK Design Codes: :
Other References:
DD No.
Choose Design Record: Latest Cost Estimate:
Project Scope & Short Description of Structure:
ITEM REV
DESCRIPTION
General
Superstructure type, spans & o/o width:
AADT/year:
Roadway classification:
Approach roadway design speed:
Design speed at structure:
Clear zone:
Horizontal alignment (curve radius):
Crown or super-elevation:
Grade-line:
Skew (LHF/RHF):
Curbs, shoulder, lane, median, and sidewalk widths:
Median type:
Clear roadway:
File: No.: Page No.: Date: Engineer/Company:
November 2011 J1-10
ITEM
REV
DESCRIPTION
Clearance box under structure:
Future widening requirements:
Approach guardrail type:
Bridge-rail type:
Identify any obstacles behind bridge-rails:
Set-back requirement for obstacles:
Approach guardrail transition type:
Approach pavement type:
Additional comments:
Design Parameters
Live Load: Highway class for fatigue design: Pier collision load: Wind load: Effective structure temperature range: Earth pressures: Ice loads: Earthquake: Test piles: Soil borehole data: Geotechnical features: General scour elevation: Design local scour:
File: No.: Page No.: Date: Engineer/Company:
November 2011 J1-11
ITEM
REV
DESCRIPTION
Additional comments:
Structural Materials
As per standard drawings:
Concrete: Class B: 25 MPa
Class C: 35 MPa
Class HPC: 45 MPa
Class D: 30 MPa
Class S: 20 MPa
Pipe Pile: 25 MPa
Reinforcing steel grade and type: Pre-stressing steel: Post-tensioning steel: Structural steel: Other materials:
Abutments
Abutment Type: Piles/orientation: Casing for integral piles (Y/N, type): Abutment face height: Inspection access: Back wall: Wing walls/orientation: Wing wall and treatment: Curtain Wall: Roof Slab:
File: No.: Page No.: Date: Engineer/Company:
November 2011 J1-12
ITEM
REV
DESCRIPTION
Grade beam: Approach Slab: Sleeper slab: Sidewalk slab: Median: Finishes and Sealing: Slope protection: Plumbing for finger joints: Drain troughs at wing wall ends: Sub-drainage system: Estimated settlement after construction: Additional comments:
Piers
Pier type: Shaft and nose shape: Pier protection: Foundation: Footing elevations: Footing shape: Bracing: Nose plates: Finishes: Additional comments:
File: No.: Page No.: Date: Engineer/Company:
November 2011 J1-13
ITEM
REV
DESCRIPTION
Bearings Expansion bearings: Fixed bearings: Orientation w.r.t. skew: Additional comments:
Girders
Method of analysis: Wheel line/girder (Tabulate for critical moment & sheer locations): Girder type: Number and spacing: Continuity: Transverse connectivity: Abutment diaphragm Pier diaphragms: Intermediate diaphragms: Girder finishing: Additional comments:
Deck
Deck thickness: Nominal girder haunch height: Waterproofing system: Wearing surface: Allowance for future removal by milling: Allowance for future w.s. after milling: Barrier type:
File: No.: Page No.: Date: Engineer/Company:
November 2011 J1-14
ITEM
REV
DESCRIPTION
Curbs width and height: Roadway deck drains: Sidewalks width and height: Median/curb type: ACP weep drains: Utilities provisions:
Bridge End Deck or Pavement Joints
Location and joint types: Additional comments:
Retaining Walls
Location and wall type: Component features and specifications: Traffic or other safety barriers:
Construction Features:
Construction loads:
Remarks on how the major project elements will be built (contract; crew; etc.) Other factors to consider: detours; channel/road work; staging; field vs. plant work; drainage; lighting; other agency involvements. Generally, only unusual situations or non-standard procedures need be listed.
File: No.: Page No.: Date: Engineer/Company:
November 2011 J1-15
ITEM
REV
DESCRIPTION
Preliminary List of Drawings:
Drawing No. Drawing Title
File: No.: Page No.: Date: Engineer/Company:
November 2011 J1-16
ITEM
REV
DESCRIPTION
Scheduling:
Provide realistic estimates of completion of design and drafting work considering current knowledge of drafting support level.
Unresolved Major Items:
List items for further review, investigation decision, missing data, etc.
APPENDIX J1
November 2011 J1-17
CORPORATE DATA REQUIREMENTS FOR BRIDGE PROJECTS PROJECT SUMMARY
Municipality: Bridge File: Agreement # Department Liaison Project Description: Region: Location: Consultant: Project start date: Project completion date:
STRUCTURAL AND HYDROTECHNICAL DELIVERABLES
PRELIMINARY ENGINEERING date
required** date delivered
forwarded to Edmonton?
• Bridge Assessment Report • Cost Estimates (B1) • Environment Permit • Federal Fisheries Approval • • NWPA Approval • Preliminary Engineering Meeting Form • CTA Approval (Railways) • Geotechnical Report • Corrosion Survey Report • Complete Design Notes & Checkers Notes • DD Drawings: signed & stamped Mylar and CAD
Files
• Drawing Numbers DD DETAILED DESIGN date
required date delivered
forwarded to Edmonton?
• Preliminary Structures Report • Choose Design Form • Project Design Brief • Culvert or Bridge Authorization Form • Design Completion Form • Cost Estimate (“C”) • Approved Shop/fabrication Drawings and CAD Files • Approved Stressing Calculations • Const. Drawings: signed and stamped Mylar and
CAD Files
• Design Notes and Checkers Notes • Drawing Number Range P
for additional information see clause of the “Engineering Consultant Guidelines for Highway, Bridge, and Water Projects” **Project Sponsor to indicate N/A in box when “not applicable” cc: Director, Bridge Engineering Section, Technical Standards Branch
APPENDIX J1
November 2011 J1-18
Note: All reports, forms, approvals and notes to be submitted in hard copy and electronic format (MS Word or PDF). Electronic files to be modified with bridge file number and date.
APPENDIX J2
November 2011
APPENDIX J2
QUALIFICATIONS FOR BRIDGE MATERIALS FABRICATION
INSPECTION
PRE-STRESSED PRE-CAST CONCRETE GIRDER/UNITS
MISCELLANEOUS MATERIAL (INCLUDING
CULVERTS)
MAJOR STEEL COMPONENTS
APPENDIX J2
November 2011
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX J2
November 2011 J2-1
BRIDGE MATERIALS FABRICATION INSPECTION
PRE-STRESSED PRECAST CONCRETE GIRDERS/UNITS QUALIFICATIONS � Inspector
ACI grade 1 certified concrete testing technician and must have extensive precast pre-stressed concrete fabrication experience. He shall be fully cognizant of all requirements of the Contract, Specifications, and Drawings.
� Testing Lab Certified to CSA standards.
CULVERTS Culverts include metal CSP (Corrugated Steel Pipe) and SPCSP (Structural Plate Corrugated Steel Pipe) QUALIFICATION OF VISUAL INSPECTOR � Level 1 certified and must have experience in fabrication inspection of CSP and SPCSP.
MISCELLANEOUS MATERIAL Miscellaneous material includes deck joints, bearings, bridge-rail, strengthening/replacement members, miscellaneous iron, and culverts. QUALIFICATIONS OF VISUAL INSPECTOR � The visual inspector shall be a Level II certified welding inspector as per CSA 178.2
accredited with W47.1/W59 or must have bridge related fabrication inspection experience. He shall be fully cognizant of all requirements of the Contract, Specifications, and Drawings.
QUALIFICATIONS OF NDT INSPECTORS � Radiographic Inspection: The lead technician shall be certified to Level II of C.G.S.B. and
his assistant shall be a Qualified Operator (Q.O.). � Ultrasonic Inspection: The technician shall be certified to Level II of C.G.S.B. � Magnetic Particle Inspection: The technician shall be certified to Level II of C.G.S.B.
MAJOR STEEL COMPONENTS Major steel components include steel girders, sign structures, and ferries.
APPENDIX J2
November 2011 J2-2
QUALIFICATIONS OF VISUAL INSPECTOR/S � The day shift visual inspector shall be a Level III certified welding inspector as per CSA
178.2 accredited with W47.1/W59 or must have an extensive bridge related fabrication inspection experience. He must also be experienced in operating telebrinnel hardness testing apparatus. He shall be fully cognizant of all requirements of the Contract, Specifications, and Drawings.
� The second shift visual inspector shall be a Level II certified welding inspector as per CSA
178.2 accredited with W47.1/W59 or must have bridge related fabrication inspection experience. He shall be experienced in interpreting Engineering Drawings.
QUALIFICATIONS OF NDT INSPECTORS � Radiographic Inspection: The lead technician shall be certified to Level II of C.G.S.B. and
his assistant shall be a Qualified Operator (Q.O.). � Magnetic Particle Inspection: The technician shall be certified to Level II of C.G.S.B. � Ultrasonic Inspection: The technician shall be certified to Level II of C.G.S.B.
APPENDIX J3
November 2011
APPENDIX J3
QUALIFICATIONS FOR BRIDGE CONSTRUCTION INSPECTION
AND BRIDGE PAINTING INSPECTION
APPENDIX J3
November 2011
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX J3
November 2011 J3-1
BRIDGE CONSTRUCTION INSPECTION GENERAL
� Bridge Construction Inspection shall include inspection for major bridge structures, bridge rehabilitation work, and bridge size culverts.
QUALIFICATIONS OF BRIDGE CONSTRUCTION INSPECTOR
� Preference for either a Civil Engineer (P. Eng.) or (E.I.T.) or Certified Civil Engineering Technologist (C.E.T.).
� Extensive field experience in supervision and inspection of bridge construction/bridge rehab work by contract.
� Trained and experienced in interpreting engineering drawings and applicable specifications. � Effective written and oral communication skills. � Previous field experience in construction surveying, concrete quality control, rebar
installations and concrete placement and installation and assembly of culverts. � Thorough knowledge of contract administration and contract law. � Competent and knowledgeable of the Occupational Health and Safety Act and Regulations.
BRIDGE PAINTING INSPECTION
GENERAL
� Bridge Painting Inspection shall be inspection of bridge structures requiring the application of an approved coating system.
QUALIFICATIONS OF PAINT INSPECTOR � The Paint Inspector shall have N.A.C.E. (National Association of Corrosion Engineers)
Level III certification. QUALIFICATIONS OF FIELD WELDING INSPECTOR The visual inspector shall be a Level II certified welding inspector as per CSA 178.2 accredited with W47.1/W59 and must have experience in field welding.
APPENDIX J3
November 2011 J3-2
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX K
November 2011
APPENDIX K
RECORDS MANAGEMENT BY CONSULTANTS ON PROJECTS
APPENDIX K
November 2011
This page left blank intentionally.
APPENDIX K
November 2011 K-1
RECORDS MANAGEMENT BY CONSULTANTS ON PROJECTS To ensure that sufficiently detailed records are kept to comply with the requirements of the Freedom of Information and Protection of Privacy (FOIP) Act, and to serve the future needs of the Department, the following records must be prepared, submitted, and a copy retained by the Consultant. The records are listed in categories as follows:
1) Planning 2) Roadway Design
2a) Preliminary Survey 2e) Lands and Aggregates 2b) Grading Design 2f) Geotechnical 2c) Environment 2g) Surfacing 2d) Utilities 2h) Traffic
3) Bridges 3a) Bridge Preliminary Engineering
3b) Bridge Design
The bridge related information (listed as items 3a and 3b above) shall be submitted based on bridge file number to facilitate record retention under those file numbers. The rest of the information shall be submitted as one Project Records file with the information categorized according to the headings shown. The Project Records file will be stored in the Corporate Records Centre under the following identifiers: Highway Number, Control Section Number, and Kilometre “from and to” information (project limits). Supplemental information that will also be shown on the file identifier are dates, project description ”from and to”, and Contract Number. The Department will store the graphics information separately from the Project Records file e.g. mosaic-profile plans, bridge plans, etc. will be stored in the appropriate graphics files. Electronic files for all text and graphics shall be included. The Project Records file shall be submitted prior to final invoice submission for engineering services on a project. Consultants are required to prepare a complete duplicate copy of the Project Records file and retain the information for ten (10) years. After this time, the documents should be returned to the Department for destruction. The Department’s practice is documented in Schedule number 2002/046 which is available from Records Management Section, Alberta Transportation, 4999 98 avenue, Edmonton.
Note: An asterisk (*) beside a plan or record indicates that a Record Drawing is to be submitted following completion of construction. All Record Drawings shall be submitted in MicroStation format and on 3 mil Mylar, stamped, signed, and sealed, along with a CD containing the Record Drawing electronic drawings as part of the Final Details for a
project. Final details shall be submitted prior to final invoice submission for engineering services on a project.
APPENDIX K
November 2011 K-2
1. PLANNING
� A written reproducible (unbound, camera ready, 8”x11” or on Mylar film) report (complete with plans) is required. All electronic data, for example survey data, digital files for photo image, digital file for interchange or intersection plans, etc. shall also be submitted for department use.
� Public participation documents (i.e. questionnaires) shall be bound separately to
enable the Department to protect the privacy of the individual as per FOIP.
2. ROADWAY DESIGN A CD containing all electronic files of the design categories below (from 2a to 2h), clearly labelled, shall be submitted to the Project Sponsor prior to final invoice submission for engineering services on a project. 2a) PRELIMINARY SURVEY
� An ASCII geographic coordinate file (xyz values such as latitude, longitude, elevation) for roads and bridges site surveys including raw and processed data of survey, geodetic datum and other survey specifics.
� Utilities Survey - Exact location and depth of installation of telephone cable (size and type)
and pedestals, overhead telephone lines, power lines, television, telecommunication, pipeline company instrumentation, pipelines, telegraph, railway operating cables, etc. shall be noted in the survey field book.
� Railway Crossings - The complete details of survey and all plans prepared for railway crossings
2b) GRADING DESIGN
� Geometric, Safety, and Surfacing Assessment Reports (when prepared by the
Roadway Design Consultant)
� Final Grading Design Package (as noted in Section 8.1.1) including Design Drawing mosaic profile plans, intersection plans, utility plans, overhaul diagram, and other special drawings
� A zipped file of computer aided Detailed Design of the entire project including road allowances, roadside turnouts, accesses, and service roads
NOTE: The database should be ready for loading in the program software to
print design information as well as to view the Design Cross Sections, Earthwork Quantities, and Overhaul Diagrams
� Design Element Files
- horizontal and vertical alignments - typical cross-sections - super-elevation
APPENDIX K
November 2011 K-3
- climbing/passing lanes - soil survey information (i.e. borings file) - area/surface parameters - borrow files - volume files
� Record Drawing mosaic profile plans
� Record Drawing plans for intersection geometric layout, passing lanes, climbing lanes, interchange, roadside turnouts, etc.
2c) ENVIRONMENT
� Approvals issued by Alberta Environmental Protection need to be retained until a
reclamation certificate is obtained for borrow pits and gravel pits
� Permits and licenses issued by Environmental Protection may need periodic re-authorization
� Letters of clearance issued by Alberta Community Development for archaeological sites, etc.
� Terms and conditions from referrals
2d) UTILITIES
� Utility crossing plans and associated crossing agreements (plan to be retained with Finals)
� Utility alteration estimates, where applicable
� Correspondence with utilities companies
2e) LAND AND AGGREGATES
� Aggregate data summary requests
� Spec. shell (supply and payment for aggregate - contractor's supply with option)
� Pit operations
� Pit plan
� Aggregates testing plan
� Area map showing project and aggregate site
� Mosaic of right-of-way request
2f) GEOTECHNICAL
� Geotechnical engineering report (complete with investigation report, borehole logs, plans, drawings, recommendations)
� Computer diskettes containing instrumentation monitoring readings and files of plots
� Computer printout of instrumentation monitoring plots
APPENDIX K
November 2011 K-4
2g) SURFACING DESIGN
� Detailed Design (Final) Surfacing strategy and basic structural design report
� Contract document
� Bid items description
� Quantity, cost estimates, and summaries
� Record Drawing Cross sections and plans
� Design notes and correspondence
� Summary of Pavement Testing Program Materials (where required)
2h) TRAFFIC
� Traffic and Pedestrian Control Signals - Traffic data (if these are provided by the consultant) - Signal design (phasing, timing, etc.) - Intersection layout (signal design) - Signal equipment (electrical prints, operation manuals, brochures, etc.)
� Railway Crossing Signals - Crossing plan - Application documents with Transport Canada, etc. - Board Orders and cost sharing agreements
� Traffic Studies - Proposals - Study Report
� Signing, Pavement Markings, and Guardrail Design - Project plans where necessary
� Illumination - Lighting design (plans, etc.) - Agreements with power company (operation and maintenance responsibility)
3. BRIDGES 3a) BRIDGE PRELIMINARY ENGINEERING
� Bridge assessment report
� Plans and cost estimate for alternatives considered
� Navigable Water Protection Act (NWPA) drawings and permit applications/approvals
� Railway grade separation design plan including Canada Transportation Act (CTA) submission
� Drawings
� Environmental Impact Assessment and all documentation required for CTA approval
� Environmental permit documents
APPENDIX K
November 2011 K-5
� Estimated life expectancy of culvert and corrosion survey results
� Design notes
� Stamped, signed and sealed original Design Data (DD) drawings (hard copy & electronic data)
� CTA order, and approval drawing(s) 3b) BRIDGE DESIGN
� Original drawing (with stamps and signatures)(hard copy & electronic data)
� Design notes
� Shop drawings
� Project summary report
� Copy project related photographs Note: An electronic form (MS Word or PDF) of all records, notes, etc. need to be submitted
with two hard copies.
APPENDIX K
November 2011 K-6
This page left blank intentionally.